UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
☒
ANNUAL REPORT
UNDER SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
(FEE REQUIRED)
For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2017
☐
TRANSACTION REPORT
UNDER SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
(NO FEE REQUIRED)
For the transaction period from ________ to ________
Commission File
number
000-30262
VISUALANT, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in charter)
Nevada
|
90-0273142
|
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or
organization)
|
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
|
|
|
|
|
500
Union Street, Suite 810, Seattle, Washington
USA
|
98101
|
(Address of principal executive offices)
|
(Zip Code)
|
|
206-903-1351
|
|
|
(Registrant's telephone number, including area
code)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
N/A
|
|
|
(Former name, address, and fiscal year, if changed since last
report)
|
|
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all
reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or
for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file
such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements
for the past 90 days. Yes
☒
No
☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted
electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every
Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant
to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter)
during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the
registrant was required to submit and post such files).
Yes
☒
No
☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large
accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer,
smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the
definitions of “large accelerated filer,”
“accelerated filer”, “smaller reporting
company”, and “emerging growth company” in Rule
12b-2
Large
accelerated filer
|
☐
|
Accelerated
filer
|
☐
|
Non-accelerated
filer (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
|
☐
|
Smaller
reporting company
|
☒
|
Emerging
growth company
|
☐
|
|
|
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the
registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period
for complying with any new or revised financial accounting
standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange
Act.
☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company
(as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange
Act). Yes
☐
No
☒
As of March 31, 2017 (the last business day of our most recently
completed second fiscal quarter), based upon the last reported
trade on that date, the aggregate market value of the voting and
non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates (for this purpose,
all outstanding and issued common stock minus stock held by the
officers, directors and known holders of 10% or more of the
Company’s common stock) was $1,389,796.
The number of shares of common stock, $.001 par value, issued and
outstanding as of December 29, 2017: 4,655,486
shares
|
|
Page
|
PART 1
|
|
|
|
|
|
ITEM 1.
|
Description of Business
|
3
|
|
|
|
ITEM 1A.
|
Risk Factors
|
6
|
|
|
|
ITEM 1B
|
Unresolved Staff Comments
|
15
|
|
|
|
ITEM 2.
|
Properties
|
15
|
|
|
|
ITEM 3.
|
Legal Proceedings
|
15
|
|
|
|
ITEM 4.
|
Mine Safety Disclosures
|
15
|
|
|
|
ITEM
5.
|
Other
Information
|
15
|
|
|
|
PART
II
|
|
|
|
|
|
ITEM 5.
|
Market for Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer
Purchases of Equity Securities
|
16
|
|
|
|
ITEM 6.
|
Selected Financial Data
|
20
|
|
|
|
ITEM 7.
|
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations
|
20
|
|
|
|
ITEM 7A.
|
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market
Risk
|
24
|
|
|
|
ITEM 8.
|
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
|
24
|
|
|
|
ITEM 9.
|
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and
Financial Disclosure
|
24
|
|
|
|
ITEM 9A.
|
Controls and Procedures
|
24
|
|
|
|
ITEM 9B.
|
Other Information
|
25
|
|
|
|
PART
III
|
|
|
|
|
|
ITEM 10.
|
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
|
26
|
|
|
|
ITEM 11.
|
Executive Compensation
|
28
|
|
|
|
ITEM 12.
|
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and
Related Stockholder Matters
|
34
|
|
|
|
ITEM 13.
|
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director
Independence
|
35
|
|
|
|
ITEM 14.
|
Principal Accounting Fees and Services
|
37
|
|
|
|
PART
IV
|
|
|
|
|
|
ITEM 15.
|
Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
|
38
|
|
|
|
|
SIGNATURES
|
42
|
PART I
DISCLOSURE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
The following discussion, in addition to the other information
contained in this report, should be considered carefully in
evaluating us and our prospects. This report (including without
limitation the following factors that may affect operating results)
contains forward-looking statements (within the meaning of Section
27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended ("Securities Act")
and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended
("Exchange Act") regarding us and our business, financial
condition, results of operations and prospects. Words such as
"expects," "anticipates," "intends," "plans," "believes," "seeks,"
"estimates" and similar expressions or variations of such words are
intended to identify forward-looking statements, but are not the
exclusive means of identifying forward-looking statements in this
report. Additionally, statements concerning future matters such as
revenue projections, projected profitability, growth strategies,
development of new products, enhancements or technologies, possible
changes in legislation and other statements regarding matters that
are not historical are forward-looking statements.
Forward-looking statements in this report reflect the good faith
judgment of our management and these statements are based on facts
and factors as we currently understand them. Forward-looking
statements are subject to risks and uncertainties and actual
results and outcomes may differ materially from the results and
outcomes discussed in the forward-looking statements. Factors that
could cause or contribute to such differences in results and
outcomes include, but are not limited to, those discussed below in
“Risk Factors” and in "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," as well
as those discussed elsewhere in this report. Readers are urged not
to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements,
which speak only as of the date of
this report. We undertake no obligation to revise or update any
forward-looking statements in order to reflect any event or
circumstance that may arise after the date of this
report.
ITEM 1. DESCRIPTION OF
BUSINESS
BACKGROUND AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
Visualant, Incorporated (the “Company,”
“Visualant, Inc.” or “Visualant”) was
incorporated under the laws of the State of Nevada in 1998.
We have authorized 105,000,000 shares of capital stock, of which
100,000,000 are shares of voting common stock, par value $0.001 per
share, and 5,000,000 are shares preferred stock, par value $0.001
per share.
BUSINESS
We are focused on the development, marketing and sales of a
proprietary technology which is capable of uniquely identifying and
authenticating almost any substance using light to create, record
and detect the unique digital “signature” of the
substance. We call this our “ChromaID™”
technology.
Overview
For the
past several years we have focused on the development of our
proprietary ChromaID™ technology. Using light from low-cost
LEDs (light emitting diodes) we map the color of substances, fluids
and materials and with our proprietary processes we can
authenticate, identify and diagnose based upon the color that is
present. The color is both visible to us as humans but also outside
of the humanly visible color spectrum in the near infra-red and
near ultra-violet and beyond. Our ChromaID scanner sees what we
like to call “Nature’s Color Fingerprint.”
Everything in nature has a unique color identifier and with
ChromaID we can see it, and identify, authenticate and diagnose
based upon the color that is present. Our ChromaID scanner is
capable of uniquely identifying and authenticating almost any
substance or liquid using light to create, record and detect its
unique color signature. While we will continue to develop and
enhance our ChromaID technology and extend its capacity, we have
moved into the commercialization phase of our Company as we begin
to both work with partners and internally to create revenue
generating products for the marketplace.
Our ChromaID™ Technology
We have
developed a proprietary technology to uniquely identify and
authenticate almost any substance. This patented technology
utilizes light at the photon (elementary particle of light) level
through a series of emitters and detectors to generate a unique
signature or “fingerprint” from a scan of almost any
solid, liquid or gaseous material. This signature of reflected or
transmitted light is digitized, creating a unique ChromaID
signature. Each ChromaID signature is comprised of from hundreds to
thousands of specific data points.
The
ChromaID technology looks beyond visible light frequencies to areas
of near infra-red and ultraviolet light and beyond that are outside
the humanly visible light spectrum. The data obtained allows us to
create a very specific and unique ChromaID signature of the
substance for a myriad of authentication, verification and
diagnostic applications.
Traditional
light-based identification technology, called spectrophotometry,
has relied upon a complex system of prisms, mirrorsand visible
light. Spectrophotometers typically have a higher cost and utilize
a form factor (shape and size) more suited to a laboratory setting
and require trained laboratory personnel to interpret the
information. The ChromaID technology uses lower cost LEDs and
photodiodes and specific frequencies of light resulting in a more
accurate, portable and easy-to-use solution for a wide variety of
applications. The ChromaID technology not only has significant cost
advantages as compared to spectrophotometry, it is also completely
flexible is size, shape and configuration. The ChromaID scan head
can range in size from endoscopic to a scale that could be the size
of a large ceiling-mounted florescent light fixture.
In
normal operation, a ChromaID master or reference scan is generated
and stored in a database. We call this the ChromaID Reference
Library. The Visualant scan head can then scan similar materials to
identify, authenticate or diagnose them by comparing the new
ChromaID digital signature scan to that of the original or
reference ChromaID signature or scan result. Over time, we believe
the ChromaID Reference Libraries can become a significant asset of
the Company, providing valuable information in numerous fields of
use.
We have
pursued an active intellectual property strategy and have been
granted eleven patents. We also have 20 patents pending. We possess
all right, title and interest to the issued patents. Ten of the
pending patents are licensed exclusively to us in perpetuity by our
strategic partner, Allied Inventors, a spin off corporation from
Intellectual Ventures, the large intellectual property
fund.
ChromaID: A Foundational Platform Technology
Our
ChromaID technology provides a platform upon which a myriad of
applications can be developed. As a platform technology, it is
analogous to a smartphone, upon which an enormous number of
previously unforeseen applications have been developed. The
ChromaID technology is an enabling technology that brings the
science of light and photonics to low cost, real world
commercialization opportunities across multiple industries. The
technology is foundational and as such, the basis upon which the
Company believes a significant business can be built.
As with
other foundational technologies, a single application may reach
across multiple industries. The ChromaID technology can, for
example effectively differentiate and identify different brands of
clear vodkas that appear identical to the human eye. By extension
this same technology can identify pure water from water with
contaminants present. It can provide real time detection of liquid
medicines such as morphine that have been adulterated or
compromised. It can detect if jet fuel has water contamination
present. It could determine when it is time to change oil in a deep
fat fryer. These are but a few of the potential applications of the
ChromaID technology based upon extensions of its ability to
identify different clear liquids.
The
cornerstone of a company with a foundational platform technology is
its intellectual property. We have pursued an active intellectual
property strategy and has been granted eleven patents. We currently
have 20 patents pending. We possesses all right, title and interest
to the issued patents. Ten of the pending patents are licensed
exclusively to us in perpetuity by our strategic partner, Allied
Inventors.
Our Patents
We
believe that our eleven patents, 20 patent applications, two
registered trademarks, and our trade secrets, copyrights and other
intellectual property rights are important assets. Our patents will
expire at various times between 2027 and 2033. The duration of our
trademark registrations varies from country to country. However,
trademarks are generally valid and may be renewed indefinitely as
long as they are in use and/or their registrations are properly
maintained.
The
issued patents cover the fundamental aspects of the Visualant
ChromaID technology and a growing number of unique applications
ranging, to date, from invisible bar codes to tissue and liquid
analysis.
The
patents that have been issued to Visualant and their dates of
issuance are:
On
August 9, 2011, we were issued US Patent No. 7,996,173 B2 entitled
“Method, Apparatus and Article to Facilitate Distributed
Evaluation of Objects Using Electromagnetic Energy,” by the
United States Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires
August 24, 2029.
On
December 13, 2011, we were issued US Patent No. 8,076,630 B2
entitled “System and Method of Evaluating an Object Using
Electromagnetic Energy” by the United States Office of
Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires November 7,
2028.
On
December 20, 2011, we were issued US Patent No. 8,081,304 B2
entitled “Method, Apparatus and Article to Facilitate
Evaluation of Objects Using Electromagnetic Energy” by the
United States Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires
July 28, 2030.
On
October 9, 2012, we were issued US Patent No. 8,285,510 B2 entitled
“Method, Apparatus, and Article to Facilitate Distributed
Evaluation of Objects Using Electromagnetic Energy” by the
United States Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires
July 31, 2027.
On
February 5, 2013, we were issued US Patent No. 8,368,878 B2
entitled “Method, Apparatus and Article to Facilitate
Evaluation of Objects Using Electromagnetic Energy by the United
States Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires July
31, 2027.
On
November 12, 2013, we were issued US Patent No. 8,583,394 B2
entitled “Method, Apparatus and Article to Facilitate
Distributed Evaluation of Objects Using Electromagnetic Energy by
the United States Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent
expires July 31, 2027.
On
November 21, 2014, we were issued US Patent No. 8,888,207 B2
entitled “Systems, Methods, and Articles Related to
Machine-Readable Indicia and Symbols” by the United States
Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires February 7,
2033. This patent describes using ChromaID to see what we call
invisible bar codes and other identifiers.
On
March 23, 2015, we were issued US Patent No. 8,988,666 B2 entitled
“Method, Apparatus, and Article to Facilitate Evaluation of
Objects Using Electromagnetic Energy” by the United States
Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires July 31,
2027.
On May
26, 2015, we were issued US Patent No. 9,041,920 B2 entitled
“Device for Evaluation of Fluids using Electromagnetic
Energy” by the United States Office of Patents and
Trademarks. The patent expires March 12, 2033. This patent
describes a ChromaID fluid sampling devices.
On
April 19, 2016, we were issued US Patent No. 9,316,581 B2 entitled
“Method, Apparatus, and Article to Facilitate Evaluation of
Substances Using Electromagnetic Energy” by the United States
Office of Patents and Trademarks. The patent expires March 12,
2033. This patent describes an enhancement to the foundational
ChromaID technology.
On
April 18, 2017, we were issued US Patent No. 9,625,371 B2 entitled
“Method, Apparatus, and Article to Facilitate Evaluation of
Substances Using Electromagnetic Energy.” The patent expires
July 31, 2027. This patent pertains to the use of ChromaID
technology for the identification and analysis of biological
tissue. It has many potential applications in medical, industrial
and consumer markets.
We
continue to pursue a patent strategy to expand its unique
intellectual property in the United States and other
countries.
Joint Development Agreements and Product Strategy
We are
currently undertaking internal development work on potential
products for the consumer marketplace. This development work is
being performed through our
Consulting
Agreement with Phil Bosua, who serves as our Chief Product
Officer
. As these products begin to take form, we will make
appropriate product announcements.
We also
will continue to engage with partners through licensing our
ChromaID technology in various fields of use, entering in to joint
venture agreements to develop specific applications, and it certain
specific instances developing its own products for the
marketplace.
We have
deployed our ChromaID development kit to a number of potential
joint venture partners and customers around the world. There are
strong indications of interest in deploying our ChromaID technology
in a wide variety of applications involving identification,
authentication and diagnostics. We are focusing our current efforts
on productizing the ChromaID technology as it moves out of the
research laboratory and in to the marketplace. These efforts
involve working on engineering issues necessary to provide
consistent replicable results for customer end users.
Today,
we currently have Joint Venture Agreements in place with
Intellicheck and Biomedx for widely disparate applications. These
two agreements have described in greater detail in our prior
filings. The agreement with Intellicheck focuses upon developing
applications for law enforcement, defense and homeland security
applications which deal with identification and authentication. The
agreement with Biomedx focuses upon developing applications for
determining certain qualities of human skin which are diagnostic in
nature. We believe that these agreements will lead to products in
the marketplace and a generation of revenues over
time.
Research and Development
Our research and development efforts are primarily focused
improving the core foundational ChromaID technology, extending its
capacity and developing new and unique applications for the
technology. As part of this effort, we typically conduct testing to
ensure that ChromaID application methods are compatible with the
customer’s requirements, and that they can be implemented in
a cost effective manner. We are also actively involved in
identifying new application methods. Our current team has
considerable experience working with the application of light-based
technologies and their application to various industries. We
believe that its continued development of new and enhanced
technologies relating to our core business is essential to our
future success. We spent $79,405 and $325,803 during the years
ended September 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively, on development
activities.
On July 6, 2017, we entered into a Consulting
Agreement with Phil Bosua, our Chief Product Officer, whereby Mr.
Bosua can earn up to 200,000 shares of the Company’s company
stock based on achieving certain product development and funding
milestones.
THE COMPANY’S COMMON STOCK
Our common stock trades on the OTCQB Exchange under the symbol
“VSUL.”
PRIMARY RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES
We are exposed to various risks related to our need for additional
financing, the sale of significant numbers of our shares and a
volatile market price for our common stock. These risks and
uncertainties are discussed in more detail below in Part I, Item
1A.
CORPORATE INFORMATION
We were incorporated under the laws of the State of Nevada on
October 8, 1998. Our executive offices are located at 500 Union
Street, Suite 810, Seattle, WA 98101. Our telephone number is (206)
903-1351 and its principal website address is located at
www.visualant.net. The information on our website is not
incorporated as a part of this Form 10-K.
EMPLOYEES
As of September 30, 2017, we had thirteen full-time employees and
two consultants or consulting groups. Our senior management is
located in the Seattle, Washington office.
WEBSITE ACCESS TO UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
REPORTS
We file annual and quarterly reports, proxy statements and other
information with the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC").
You may read and copy any document we file at the SEC's Public
Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington D.C. 20549. Please
call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the
public reference room. The SEC maintains a website at
http://www.sec.gov that contains reports, proxy and information
statements and other information concerning filers. We also
maintain a web site at http://www.visualant.net that provides
additional information about our Company and links to documents we
file with the SEC. The Company's charters for the Audit Committee,
the Compensation Committee, and the Nominating Committee; and the
Code of Conduct & Ethics are also available on our website. The
information on our website is not part of this Form
10-K.
ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS
There are certain inherent risks which will have an effect on the
Company’s development in the future and
the most
significant risks and uncertainties known and identified by our
management are described below.
We need additional financing to support our technology development
and ongoing operations, pay our debts and maintain ownership of our
intellectual properties.
We are currently operating at a loss. We believe that our cash on
hand will be sufficient to fund our operations through January 31,
2018.
We need additional
financing to implement our business plan and to service our ongoing
operations, pay our current debts (described below) and maintain
ownership of our intellectual property. There can be no assurance
that we will be able to secure any needed funding, or that if such
funding is available, the terms or conditions would be acceptable
to us. If we are unable to obtain additional financing when it is
needed, we will need to restructure our operations and/or divest
all or a portion of our business.
We may seek
additional capital through a combination of private and public
equity offerings, debt financings and strategic collaborations.
Debt financing, if obtained, may involve agreements that include
covenants limiting or restricting our ability to take specific
actions, such as incurring additional debt, and could increase our
expenses and require that our assets secure such debt. Equity
financing, if obtained, could result in dilution to our
then-existing stockholders and/or require such stockholders to
waive certain rights and preferences. If such financing is not
available on satisfactory terms, or is not available at all, we may
be required to delay, scale back, eliminate the development of
business opportunities or file for bankruptcy and our operations
and financial condition may be materially adversely
affected.
There
can there can be no assurance that we will be able to sell that
number of shares, if any.
We need to continue as a going concern if our business is to
succeed.
Because of our recurring losses and negative cash flows from
operations, the audit report of our independent registered public
accountants on our consolidated financial statements for the year
ended September 30, 2017 contains an explanatory paragraph stating
that there is substantial doubt about our ability to continue as a
going concern. Factors identified in the report include our
historical net losses, negative working capital, and the need for
additional financing to implement our business plan and service our
debt repayments. If we are not able to attain profitability in the
near future our financial condition could deteriorate further,
which would have a material adverse impact on our business and
prospects and result in a significant or complete loss of your
investment. Further, we may be unable to pay our debt obligations
as they become due, which include obligations to secured
creditors.
If we are unable to
continue as a going concern, we might have to liquidate our assets
and the values we receive for our assets in liquidation or
dissolution could be significantly lower than the values reflected
in our financial statements. Additionally, we are
subject to customary operational covenants, including limitations
on our ability to incur liens or additional debt, pay dividends,
redeem stock, make specified investments and engage in merger,
consolidation or asset sale transactions, among other restrictions.
In addition, the inclusion of an explanatory paragraph regarding
substantial doubt about our ability to continue as a going concern
and our lack of cash resources may materially adversely affect our
share price and our ability to raise new capital or to enter into
critical contractual relations with third
parties.
As of September 30, 2017, we have a net working capital deficit of
approximately $4,099,000 and if we do not satisfy these
obligations, the lenders may have the right to demand payment in
full or exercise other remedies.
We have a $199,935 Business Loan Agreement with Umpqua Bank. On
December 19, 2017, the Umpqua Loan maturity was extended to March
31, 2018 and provides for interest at 4.00% per year.
Related to this Umpqua Loan, we entered into a demand promissory
note for $200,000 on January 10, 2014 with an entity affiliated
with Ronald P. Erickson, our Chief Executive Officer. This demand
promissory note will be effective in case of a default by us under
the Umpqua Loan.
We also have two other demand promissory notes payable to entities
affiliated with Mr. Erickson, totaling $600,000. Each of these
notes were issued between January and July 2014, provide for
interest of 3% per year and now mature on December 31, 2017. The
notes payable also provide for a second lien on our assets if not
repaid by December 31, 2017 or converted into convertible
debentures or equity on terms acceptable to the Mr. Erickson. We
recorded accrued interest of $58,167 as of September 30,
2017.
Mr. Erickson and/or entities with which he is affiliated also have
advanced $519,833 and have unreimbursed expenses and compensation
of approximately $450,679. We owe Mr. Erickson, or entities with
which he is affiliated, $1,570,511 as of September 30,
2017.
We require additional financing, to service and/or repay these debt
obligations. If we raise additional capital through borrowing or
other debt financing, we may incur substantial interest expense. If
and when we raise more equity capital in the future, it will result
in substantial dilution to our current stockholders.
We have a history of operating losses and there can be no assurance
that we can achieve or maintain profitability.
We have experienced net losses since inception. As of September 30,
2017, we had an accumulated deficit of $31,534,000 and net losses
in the amount of $3,901,000 and $1,746,000 for the years ended
September 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively. There can be no
assurance that we will achieve or maintain
profitability.
If we achieve
profitability in the future, we may not be able to sustain
profitability in subsequent periods. Failure to become and remain
profitable would impair our ability to sustain operations and
adversely affect the price of our common stock and our ability to
raise capital. Our operating expenses may increase as we spend
resources on growing our business, and if our revenue does not
correspondingly increase, our operating results and financial
condition will suffer.
Our
ChromaID business has produced minimal revenues, and may not
produce significant revenues in the near term, or at all, which
would harm our ability to continue our operations or obtain
additional financing and require us to reduce or discontinue our
operations. You must consider our business and prospects in light
of the risks and difficulties we will encounter as business with an
early-stage technology in a new and rapidly evolving industry. We
may not be able to successfully address these risks and
difficulties, which could significantly harm our business,
operating results and financial condition.
If the company were to dissolve or wind-up operations, holders of
our common stock would not receive a liquidation
preference.
If we were to wind-up or dissolve our company and liquidate and
distribute our assets, our common stockholders would share in our
assets only after we satisfy any amounts we owe to our creditors
and preferred equity holders. If our liquidation or
dissolution were attributable to our inability to profitably
operate our business, then it is likely that we would have material
liabilities at the time of liquidation or
dissolution. Accordingly, it is very unlikely that
sufficient assets will remain available after the payment of our
creditors and preferred equity holders to enable common
stockholders to receive any liquidation distribution with respect
to any common stock.
We may not be able to generate sufficient revenue from the
commercialization of our ChromaID technology and related products
to achieve or sustain profitability.
We are in the early stages of commercializing our ChromaID™
technology. To date, we have entered into one License
Agreement with Sumitomo Precision Products Co., Ltd. and have a
strategic relationship with Allied Inventors. More recently, we
have entered into a
Collaboration Agreement and
License
with Intellicheck
Mobilisa, Inc. and BioMedx Inc. None of these relationships have
generated any significant revenue. Failure to develop and sell
products based upon our ChromaID technology, grant additional
licenses and obtain royalties or develop other revenue streams will
have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition
and results of operations.
To date, we have generated minimal revenue from sales of our
ChromaID products. We believe that our commercialization success is
dependent upon our ability to significantly increase the number of
customers that are using our products
.
In addition, demand for our ChromaID products may
not materialize, or increase as quickly as planned, and we may
therefore be unable to increase our revenue levels as expected. We
are currently not profitable
.
Even if we succeed in introducing the ChromaID
technology and related products to our target markets, we may not
be able to generate sufficient revenue to achieve or sustain
profitability.
We currently rely upon external resources for engineering and
product development services. If we are unable to secure an
engineering or product development partner or establish
satisfactory engineering and product development capabilities, we
may not be able to successfully commercialize our ChromaID
technology
.
Our
success depends upon our ability to develop products that are
accurate and provide solutions for our customers. Achieving the
desired results for our customers requires solving engineering
issues in concert with them. Any failure of our ChromaID technology
or related products to meet customer expectations could result in
customers choosing to retain their existing testing methods or to
adopt systems other than ours.
We do
not currently have internal resources which can work on engineering
and product development matters. We have used third parties in the
past and will continue to do so. Historically, our primary
third-party research, partner was RATLab LLC, a Seattle based
private research organization. As we move toward commercialization
of our ChromaID technology, the RATLab is no longer providing us
with these services.
On July 6, 2017,
we entered into a Consulting Agreement with Phil Bosua whereby Mr.
Bosua can earn up to 200,000 shares of the Company’s company
stock based on achieving certain product development and funding
milestones.
These resources are not always readily available
and the absence of their availability could inhibit our research
and development efforts and our responsiveness to our customers. We
have had internal engineering and product development resources in
the Company and plan to re-establish those resources in the future.
Our inability to secure those resources could impact our ability to
provide engineering and product development services and could have
an impact on our customers’ willingness to use our ChromaID
technology.
We are in the early stages of commercialization and our ChromaID
technology and related products may never achieve significant
commercial market acceptance.
Our success depends on our ability to develop and market products
that are recognized as accurate and cost-effective. Many of our
potential customers may be reluctant to use our new technology.
Market acceptance will depend on many factors, including our
ability to convince potential customers that our ChromaID
technology and related products are an attractive alternativeto
existing light-based technologies. We will need to demonstrate that
our products provide accurate and cost-effective alternatives to
existing light-based authentication technologies. Compared to most
competing technologies, our technology is relativelynew, and most
potential customers have limited knowledge of, or experience with,
our products. Prior to implementing our ChromaID technology and
related products, potential customers are required to devote
significant time and effort to testing and validating our products.
In addition, during the implementation phase, customers may be
required to devote significant time and effort to training their
personnel on appropriate practices to ensure accurate results from
our technology and products. Any failure of our ChromaID technology
or related products to meet customer expectations could result in
customers choosing to retain their existing testing methods or to
adopt systems other than ours.
Many factors influence the perception of a system including its use
by leaders in the industry. If we are unable to induce industry
leaders in our target markets to implement and use our ChromaID
technology and related products, acceptance and adoption of our
products could be slowed. In addition, if our products fail to gain
significant acceptance in the marketplace and we are unable to
expand our customer base, we may never generate sufficient revenue
to achieve or sustain profitability.
Our management has concluded that we have material weaknesses in
our internal controls over financial reporting and that our
disclosure controls and procedures are not effective.
A material weakness is a deficiency, or a combination of
deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such
that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement
of a company's annual or interim financial statements will not be
prevented or detected on a timely basis. During the audit of our
financial statements for the year ended September 30, 2017, our
management identified material weaknesses in our internal control
over financial reporting. If these weaknesses continue, investors
could lose confidence in the accuracy and completeness of our
financial reports and other disclosures.
In addition, our management has concluded that our disclosure
controls and procedures were not effective due to the lack of an
audit committee “financial expert.”
These material
weaknesses, if not remediated, create an increased risk of
misstatement of the Company’s financial results, which, if
material, may require future restatement thereof. A failure to
implement improved internal controls, or difficulties encountered
in their implementation or execution, could cause future delays in
our reporting obligations and could have a negative effect on us
and the trading price of our common stock.
Our services and license agreement with Allied Inventors is
important to our business strategy and operations.
In November 2013, we entered into a five year strategic
relationship with Allied Inventors, formerly Xinova and Invention
Development Management Company, a former subsidiary of Intellectual
Ventures, a private intellectual property fund with over $5 billion
under management.
Allied Inventors
owns over 40,000 IP assets and has broad global
relationships for the invention of technology, the filing of
patents and the licensing of intellectual property. Allied
Inventors has worked to expand the reach and the potential
application of the ChromaID technology and has filed ten patents
base on the ChromaID technology, which it has licensed to
us.
The amended agreement with Allied Inventors covers a number of
areas that are important to our operations, including the
following:
●
The
agreement requires Allied Inventors to identify and engage
inventors to develop new applications of our ChromaID technology,
present the developments to us for approval, and file at least ten
patent applications to protect the developments;
●
We
received a worldwide, nontransferable, exclusive license to the
licensed intellectual property developed under this agreement
within the identification, authentication and diagnostics field of
use;
●
We
received a nonexclusive and nontransferable option to acquire a
worldwide, nontransferable, nonexclusive license to intellectual
property held by Allied Inventors within that same field of use;
and
●
We
granted to Allied Inventors certain licenses to our intellectual
property outside the identification, authentication and diagnostics
field of use.
Failure to operate in accordance with the Allied Inventors
agreement, or an early termination or cancellation of this
agreement for any reason,
would have a material adverse effect on ability to
execute our business strategy and on our results of operations and
business.
If components used in our finished products become unavailable, or
third-party manufacturers otherwise experience delays, we may incur
delays in shipment to our customers, which would damage our
business.
We depend on third-party suppliers for substantially all of our
components and products. We purchase these products and components
from third-party suppliers that serve the advanced lighting systems
market and we believe that alternative sources of supply are
readily available for most products and components. However,
consolidation could result in one or more current suppliers being
acquired by a competitor, rendering us unable to continue
purchasing necessary amounts of key components at competitive
prices. In addition, for certain of our customized components,
arrangements for additional or replacement suppliers will take time
and result in delays. We purchase products and components pursuant
to purchase orders placed from time to time in the ordinary course
of business. This means we are vulnerable to unanticipated price
increases and product shortages. Any interruption or delay in the
supply of components and products, or our inability to obtain
components and products from alternate sources at acceptable prices
in a timely manner, could harm our business, financial condition
and results of operations.
While we believe alternative manufacturers for these products are
available, we have selected these particular manufacturers based on
their ability to consistently produce these products per our
specifications ensuring the best quality product at the most cost
effective price. We depend on our third-party manufacturers to
satisfy performance and quality specifications and to dedicate
sufficient production capacity within scheduled delivery times.
Accordingly, the loss of all or one of these manufacturers or
delays in obtaining shipments could have a material adverse effect
on our operations until such time as an alternative manufacturer
could be found.
We are dependent on key personnel.
Our success depends to a significant degree upon the continued
contributions of key management and other personnel, some of whom
could be difficult to replace, including Ronald P. Erickson, our
Chief Executive Officer. We do not maintain key person life
insurance covering any of our officers. Our success will depend on
the performance of our officers, our ability to retain and motivate
our officers, our ability to integrate new officers into our
operations, and the ability of all personnel to work together
effectively as a team. Our officers do not currently
have employment agreements. Our failure to retain and
recruit officers and other key personnel could have a material
adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of
operations.
Our success also
depends on our continued ability to identify, attract, hire, train,
retain and motivate highly skilled technical, managerial,
manufacturing, administrative and sales and marketing personnel.
Competition for these individuals is intense, and we may not be
able to successfully recruit, assimilate or retain sufficiently
qualified personnel. In particular, we may encounter difficulties
in recruiting and retaining a sufficient number of qualified
technical personnel, which could harm our ability to develop new
products and adversely impact our relationships with existing and
future customers. The inability to attract and retain necessary
technical, managerial, manufacturing, administrative and sales and
marketing personnel could harm our ability to obtain new customers
and develop new products and could adversely affect our business
and operating results.
We have limited insurance which may not cover claims by third
parties against us or our officers and directors.
We have limited directors’ and officers’ liability
insurance and commercial liability insurance policies. Claims by
third parties against us may exceed policy amounts and we may not
have amounts to cover these claims. Any significant claims would
have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition
and results of operations. In addition, our limited
directors’ and officers’ liability insurance may affect
our ability to attract and retain directors and
officers.
Our inability to effectively protect our intellectual property
would adversely affect our ability to compete effectively, our
revenue, our financial condition and our results of
operations.
We rely on a combination of patent, trademark, and trade secret
laws, confidentiality procedures and licensing arrangements to
protect our intellectual property rights.
Obtaining and
maintaining a strong patent position is important to our business.
Patent law relating to the scope of claims in the technology fields
in which we operate is complex and uncertain, so we cannot be
assured that we will be able to obtain or maintain patent rights,
or that the patent rights we may obtain will be valuable, provide
an effective barrier to competitors or otherwise provide
competitive advantages. Others have filed, and in the future are
likely to file, patent applications thatare similar or identical to
ours or those of our licensors. To determine the priority of
inventions, or demonstrate that we did not derive our invention
from another, we may have to participate in interference or
derivation proceedings in the USPTO or in court that could result
in substantial costs in legal fees and could substantially affect
the scope of our patent protection. We cannot be assured our patent
applications will prevail over those filed by others. Also, our
intellectual property rights may be subject to other challenges by
third parties. Patents we obtain could be challenged in litigation
or in administrative proceedings such as
ex parte
reexam,
inter parties
review,
or post grant review in the United States or opposition proceedings
in Europe or other jurisdictions.
There can be no assurance that:
●
|
any of our existing patents will continue to be held valid, if
challenged;
|
●
|
patents will be issued for any of our pending
applications;
|
●
|
any claims allowed from existing or pending patents will have
sufficient scope or strength to protect us;
|
●
|
our patents will be issued in the primary countries where our
products are sold in order to protect our rights
and potential commercial advantage;
or
|
●
|
any of our products or technologies will not infringe on the
patents of other companies.
|
If we are enjoined from selling our products, or if we are required
to develop new technologies or pay significant monetary damages or
are required to make substantial royalty payments, our business and
results of operations would be harmed.
Obtaining and maintaining a patent portfolio entails significant
expense and resources. Part of the expense includes periodic
maintenance fees, renewal fees, annuity fees, various other
governmental fees on patents and/or applications due in several
stages over the lifetime of patents and/or applications, as well as
the cost associated with complying with numerous procedural
provisions during the patent application process. We may or may not
choose to pursue or maintain protection for particular inventions.
In addition, there are situations in which failure to make certain
payments or noncompliance with certain requirements in the patent
process can result in abandonment or lapse of a patent or patent
application, resulting in partial or complete loss of patent rights
in the relevant jurisdiction. If we choose to forgo patent
protection or allow a patent application or patent to lapse
purposefully or inadvertently, our competitive position could
suffer.
Legal actions to enforce our patent rights can be expensive and may
involve the diversion of significant management time. In addition,
these legal actions could be unsuccessful and could also result in
the invalidation of our patents or a finding that they are
unenforceable.We may or may not choose to pursue litigation or
interferences against those that have infringed on our patents, or
used them without authorization, due to the associated expense and
time commitment of monitoring these activities. If we fail to
protect or to enforce our intellectual property rights
successfully, our competitive position could suffer, which could
have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and
business.
Claims by others that our products infringe their patents or other
intellectual property rights could prevent us from manufacturing
and selling some of our products or require us to pay royalties or
incur substantial costs from litigation or development of
non-infringing technology.
In recent years, there has been significant litigation in the
United States involving patents and other intellectual property
rights. We may receive notices that claim we have infringed upon
the intellectual property of others. Even if these claims are not
valid, they could subject us to significant costs. Any such claims,
with or without merit, could be time-consuming to defend, result in
costly litigation, divert our attention and resources, cause
product shipment delays or require us to enter into royalty or
licensing agreements. Such royalty or licensing agreements, if
required, may not be available on terms acceptable to us or at all.
We have engaged in litigation and litigation may be necessary in
the future to enforce our intellectual property rights or to
determine the validity and scope of the proprietary rights of
others. Litigation may also be necessary to defend against claims
of infringement or invalidity by others. A successful claim of
intellectual property infringement against us and our failure or
inability to license the infringed technology or develop or license
technology with comparable functionality could have a material
adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating
results.
Our
TransTech vendor base is concentrated.
Evolis, Fargo, Ultra Electronics - Magicard Division and NiSCA, are
major vendors of TransTech whose products account for approximately
61% of TransTech’s revenue. TransTech buys, packages and
distributes products from these vendors after issuing purchase
orders. Any loss of any of these vendors would have a material
adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of
operations.
We currently have a very small sales and marketing organization. If
we are unable to secure a sales and marketing partner or establish
satisfactory sales and marketing capabilities, we may not be able
to successfully commercialize our ChromaID technology.
We currently have one full-time sales and business development
manager for the ChromaID technology. This individual oversees sales
of our products and IP licensing and manages critical customer and
partner relationships. In addition, he
manages and coordinates the business
development resources at our strategic partners Allied Inventors
and Sumitomo Precision Products as they relate to our ChromaID
technology.
We also work with third
party entities that are focused in specific market verticals where
they have business relationships that can be leveraged. Our
subsidiary, TransTech Systems, has six sales and marketing
employees on staff to support the ongoing sales efforts of that
business. In order to commercialize products that are approved for
commercial sales, we sell directly to our customers, collaborate
with third parties that have such commercial infrastructure and
work with our strategic business partners to generate sales. If we
are not successful entering into appropriate collaboration
arrangements, or recruiting sales and marketing personnel or in
building a sales and marketing infrastructure, we will have
difficulty successfully commercializing our ChromaID technology,
which would adversely affect our business, operating results and
financial condition.
We may not be able to enter into collaboration agreements on terms
acceptable to us or at all. In addition, even if we enter into such
relationships, we may have limited or no control over the sales,
marketing and distribution activities of these third parties. Our
future revenues may depend heavily on the success of the efforts of
these third parties. If we elect to establish a sales and marketing
infrastructure we may not realize a positive return on this
investment. In addition, we must compete with established and
well-funded pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies to recruit,
hire, train and retain sales and marketing personnel. Factors that
may inhibit our efforts to commercialize ChromaID without strategic
partners or licensees include:
●
|
our
inability to recruit and retain adequate numbers of effective sales
and marketing personnel;
|
●
|
the
lack of complementary products to be offered by sales personnel,
which may put us at a competitive disadvantage relative to
companies with more extensive product lines; and
|
●
|
unforeseen
costs and expenses associated with creating an independent sales
and marketing organization.
|
Government regulatory approval may be necessary before some of our
products can be sold and there is no assurance such approval will
be granted.
Although we do not need regulatory approval for our current
applications, our ChromaID technology may have a number of
potential applications in fields of use which will require prior
governmental regulatory approval before the technology can be
introduced to the marketplace. For example, we are exploring the
use of our ChromaID technology for certain medical diagnostic
applications. There is no assurance that we will be
successful in developing medical applications for our ChromaID
technology. If we were to be successful in developing medical
applications of our technology, prior approval by the FDA and other
governmental regulatory bodies may be required before the
technology could be introduced into the marketplace. There is
no assurance that such regulatory approval would be obtained for a
medical diagnostic or other applications requiring such
approval.
We may engage in
acquisitions, mergers, strategic alliances, joint ventures and
divestures that could result in final results that are different
than expected
.
In the normal course of business, we engage in discussions relating
to possible acquisitions, equity investments, mergers, strategic
alliances, joint ventures and divestitures. Such transactions are
accompanied by a number of risks, including the use of significant
amounts of cash, potentially dilutive issuances of equity
securities,
incurrence of
debt on potentially unfavorable terms as well as impairment
expenses related to goodwill and amortization expenses related to
other intangible assets, the possibility that we may pay too much
cash or issue too many of our shares as the purchase price for an
acquisition relative to the economic benefits that we ultimately
derive from such acquisition, and various potential difficulties
involved in integrating acquired businesses into our
operations.
From time to time, we have also engaged in discussions with
candidates regarding the potential acquisitions of our product
lines, technologies and businesses. If a divestiture such as this
does occur, we cannot be certain that our business, operating
results and financial condition will not be materially and
adversely affected. A successful divestiture depends on various
factors, including our ability to effectively transfer liabilities,
contracts, facilities and employees to any purchaser; identify and
separate the intellectual property to be divested from the
intellectual property that we wish to retain; reduce fixed costs
previously associated with the divested assets or business; and
collect the proceeds from any divestitures.
If we do not realize the expected benefits of any acquisition or
divestiture transaction, our financial position, results of
operations, cash flows and stock price could be negatively
impacted.
Our growth strategy depends in part on our ability to execute
successful strategic acquisitions. We have made strategic
acquisitions in the past and may do so in the future, and if the
acquired companies do not perform as expected, this could adversely
affect our operating results, financial condition and existing
business.
We may continue to expand our business through strategic
acquisitions. The success of any acquisition will depend on, among
other things:
|
●
|
the
availability of suitable candidates;
|
|
●
|
higher
than anticipated acquisition costs and expenses;
|
|
●
|
competition
from other companies for the purchase of available
candidates;
|
|
●
|
our
ability to value those candidates accurately and negotiate
favorable terms for those acquisitions;
|
|
●
|
the
availability of funds to finance acquisitions and obtaining any
consents necessary under our credit facility;
|
|
●
|
the
ability to establish new informational, operational and financial
systems to meet the needs of our business;
|
|
●
|
the
ability to achieve anticipated synergies, including with respect to
complementary products or services; and
|
|
●
|
the
availability of management resources to oversee the integration and
operation of the acquired businesses.
|
We may not be successful in effectively integrating acquired
businesses and completing acquisitions in the future. We also may
incur substantial expenses and devote significant management time
and resources in seeking to complete acquisitions. Acquired
businesses may fail to meet our performance expectations. If we do
not achieve the anticipated benefits of an acquisition as rapidly
as expected, or at all, investors or analysts may not perceive the
same benefits of the acquisition as we do. If these risks
materialize, our stock price could be materially adversely
affected.
We are subject to corporate governance and internal control
requirements, and our costs related to compliance with, or our
failure to comply with existing and future requirements could
adversely affect our business.
We must comply with corporate governance requirements under the
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the Dodd–Frank Wall Street
Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010, as well as additional
rules and regulations currently in place and that may be
subsequently adopted by the SEC and the Public Company Accounting
Oversight Board. These laws, rules, and regulations continue to
evolve and may become increasingly stringent in the future. The
financial cost of compliance with these laws, rules, and
regulations is expected to remain substantial.
Our management has concluded that our disclosure controls and
procedures were not effective due to the lack of an audit committee
“financial expert.” We expect to appoint an additional
independent director to serve as Audit Committee Chairman. This
director will be an “audit committee financial expert”
as defined by the SEC. However, we cannot assure you that we will
be able to fully comply with these laws, rules, and regulations
that address corporate governance, internal control reporting, and
similar matters in the future. Failure to comply with these laws,
rules and regulations could materially adversely affect our
reputation, financial condition, and the value of our
securities.
The Capital Source credit facility contains
covenants that may limit our flexibility in operating our business
and failure to comply with any of these covenants could have a
material adverse effect on our business
.
In December 8, 2009, we entered into the Capital Source credit
facility.
On June 6, 2017, TransTech entered into the Fourth
Modification to the Loan and Security Agreement.
This Capital Source credit facility contains covenants that limit
our ability to engage in specified types of transactions. These
covenants limit our ability to, among other things:
|
●
|
sell,
transfer, lease or dispose of certain assets;
|
|
●
|
engage
in certain mergers and consolidations;
|
|
●
|
incur
debt or encumber or permit liens on certain assets, except in the
limited circumstances permitted under the loan and security
agreements;
|
|
●
|
make
certain restricted payments, including paying dividends on, or
repurchasing or making distributions with respect to, our common
stock; and
|
|
●
|
enter
into certain transactions with affiliates.
|
A breach of any of the covenants under the Capital Source credit
facility could result in a default under the Capital Source credit
facility. Upon the occurrence of an event of default under the
Capital Source credit facility, the lenders could elect to declare
all amounts outstanding to be immediately due and payable and
terminate all commitments to extend further credit. If we are
unable to repay those amounts, the lenders could proceed against
the collateral granted to them to secure such
indebtedness.
The exercise prices of certain warrants and the Series A and C
Preferred Shares may require further adjustment.
In the
future, if we sell our common stock at a price below $0.25 per
share, the exercise price
of 23,334
outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Stock, 1,785,715
outstanding shares of Series C Preferred Stock and 1,016,004
outstanding shares Series D preferred Stock, would adjust below
$0.25 per share pursuant to the documents governing such
instruments. In addition, the conversion price of a Convertible
Note Payable of $570,000 and the exercise price of outstanding
warrants to purchase 3,782,616 shares of common stock would adjust
below $0.25 per share pursuant to the documents governing such
instruments.
Risks Relating to Our Stock
The price of our
common stock is volatile, which may cause investment losses for our
stockholders
.
The market price of our common stock has been and is likely in the
future to be volatile. Our common stock price may fluctuate in
response to factors such as:
|
●
|
Announcements by us regarding liquidity, significant acquisitions,
equity investments and divestitures,
strategic relationships, addition or loss of
significant customers and contracts, capital expenditure
commitments and
litigation;
|
|
●
|
Issuance of convertible or equity securities and related warrants
for general or merger and acquisition purposes;
|
|
●
|
Issuance or repayment of debt, accounts payable or convertible debt
for general or merger and acquisition
purposes;
|
|
●
|
Sale of a significant number of shares of our common stock by
stockholders;
|
|
●
|
General market and economic conditions;
|
|
●
|
Quarterly variations in our operating results;
|
|
●
|
Investor and public relation activities;
|
|
●
|
Announcements of technological innovations;
|
|
●
|
New product introductions by us or our competitors;
|
|
●
|
Competitive activities; and
|
|
●
|
Additions or departures of key personnel.
|
These broad market and industry factors may have a material adverse
effect on the market price of our common stock, regardless of our
actual operating performance. These factors could have a material
adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of
operations.
Transfers of our securities may be restricted by virtue of state
securities “blue sky” laws, which prohibit trading
absent compliance with individual state laws. These restrictions
may make it difficult or impossible to sell shares in those
states.
Transfers of our common stock may be restricted under the
securities or securities regulations laws promulgated by various
states and foreign jurisdictions, commonly referred to as "blue
sky" laws. Absent compliance with such individual state laws, our
common stock may not be traded in such jurisdictions. Because the
securities held by many of our stockholders have not been
registered for resale under the blue sky laws of any state, the
holders of such shares and persons who desire to purchase them
should be aware that there may be significant state blue sky law
restrictions upon the ability of investors to sell the securities
and of purchasers to purchase the securities. These restrictions
may prohibit the secondary trading of our common stock. Investors
should consider the secondary market for our securities to be a
limited one.
Two individual
investors could have significant influence over matters submitted
to stockholders for approval
.
As of September 30, 2017, two individuals in the aggregate,
assuming the exercise of all warrants to purchase common stock,
hold shares representing approximately 80% of our common stock on a
fully-converted basis and could be considered a control group for
purposes of SEC rules. However, the agreement with one of these
individuals limits his ownership to 4.99% individually. Beneficial
ownership includes shares over which an individual or entity has
investment or voting power and includes shares that could be issued
upon the exercise of options and warrants within 60 days after the
date of determination. If these persons were to choose to act
together, they would be able to significantly influence all matters
submitted to our stockholders for approval, as well as our
officers, directors, management and affairs. For example, these
persons, if they choose to act together, could significantly
influence the election of directors and approval of any merger,
consolidation or sale of all or substantially all of our assets.
This concentration of voting power could delay or prevent an
acquisition of us on terms that other stockholders may
desire.
The sale of a significant number of our shares of common stock
could depress the price of our common stock.
Sales or issuances of a large number of shares of common stock in
the public market or the perception that sales may occur could
cause the market price of our common stock to decline. As of
September 30, 2017, we had 4,655,486 shares of common stock issued
and outstanding, held by 66 stockholders of record. The number of
stockholders, including beneficial owners holding shares through
nominee names, is approximately 2,300. Each share of common stock
entitles its holder to one vote on each matter submitted to the
stockholders for a vote, and no cumulative voting for directors is
permitted. Stockholders do not have any preemptive
rights to acquire additional securities issued by
us.
As of September
30, 2017, there were options outstanding for the purchase of 15,404
common shares, warrants for the purchase of 6,900,356 common
shares, 2,825,053 shares of our common stock issuable upon the
conversion of Series A, Series C and Series D Convertible Preferred
Stock and up to 332,940 shares of our common stock issuable upon
the exercise of placement agent warrants. In addition, we have an
unknown number of shares are issuable upon conversion of
convertible debentures of $570,000. All of which could potentially
dilute future earnings per share.
Significant shares of common stock are held by our principal
stockholders, other company insiders and other large stockholders.
As “affiliates” of Visualant, as defined under
Securities and Exchange Commission Rule 144 under the Securities
Act of 1933, our principal stockholders, other of our insiders and
other large stockholders may only sell their shares of common stock
in the public market pursuant to an effective registration
statement or in compliance with Rule 144.
These options, warrants, convertible notes payable and convertible
preferred stock could result in further dilution to common stock
holders and may affect the market price of the common
stock.
Future issuance of
additional shares of
common stock and/or preferred stock could dilute existing
stockholders.
We have and may
issue preferred stock that could have rights that are preferential
to the rights of common stock that could discourage potentially
beneficially transactions to our common
stockholders.
Pursuant to our certificate of incorporation, we currently have
authorized 100,000,000 shares of common stock and 5,000,000 shares
of preferred stock. To the extent that common shares are available
for issuance, subject to compliance with applicable stock exchange
listing rules, our board of directors has the ability to issue
additional shares of common stock in the future for such
consideration as the board of directors may consider sufficient.
The issuance of any additional securities could, among other
things, result in substantial dilution of the percentage ownership
of our stockholders at the time of issuance, result in substantial
dilution of our earnings per share and adversely affect the
prevailing market price for our common stock.
An issuance of additional shares of preferred stock could result in
a class of outstanding securities that would have preferences with
respect to voting rights and dividends and in liquidation over our
common stock and could, upon conversion or otherwise, have all of
the rights of our common stock. Our Board of Directors'
authority to issue preferred stock could discourage potential
takeover attempts or could delay or prevent a change in control
through merger, tender offer, proxy contest or otherwise by making
these attempts more difficult or costly to achieve. The
issuance of preferred stock could impair the voting, dividend and
liquidation rights of common stockholders without their
approval.
Future capital raises may dilute our existing stockholders’
ownership and/or have other adverse effects on our
operations.
If we
raise additional capital by issuing equity securities, our existing
stockholders’ percentage ownership will be reduced and these
stockholders may experience substantial dilution. We may also issue
equity securities that provide for rights, preferences and
privileges senior to those of our common stock. If we raise
additional funds by issuing debt securities, these debt securities
would have rights senior to those of our common stock and the terms
of the debt securities issued could impose significant restrictions
on our operations, including liens on our assets. If we raise
additional funds through collaborations and licensing arrangements,
we may be required to relinquish some rights to our technologies or
candidate products, or to grant licenses on terms that are not
favorable to us.
We do not anticipate paying any cash dividends on our capital stock
in the foreseeable future.
We have never declared or paid cash dividends on our capital stock.
We currently intend to retain all of our future earnings, if any,
to finance the growth and development of our business, and we do
not anticipate paying any cash dividends on our capital stock in
the foreseeable future. In addition, the terms of any future debt
agreements may preclude us from paying dividends. As a result,
capital appreciation, if any, of our common stock will be your sole
source of gain for the foreseeable future.
Anti-takeover provisions may limit the ability of another party to
acquire our company, which could cause our stock price to
decline.
Our certificate of incorporation, as amended, our bylaws and Nevada
law contain provisions that could discourage, delay or prevent a
third party from acquiring our company, even if doing so may be
beneficial to our stockholders. In addition, these provisions could
limit the price investors would be willing to pay in the future for
shares of our common stock.
Our articles of incorporation allow for our board to create new
series of preferred stock without further approval by our
stockholders, which could adversely affect the rights of the
holders of our common stock; our Series A Preferred Stock contains
provisions that restrict our ability to take certain actions
without the consent of at least 66% of the Series A Preferred Stock
then outstanding.
Our Board of Directors has the authority to fix and determine the
relative rights and preferences of preferred stock. Our Board of
Directors also has the authority to issue preferred stock without
further stockholder approval. As a result, our Board of Directors
could authorize the issuance of a series of preferred stock that
would grant to holders the preferred right to our assets upon
liquidation, the right to receive dividend payments before
dividends are distributed to the holders of common stock and the
right to the redemption of the shares, together with a premium,
prior to the redemption of our common stock. In addition, our Board
of Directors could authorizethe issuance of a series of preferred
stock that has greater voting power than our common stock or that
is convertible into our common stock, which could decrease the
relative voting power of our common stock or result in dilution to
our existing stockholders.
In addition, our articles of incorporation restrict our ability to
take certain actions without the approval of at least 66% of the
Series A Preferred Stock then outstanding. These actions include,
among other things;
●
authorizing,
creating, designating, establishing or issuing an increased number
of shares of Series A Preferred Stock or any other class or series
of capital stock ranking senior to or on a parity with the Series A
Preferred Stock;
●
adopting
a plan for the liquidation, dissolution or winding up the affairs
of our company or any recapitalization plan (whether by merger,
consolidation or otherwise);
●
amending,
altering or repealing, whether by merger, consolidation or
otherwise, our articles of incorporation or bylaws in a manner that
would adversely affect any right, preference, privilege or voting
power of the Series A Preferred Stock; and
●
declaring
or paying any dividend (with certain exceptions) or directly or
indirectly purchase, redeem, repurchase or otherwise acquire any
shares of our capital stock, stock options or convertible
securities (with certain exceptions).
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None.
ITEM 2. PROPERTIES
Corporate Offices
On April 13, 2017, the Company leased its executive office located
at 500 Union Street, Suite 810, Seattle, Washington, USA, 98101.
The Company leases 943 square feet and the net monthly payment is
$2,672. The monthly payment increases approximately 3% each year
and the lease expires on May 31, 2022.
TransTech Facilities
TransTech is located at 12142 NE Sky Lane, Suite 130, Aurora, OR
97002. TransTech leases a total of approximately 6,340 square feet
of office and warehouse space for its administrative offices,
product inventory and shipping operations. Effective December 1,
2017, TransTech leases this office from December 1, 2017 at $4,465
per month. The monthly payment increases approximately 3% each year
and the lease expires on January 31, 2020. Until December 1, 2017,
TransTech leased this office on a month to month basis at $6,942
per month.
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
We may
from time to time become a party to various legal proceedings
arising in the ordinary course of our business. We are currently
not a party to any pending legal proceeding that is not ordinary
routine litigation incidental to our business.
ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY
DISCLOSURES
This item is not applicable.
ITEM 5. OTHER INFORMATION
This item is not applicable.
PART II
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S
COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF
EQUITY SECURITIES
Authorized Capital Stock
We have
authorized 105,000,000 shares of capital stock, of which
100,000,000 are shares of voting common stock, par value $0.001 per
share, and 5,000,000 are shares of preferred stock, par value
$0.001 per share.
Voting Preferred Stock
We are authorized to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of preferred
stock with a par value of $0.001.
Series A Preferred Stock
On July 21, 2015, we filed with the Nevada Secretary of State an
Amended and Restated Certificate of Designations, Preferences and
Rights for our Series A Convertible Preferred Stock. Among other
things, the Amended and Restated Certificate changed the conversion
price and the stated value of the Series A Preferred from $0.10
(pre reverse stock split) to $30.00 (post-reverse stock split), and
added a provision adjusting the conversion price upon the
occurrence of certain events.
Under
the Amended and Restated Certificate, we had 11,667 shares of
Series A Preferred authorized, all of which are outstanding. Each
holder of outstanding shares of Series A Preferred is entitled to
the number of votes equal to the number of whole shares of common
stock into which the shares of Series A Preferred held by such
holder are then convertible as of the applicable record date. We
cannot amend, alter or repeal any preferences, rights, or other
terms of the Series A Preferred so as to adversely affect the
Series A Preferred, without the written consent or affirmativevote
of the holders of at least 66% of the then outstanding shares of
Series A Preferred, voting as a separate voting group, given by
written consent or by vote at a meeting called for such purpose for
which notice shall have been duly given to the holders of the
Series A Preferred.
During
the year ended September 30, 2015, we sold 11,667 Series A
Preferred Stock to two investors totaling $350,000. These shares
are expected to be convertible into 11,667 shares of common stock
at $30.00 per share, subject to adjustment, for a period of five
years. The Series A Preferred Stock has voting rights
and may not be redeemed without the consent of the
holder.
We also
issued (i) a Series C five-year Warrant for 23,334 shares of common
stock at an exercise price of $30.00 per share, which is callable
at $60.00 per share; and (ii) a Series D five-year Warrant for
23,334 shares of common stock at an exercise price of $45.00 per
share, which is callable at $90.00 per share. The Series A
Preferred Stock and Series C and D Warrants had registration
rights.
On July 20, 2015, the two investors entered into an Amendment to
Series A Preferred Stock Terms whereby they agreed to the terms of
the
Amended and Restated Certificate of Designations,
Preferences and Rights of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock and
waived all registration rights.
On
August 4, 2016, the price of the
Series A Preferred Stock
was adjusted to
$0.70 per share due to the issuance of common stock at that
price.
On
March 8, 2016, we received approval from the State of Nevada for
the Correction to the Company’s Amended and Restated
Certificate of Designations, Preferences and Rights of its Series A
Convertible Preferred Stock. The Amended and Restated Certificate
filed July 21, 2015 changed the conversion price and the stated
value from $0.10 (pre reverse stock split) to $30.00 (post-reverse
stock split), and adding a provision adjusting the conversion price
upon the occurrence of certain events. On February 19, 2016, the
holders of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock entered into
Amendment 2 of Series A Preferred Stock Terms and increased the
number of Preferred Stock Shares to properly account for the
reverse stock split. We have 23,334 Series A Preferred Stock issued
and outstanding.
On August 14, 2017,
the price of the
Series A Preferred Stock
and Series C
Warrants were adjusted to $0.25 per share
pursuant to the documents governing such
instruments.
Series C and D Preferred Stock and Warrants
On
August 5, 2016, we closed a Series C Preferred Stock and Warrant
Purchase Agreement with Clayton A. Struve, an accredited investor
for the purchase of $1,250,000 of preferred stock with a conversion
price of $0.70 per share. The preferred stock has a yield of 8% and
an ownership blocker of 4.99%. In addition, Mr. Struve received a
five year warrant to acquire 1,785,714 shares of common stock at
$0.70 per share.
On
November 14, 2016, we issued 187,500 shares of Series D Convertible
Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 187,500 shares of common
stock in a private placement to certain accredited investors for
gross proceeds of $150,000 pursuant to a Series D Preferred Stock
and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated November 10,
2016.
On
December 19, 2016, we issued 187,500 shares of Series D Convertible
Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 187,500 shares of common
stock in a private placement to an accredited investor for gross
proceeds of $150,000 pursuant to a Series D Preferred Stock and
Warrant Purchase Agreement dated December 14, 2016.
On May 1, 2017, the Company issued 357,143 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 357,143
shares of common stock in a private placement to an accredited
investor for gross proceeds of $250,000 pursuant to a Series D
Preferred Stock and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated May 1,
2016.
The initial conversion price of the Series D Shares is $0.70 per
share, subject to certain adjustments. The initial exercise price
of the warrant is $0.70 per share, also subject to certain
adjustments. The Company also amended and restated the Certificate
of Designation for the Series D Shares, resulting in an adjustment
to the conversion price of all currently outstanding Series D
Shares to $0.70 per share.
On August 14, 2017,
the price of the
Series D Convertible Preferred Stock and a
warrant
were adjusted to $0.25 per share
pursuant to the documents governing such
instruments.
Common Stock
We are authorized to issue up to 100,000,000 shares of common stock
with a par value of $0.001. As of September 30, 2017, we had
4,655,486 shares of common stock issued and outstanding, held by 66
shareholders of record. The number of shareholders, including
beneficial owners holding shares through nominee names, is
approximately 2,300. Each share of common stock entitles its holder
to one vote on each matter submitted to the shareholders for a
vote, and no cumulative voting for directors is
permitted. Shareholders do not have any preemptive
rights to acquire additional securities issued by us. As
of September 30, 2017, there were options outstanding for the
purchase of 15,404 common shares, warrants for the purchase of
6,900,356 common shares, 2,825,053 shares of our common stock
issuable upon the conversion of Series A, Series C and Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and up to 332,940 shares of our common
stock issuable upon the exercise of placement agent warrants. In
addition, we have convertible debentures of $570,000. All of which
could potentially dilute future earnings per share.
American Stock Transfer and Trust Company is the transfer agent and
registrar for our Common Stock.
Stock Incentive Plan
On April 29, 2011, our 2011 Stock Incentive Plan was approved at
the Annual Stockholder Meeting. We were authorized to issue options
for, and has reserved for issuance, up to 46,667 shares of
common stock under the 2011 Stock Incentive Plan. On March 21,
2013, an amendment to the Stock Option Plan was approved by the
stockholders of the Company, increasing the number of shares
reserved for issuance under the Plan to 93,333 shares.
Anti-Takeover Provisions
Nevada Revised Statutes
Acquisition of Controlling Interest
Statutes
. Nevada's "acquisition of
controlling interest" statutes contain provisions governing the
acquisition of a controlling interest in certain Nevada
corporations. These "control share" laws provide generally that any
person who acquires a "controlling interest" in certain Nevada
corporations may be denied certain voting rights, unless a majority
of the disinterested stockholders of the corporation elects to
restore such voting rights. These statutes provide that a person
acquires a "controlling interest" whenever a person acquires shares
of a subject corporation that, but for the application of these
provisions of the Nevada Revised Statutes, would enable that person
to exercise (1) one-fifth or more, but less than one-third,
(2) one-third or more, but less than a majority or (3) a
majority or more, of all of the voting power of the corporation in
the election of directors. Once an acquirer crosses one of these
thresholds, shares which it acquired in the transaction taking it
over the threshold and within the 90 days immediately
preceding the date when the acquiring person acquired or offered to
acquire a controlling interest become "control shares" to which the
voting restrictions described above apply. Our articles of
incorporation and bylaws currently contain no provisions relating
to these statutes, and unless our articles of incorporation or
bylaws in effect on the tenth day after the acquisition of a
controlling interest were to provide otherwise, these laws would
apply to us if we were to (i) have 200 or more stockholders of
record (at least 100 of which have addresses in the State of Nevada
appearing on our stock ledger) and (ii) do business in the
State of Nevada directly or through an affiliated corporation. As
of September 30, 2017 we have less than 200 record stockholders. If
these laws were to apply to us, they might discourage companies or
persons interested in acquiring a significant interest in or
control of the company, regardless of whether such acquisition may
be in the interest of our stockholders.
Combinations with Interested Stockholders
Statutes
. Nevada's "combinations with
interested stockholders" statutes prohibit certain business
"combinations" between certain Nevada corporations and any person
deemed to be an "interested stockholder" for two years after the
such person first becomes an "interested stockholder" unless
(i) the corporation's board of directors approves the
combination (or the transaction by which such person becomes an
"interested stockholder") in advance, or (ii) the combination
is approved by the board of directors and sixty percent of the
corporation's voting power not beneficially owned by the interested
stockholder, its affiliates and associates. Furthermore, in the
absence of prior approval certain restrictions may apply even after
such two-year period. For purposes of these statutes, an
"interested stockholder" is any person who is (x) the
beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of ten percent or more of
the voting power of the outstanding voting shares of the
corporation, or (y) an affiliate or associate of the
corporation and at any time within the two previous years was the
beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of ten percent or more of
the voting power of the then outstanding shares of the corporation.
The definition of the term "combination" is sufficiently broad to
cover most significant transactions between the corporation and an
"interested stockholder". Subject to certain timing requirements
set forth in the statutes, a corporation may elect not to be
governed by these statutes. We have not included any such provision
in our articles of incorporation.
The
effect of these statutes may be to potentially discourage parties
interested in taking control of us from doing so if it cannot
obtain the approval of our Board of Directors.
Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws Provisions
Our
articles of incorporation, as amended and restated, and our bylaws,
as amended and restated, contain provisions that could have the
effect of discouraging potential acquisition proposals or tender
offers or delaying or preventing a change in control, including
changes a stockholder might consider favorable. In particular, our
articles of incorporation and bylaws, among other
things:
●
permit our Board of Directors to alter our bylaws without
stockholder approval;
●
provide that vacancies on our Board of Directors may be filled by a
majority of directors in office, although less than a
quorum;
●
authorize the issuance of preferred stock, which can be created and
issued by our Board of Directors without prior stockholder
approval, with rights senior to our common stock, which may render
more difficult or discourage an attempt to obtain control of us by
means of a merger, tender offer, proxy contest or otherwise;
and
●
establish advance notice procedures with respect to stockholder
proposals relating to the nomination of candidates for election as
directors and other business to be brought before stockholder
meetings, which notice must contain information specified in our
bylaws.
In
addition, our articles of incorporation restrict our ability to
take certain actions without the approval of at least 66% of the
Series A Preferred Stock then outstanding. These actions include,
among other things;
●
authorizing, creating, designating, establishing or issuing an
increased number of shares of Series A Preferred Stock or any other
class or series of capital stock ranking senior to or on a parity
with the Series A Preferred Stock;
●
adopting a plan for the liquidation, dissolution or winding up the
affairs of our company or any recapitalization plan (whether by
merger, consolidation or otherwise);
●
amending, altering or repealing, whether by merger, consolidation
or otherwise, our articles of incorporation or bylaws in a manner
that would adversely affect any right, preference, privilege or
voting power of the Series A Preferred Stock;
and
●
declaring or paying any dividend (with certain exceptions) or
directly or indirectly purchase, redeem, repurchase or otherwise
acquire any shares of our capital stock, stock options or
convertible securities (with certain exceptions).
Such
provisions may have the effect of discouraging a third-party from
acquiring us, even if doing so would be beneficial to our
stockholders. These provisions are intended to enhance the
likelihood of continuity and stability in the composition of our
Board of Directors and in the policies formulated by them, and to
discourage some types of transactions that may involve an actual or
threatened change in control of our company. These provisions are
designed to reduce our vulnerability to an unsolicited acquisition
proposal and to discourage some tactics that may be used in proxy
fights. We believe that the benefits of increased protection of our
potential ability to negotiate with the proponent of an unfriendly
or unsolicited proposal to acquire or restructure our company
outweigh the disadvantages of discouraging such proposals because,
among other things, negotiation of such proposals could result in
an improvement of their terms.
However,
these provisions could have the effect of discouraging others from
making tender offers for our shares that could result from actual
or rumored takeover attempts. These provisions also may have the
effect of preventing changes in our management.
Market Price of and Dividends on Common Equity and Related
Stockholder Matters
Our
common stock is currently quoted on the OTCQB under the symbol
"VSUL". The following table sets forth the range of the high and
low sale prices of the common stock for the periods indicated. The
quotations reflect inter-dealer prices, without retail markup,
markdown or commission, and may not represent actual transactions.
Consequently, the information provided below may not be indicative
of our common stock price under different conditions.
Trades
in our common stock may be subject to Rule 15g-9 of the Exchange
Act, which imposes requirements on broker/dealers who sell
securities subject to the rule to persons other than established
customers and accredited investors. For transactions covered by the
rule, broker/dealers must make a special suitability determination
for purchasers of the securities and receive the purchaser’s
written agreement to the transaction before the sale.
Period
Ended
|
|
|
Year Ending September 30, 2017
|
|
|
September
30, 2017
|
$
0.25
|
$
0.11
|
June
30, 2017
|
$
0.70
|
$
0.23
|
March
31, 2017
|
$
0.99
|
$
0.54
|
December
31, 2016
|
$
1.44
|
$
0.66
|
|
|
|
Year Ending September 30, 2016
|
|
|
September
30, 2016
|
$
3.50
|
$
0.95
|
June
30, 2016
|
$
9.35
|
$
2.25
|
March
31, 2016
|
$
8.04
|
$
5.00
|
December
31, 2015
|
$
9.00
|
$
4.30
|
As of
December 27, 2017, the high and low sales price of our common stock
was $0.23 per share and $0.29 per share, respectively. As of
December 29, 2017, there were
4,655,486
shares of common stock
outstanding held by approximately 66 stockholders of record. This
number does not include approximately 2,300 beneficial owners whose
shares are held in the names of various security brokers, dealers
and registered clearing agencies.
Transfer Agent
Our transfer agent is American Stock Transfer & Trust Company
located at 6201 15th Avenue, Brooklyn, New York 11219, and their
telephone number is (800) 937-5449.
Dividend Policy
We have
not previously declared or paid any cash dividends on our common
stock and do not anticipate or contemplate paying dividends on our
common stock in the foreseeable future. We currently intend to use
all of our available funds to finance the growth and development of
our business. We can give no assurances that we will ever have
excess funds available to pay dividends. In addition, our articles
of incorporation restrict our ability to pay any dividends on our
common stock without the approval of 66% of our then outstanding
Series A Preferred Stock.
Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities
During the three months ended September 30, 2017, we had the
following sales of unregistered sales of equity
securities:
On the year ended September 30, 2017, the Company issued 795,000
shares of restricted common stock to two Named Executive Officers
employees, two directors and six employees and consultants and for
services during 2015-2017. The shares were issued in accordance
with the 2011 Stock Incentive Plan and were valued at $0.17 per
share, the market price of our common stock. The Company expensed
$135,150 during the year ended September 30, 2017.
INFORMATION
The following table provides information as of September 30, 2017
related to the equity compensation plan in effect at that
time.
|
(a)
|
(b)
|
(c)
|
|
|
|
Number of securities
|
|
|
|
remaining available
|
|
Number of securities
|
Weighted-average
|
for future issuance
|
|
to be issued upon
|
exercise price of
|
under equity compensation
|
|
exercise of outstanding
|
outstanding options,
|
plan (excluding securities
|
Plan Category
|
options, warrants and rights
|
warrants and rights
|
reflected in column (a))
|
Equity compensation plan
|
|
|
|
approved by shareholders
|
15,404
|
14.675
|
62,929
|
Equity compensation plans
|
|
|
|
not approved by shareholders
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Total
|
15,404
|
14.675
|
62,929
|
ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL
DATA
Summary Financial Information
In the following table, we provide you with our selected
consolidated historical financial and other data. We have prepared
the consolidated selected financial information using our
consolidated financial statements for the years ended September 30,
2017 and 2016. When you read this selected consolidated historical
financial and other data, it is important that you read along with
it the historical financial statements and related notes in our
consolidated financial statements included in this report, as well
as Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations.
(dollars in thousands)
|
Years
Ended September 30,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
STATEMENT
OF OPERATIONS DATA:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net
revenue
|
$
4,874
|
$
6,024
|
$
6,291
|
$
7,983
|
$
8,573
|
Cost
of goods sold
|
3,966
|
5,036
|
5,274
|
6,694
|
6,717
|
Gross
profit
|
908
|
988
|
1,017
|
1,289
|
1,856
|
Research
and development expenses
|
79
|
326
|
363
|
670
|
1,169
|
General
and administrative expenses
|
3,088
|
3,355
|
2,984
|
3,180
|
4,581
|
Impairment
of goodwill
|
984
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Operating
(loss)
|
(3,243
)
|
(2,693
)
|
(2,330
)
|
(2,561
)
|
(3,894
)
|
Other
expense
|
(658
)
|
947
|
(271
)
|
1,538
|
(2,741
)
|
Net
(loss)
|
(3,901
)
|
(1,746
)
|
(2,601
)
|
(1,023
)
|
$
(6,635
)
|
Income
taxes current benefit
|
-
|
-
|
30
|
(6
)
|
$
(30
)
|
Net
(loss)
|
(3,901
)
|
(1,746
)
|
(2,631
)
|
(1,017
)
|
(6,605
)
|
Noncontrolling
interest
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
$
17
|
Net
(loss) attributable to Visualant, Inc. and Subsidiaries common
shareholders
|
$
(3,901
)
|
$
(1,746
)
|
$
(2,631
)
|
$
(1,017
)
|
$
(6,622
)
|
Net
(loss) per share
|
$
(1.01
)
|
$
(1.22
)
|
$
(2.33
)
|
$
(1.24
)
|
$
(15.11
)
|
Weighted
average number of shares
|
3,844,840
|
1,428,763
|
1,131,622
|
819,563
|
437,049
|
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
You should read the following discussion and analysis of our
financial condition and results of operations together with our
financial statements and related notes appearing at the end of this
prospectus. Some of the information contained in this discussion
and analysis or set forth elsewhere in this prospectus, including
information with respect to our plans and strategy for our business
and related financing, includes forward-looking statements that
involve risks and uncertainties. You should read the "Risk Factors"
section of this prospectus for a discussion of important factors
that could cause actual results to differ materially from the
results described in or implied by the forward-looking statements
contained in the following discussion and analysis.
We are focused on the development, marketing and sales of a
proprietary technology which is capable of uniquely identifying and
authenticating almost any substance using light to create, record
and detect the unique digital “signature” of the
substance. We call this our “ChromaID™”
technology.
Overview
For the
past several years we have focused on the development of our
proprietary ChromaID™ technology. Using light from low-cost
LEDs (light emitting diodes) we map the color of substances, fluids
and materials and with our proprietary processes we can
authenticate, identify and diagnose based upon the color that is
present. The color is both visible to us as humans but also outside
of the humanly visible color spectrum in the near infra-red and
near ultra-violet and beyond. Our ChromaID scanner sees what we
like to call “Nature’s Color Fingerprint.”
Everything in nature has a unique color identifier and with
ChromaID we can see it, and identify, authenticate and diagnose
based upon the color that is present. Our ChromaID scanner is
capable of uniquely identifying and authenticating almost any
substance or liquid using light to create, record and detect its
unique color signature. While we will continue to develop and
enhance our ChromaID technology and extend its capacity, we have
moved into the commercialization phase of our Company as we begin
to both work with partners and internally to create revenue
generating products for the marketplace.
Our ChromaID™ Technology
We have
developed a proprietary technology to uniquely identify and
authenticate almost any substance. This patented technology
utilizes light at the photon (elementary particle of light) level
through a series of emitters and detectors to generate a unique
signature or “fingerprint” from a scan of almost any
solid, liquid or gaseous material. This signature of reflected or
transmitted light is digitized, creating a unique ChromaID
signature. Each ChromaID signature is comprised of from hundreds to
thousands of specific data points.
The
ChromaID technology looks beyond visible light frequencies to areas
of near infra-red and ultraviolet light and beyond that are outside
the humanly visible light spectrum. The data obtained allows us to
create a very specific and unique ChromaID signature of the
substance for a myriad of authentication, verification and
diagnostic applications.
Traditional
light-based identification technology, called spectrophotometry,
has relied upon a complex system of prisms, mirrorsand visible
light. Spectrophotometers typically have a higher cost and utilize
a form factor (shape and size) more suited to a laboratory setting
and require trained laboratory personnel to interpret the
information. The ChromaID technology uses lower cost LEDs and
photodiodes and specific frequencies of light resulting in a more
accurate, portable and easy-to-use solution for a wide variety of
applications. The ChromaID technology not only has significant cost
advantages as compared to spectrophotometry, it is also completely
flexible is size, shape and configuration. The ChromaID scan head
can range in size from endoscopic to a scale that could be the size
of a large ceiling-mounted florescent light fixture.
In
normal operation, a ChromaID master or reference scan is generated
and stored in a database. We call this the ChromaID Reference
Library. The Visualant scan head can then scan similar materials to
identify, authenticate or diagnose them by comparing the new
ChromaID digital signature scan to that of the original or
reference ChromaID signature or scan result. Over time, we believe
the ChromaID Reference Libraries can become a significant asset of
the Company, providing valuable information in numerous fields of
use.
We have
pursued an active intellectual property strategy and have been
granted eleven patents. We also have 20 patents pending. We possess
all right, title and interest to the issued patents. Ten of the
pending patents are licensed exclusively to us in perpetuity by our
strategic partner, Allied Inventors, a spin off corporation from
Intellectual Ventures, the large intellectual property
fund.
In 2010, we acquired TransTech Systems as an adjunct to our
business. TransTech is a distributor of products for employee and
personnel identification. TransTech currently provides
substantially all of our revenues. We intend, however, to further
develop and market our ChromaID technology.
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The following table presents certain consolidated statement of
operations information and presentation of that data as a
percentage of change from year-to-year.
(dollars in thousands)
|
Years
Ended September 30,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue
|
$
4,874
|
$
6,024
|
$
(1,150
)
|
-19.1
%
|
Cost
of sales
|
3,966
|
5,036
|
(1,070
)
|
21.2
%
|
Gross
profit
|
908
|
988
|
(80
)
|
-8.1
%
|
Research
and development expenses
|
79
|
326
|
(247
)
|
75.8
%
|
Selling,
general and administrative expenses
|
3,088
|
3,355
|
(267
)
|
8.0
%
|
Impairment
of goodwill
|
984
|
-
|
-
|
-100.0
%
|
Operating
loss
|
(3,243
)
|
(2,693
)
|
434
|
16.1
%
|
Other
(expense) income:
|
|
|
|
|
Interest
expense
|
(377
)
|
(324
)
|
(53
)
|
-16.4
%
|
Other
(expense)
|
(63
)
|
(11
)
|
(52
)
|
-472.7
%
|
(Loss)
gain on change- derivative liability warrants
|
(218
)
|
2,560
|
(2,778
)
|
-108.5
%
|
(Loss)
on conversion of debt
|
-
|
(1,278
)
|
1,278
|
100.0
%
|
Total
other (expense) income
|
(658
)
|
947
|
(1,605
)
|
-169.5
%
|
Income
before income taxes
|
(3,901
)
|
(1,746
)
|
(1,171
)
|
-67.1
%
|
Income
taxes - current (benefit)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
0.0
%
|
Net
(loss)
|
(3,901
)
|
(1,746
)
|
(1,171
)
|
-67.1
%
|
Sales
Net revenue for the year ended September 30, 2017 decreased
$1,150,000 to $4,874,000 as compared to $6,024,000 for the year
ended September 30, 2016. The decrease was due to lower sales by
TransTech resulting from a reduction in product sales and a large
sale in 2016 that was not repeated in 2017.
Cost of Sales
Cost of sales for the year ended September 30, 2017 decreased
$1,070,000 to $3,966,000 as compared to $5,036,000 for the year
ended September 30, 2016. The decrease was due to lower sales by
TransTech resulting from a reduction in product sales and a large
sale in 2016 that was not repeated in 2017.
Gross profit was $908,000 for the year ended September 30, 2017 as
compared to $988,000 for the year ended September 30, 2016. Gross
profit was 18.6% for the year ended September 30, 2017 as compared
to 16.4% for the year ended September 30, 2016.
Research and Development Expenses
Research and development expenses for the year ended September 30,
2017 decreased $247,000 to $79,000 as compared to $326,000 for the
year ended September 30, 2016. The decrease was due to reduced
expenditures for the RATLab and suppliers related to the
commercialization of our ChromaID technology. The
RATLab is
no longer providing us with services.
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses
Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended
September 30, 2017 decreased $267,000 to $3,088,000 as compared to
$3,355,000 for the year ended September 30,
2016.
The decrease primarily was due to (i) decreased business
development and investor relation expenses of $112,000; (ii)
reduced consulting expenses of $107,000; (iii) decreased
amortization expense of $71,000; (iv) decreased payroll expenses of
$69,000; (v) decreased legal expenses of $46,000;(vi) decreased
other expenses of $46,000;offset by (vii) increased bad debt losses
on accounts receivable of $136,000; and (viii) increased marketing
expenses of $48,000. As part of the selling, general and
administrative expenses for the year ended September 30, 2017, we
incurred investor relation expenses and business development
expenses of $692,000.
Impairment of Goodwill
Our TransTech business is very capital intensive. We reviewed
TransTech’s operations based on its overall financial
constraints and determined the value has been impaired. We recorded
an impairment of goodwill associated with TransTech of $984,000
during the year September 30, 2017.
Other Income (Expense)
Other expense for the year ended September 30, 2017 was $658,000 as
compared to other income of $947,000 for the year ended September
30, 2016. The other expense for the year ended September 30, 2017
included (i) change in the value of derivatives of $218,000; (ii)
interest expense of $377,000; (iii) other expense of $63,000. The
decrease is a result of the decline of the derivative liability as
our underlying stock price has declined and conversion of interest
and amortization of debt discount of $227,000.
The other income for the year ended September 30, 2016 included
change in the value of derivatives of $2,560,000, offset by the
loss on the retirement of debt of $1,278,000, interest expenses of
$324,000 and other expenses of $11,000. The gain on the value of
the derivative instruments is a result of the decline of the
derivative liability as our underlying stock price has
declined.
Net (Loss)
Net loss for the year ended September 30, 2017 was $3,901,000 as
compared to $1,746,000 for the year ended September 30, 2016. The
net loss for the year ended September 30, 2017
, included
non-cash expenses of non-cash items of
$2,397,000. The non-cash items include (i) depreciation and
amortization of $81,000; (ii) issuance of capital stock for
services and expenses of $548,000; (iii) stock based compensation
of $38,000; (iv) bad debt losses and provision on loss on accounts
receivable of $141,000; (v) impairment of goodwill of $984,000;
(vi) loss on sale of assets $113,000; (vii) conversion of interest
and amortization of debt discount of $227,000; and (viii)
reclassification of derivative liability of $410,000; offset by
(ix) loss on change- derivative liability warrants of $145,000.
TransTech’s net loss from operations was ($256,000) for the
year ended September 30, 2017 as compared to ($192,000) for the
year ended September 30, 2016.
The net loss for the year ended
September 30, 2016, included
non-cash income of $956,000, including
(i) gain on change- derivative liability warrants of $2,560,000,
offset by (ii) other of $34,000, (iii) depreciation and
amortization of $179,000; (iv) stock based compensation of $46,000;
(v) share and warrant issuances of $395,000; (vi)
loss on
conversion of preferred stock $675,695; (vii) loss on settlement of
debt $97,037;(viii) loss on termination of stock purchase agreement
$505,000; (ix) amortization of debt discounts
$299,412.
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
We had cash of approximately $103,000 and net working capital
deficit of approximately $4,099,000 as of September 30,
2017. We have experienced net losses since inception and
we expect losses to continue as we commercialize our
ChromaID™ technology. As of September 30, 2017, we had an
accumulated deficit of $31,534,000 and net losses in the amount of
$3,901,000 and $1,746,000 for the years ended September 30, 2017
and 2016, respectively.
We believe that our
cash on hand will be sufficient to fund our operations through
January 31, 2018.
The
opinion of our independent registered public accounting firm on our
audited financial statements as of and for the year ended September
30, 2017 contains an explanatory paragraph regarding substantial
doubt about our ability to continue as a going concern. Our ability
to continue as a going concern is dependent upon raising capital
from financing transactions.
We need additional financing to implement our business plan and to
service our ongoing operations and pay our current debts. There can
be no assurance that we will be able to secure any needed funding,
or that if such funding is available, the terms or conditions would
be acceptable to us. If we are unable to obtain additional
financing when it is needed, we will need to restructure our
operations, and divest all or a portion of our
business.
We may seek additional
capital through a combination of private and public equity
offerings, debt financings and strategic collaborations. Debt
financing, if obtained, may involve agreements that include
covenants limiting or restricting our ability to take specific
actions, such as incurring additional debt, and could increase our
expenses and require that our assets secure such debt. Equity
financing, if obtained, could result in dilution to our
then-existing stockholders and/or require such stockholders to
waive certain rights and preferences. If such financing is not
available on satisfactory terms, or is not available at all, we may
be required to delay, scale back, eliminate the development of
business opportunities or file for bankruptcy and our operations
and financial condition may be materially adversely
affected.
We have financed our corporate operations and our technology
development through the issuance of convertible debentures, the
issuance of preferred stock, the sale common stock, issuance of
common stock in conjunction with an equity line of credit, loans by
our Chief Executive Officer and the exercise of
warrants.
We
finance our TransTech operations from operations and a Secured
Credit Facility with Capital Source
Business
Finance
Group. On December 9, 2008,
TransTech entered into a $1,000,000 secured credit facility with
Capital Source
to fund
its operations. On June 6, 2017, TransTech entered into the
Fourth Modification to the Loan and Security Agreement. This
secured credit facility was renewed until June 12, 2018 with a
floor for prime interest of 4.5% (currently 4.5%) plus 2.5%. The
eligible borrowing is based on 80% of eligible trade accounts
receivable, not to exceed $500,000. The secured credit facility is
collateralized by the assets of TransTech, with a guarantee by
Visualant, including a security interest in all assets of
Visualant. The remaining balance on the accounts receivable line of
$365,725 ($16,000 available) as of September 30, 2017 must be
repaid by the time the secured credit facility expires on June 12,
2018, or the Company renews by automatic extension for the next
successive one year term.
Operating Activities
Net cash used in operating activities for the year ended September
30, 2017 was $1,264,000. This amount was primarily related to (i) a
net loss of $3,901,000; offset by (ii) a decrease in accounts
receivable and prepaid expenses of $27,000; (iii) a decrease in
inventory of $69,000; (iv) an increase in accounts payable, accrued
expenses and deferred revenue of $198,000; (v) non-cash expenses of
non-cash items of $2,397,000. The non-cash items include (i)
depreciation and amortization of $81,000; (ii) issuance of capital
stock for services and expenses of $548,000; (iii) stock based
compensation of $38,000; (iv) bad debt losses and provision on loss
on accounts receivable of $141,000; (v)impairment of goodwill of
$984,000; (vi) loss on sale of assets $113,000; (vii) conversion of
interest and amortization of debt discount of $227,000; and (viii)
reclassification of derivative liability of $410,000; offset by
(ix) loss on change- derivative liability warrants of
$145,000.
Financing Activities
Net cash provided by financing activities for the year ended
September 30, 2017 was $1,145,000. This amount was primarily
related to (i) proceeds from convertible notes of $690,000; (ii)
proceeds from the sale of common and preferred stock of $550,000;
and (iii) proceeds from line of credit of $30,000; offset by (iv)
repayment of convertible notes of $125,000.
Our contractual cash obligations as of September 30, 2017 are
summarized in the table below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Contractual
Cash Obligations
|
|
|
|
|
|
Operating
leases
|
$
268,776
|
$
75,726
|
$
136,940
|
$
56,110
|
$
-
|
Convertible
notes payable
|
570,000
|
570,000
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Notes
payable
|
1,165,660
|
1,165,660
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Capital
expenditures
|
100,000
|
20,000
|
40,000
|
40,000
|
-
|
|
$
2,104,436
|
$
1,831,386
|
$
176,940
|
$
96,110
|
$
-
|
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
We do
not have any off-balance sheet arrangements (as that term is
defined in Item 303 of Regulation S-K) that are reasonably likely
to have a current or future material effect on our financial
condition, revenue or expenses, results of operations, liquidity,
capital expenditures or capital resources.
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND ESTIMATES
The application of GAAP involves the exercise of varying degrees of
judgment. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates and
judgments based on historical experience and various other factors
that are believed to be reasonable under the
circumstances.
Actual results may differ from these estimates under different
assumptions or conditions. We believe that of our significant
accounting policies (see summary of significant accounting policies
more fully described in Note 2 to the financial statements set
forth in this report), the following policies involve a higher
degree of judgment and/or complexity:
Inventories
– Inventories
consist primarily of printers and consumable supplies, including
ribbons and cards, badge accessories, capture devices, and access
control components held for resale and are stated at the lower of
cost or market on the first-in, first-out (“FIFO”)
method. Inventories are considered available for resale
when drop shipped and invoiced directly to a customer from a
vendor, or when physically received by TransTech at a warehouse
location. We record a provision for excess and obsolete
inventory whenever an impairment has been identified. There is a
$35,000 and $25,000 reserve for impaired inventory as of September
30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Fair Value Measurements and Financial Instruments
–
ASC Topic 820,
Fair Value Measurement and Disclosures
,
defines fair value as the exchange price that would be received for
an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the
principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in
an orderly transaction between market participants on the
measurement date. This topic also establishes a fair
value hierarchy, which requires classification based on observable
and unobservable inputs when measuring fair value. The
fair value hierarchy distinguishes between assumptions based on
market data (observable inputs) and an entity’s own
assumptions (unobservable inputs).
Revenue Recognition
–
Visualant and TransTech revenue are derived from products and
services. Revenue is considered realized when the products or
services have been provided to the customer, the work has been
accepted by the customer and collectability is reasonably
assured. Furthermore, if an actual measurement of revenue cannot be
determined, we defer all revenue recognition until such time that
an actual measurement can be determined. If during the course of a
contract management determines that losses are expected to be
incurred, such costs are charged to operations in the period such
losses are determined. Revenues are deferred when cash has been
received from the customer but the revenue has not been
earned.
Stock Based Compensation
– We have share-based compensation plans
under which employees, consultants, suppliers and directors may be
granted restricted stock, as well as options to purchase shares of
our common stock at the fair market value at the time of grant.
Stock-based compensation cost is measured by us at the grant date,
based on the fair value of the award, over the requisite service
period. For options issued to employees, we recognize stock
compensation costs utilizing the fair value methodology over the
related period of benefit. Grants of stock options and
stock to non-employees and other parties are accounted for in
accordance with the ASC 505.
ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE
DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
We have no investments in any market risk sensitive instruments
either held for trading purposes or entered into for other than
trading purposes.
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND
SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
Reference is made to our consolidated financial statements
beginning on page F-1 of this report.
ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS
WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL
DISCLOSURE
Not applicable.
ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
(a)
Evaluation of disclosure
controls and procedures.
We
conducted an evaluation, under the supervision and with the
participation of our management, of the effectiveness of the design
and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures. The term
“disclosure controls and procedures,” as defined in
Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities and Exchange Act
of 1934, as amended (“Exchange Act”), means controls
and other procedures of a company that are designed to ensure that
information required to be disclosed by the company in the reports
it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed,
summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the
Securities and Exchange Commission's rules and forms. Disclosure
controls and procedures also include, without limitation, controls
and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be
disclosed by a company in the reports that it files or submits
under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to the
company's management, including its principal executive and
principal financial officers, or persons performing similar
functions, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding
required disclosure. Based on this evaluation, our principal
executive and principal financial officers concluded as of
September 30, 2017
that our
disclosure controls and procedures were not effective at the
reasonable assurance level due to the material weaknesses in our
internal controls over financial reporting discussed immediately
below.
Identified Material Weakness
A
material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting
is a control deficiency, or combination of control deficiencies,
that results in more than a remote likelihood that a material
misstatement of the financial statements will not be prevented or
detected.
Management
identified the following material weakness during its assessment of
internal controls over financial reporting:
Audit Committee
:
While we have
an audit committee, we lack a financial expert. During 2018, the
Board expects to appoint an additional independent Director to
serve as Audit Committee Chairman who is an “audit
committee financial expert” as defined by the Securities and
Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and as adopted under the
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
Financial Reporting
: There were
several late required Form 8-K and Form D SEC filings from April 1,
2017 to August 14, 2017. In addition, we believe there is a lack of
segregation of duties over financial reporting. The Company is
strengthening financial personnel and using a consultant to ensure
accurate and timely financial reporting.
(b) Management's Report on Internal Control Over Financial
Reporting.
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining
adequate internal control over financial reporting as defined in
Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of
1934. Our internal control over financial reporting is a
process designed by, or under the supervision of, our CEO and CFO,
or persons performing similar functions, and effected by our board
of directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable
assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in
accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the
United States of America (GAAP). Our internal control
over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures
that: (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable
detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and
disposition of the assets of the Company; (ii) provide reasonable
assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit
preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP and
that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only
in accordance with authorization of management and directors of the
Company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding
prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or
disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a
material effect on the financial statements.
Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s
internal control over financial reporting as of September 30,
2017. In making this assessment, management used the
criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of
the Treadway Commission in the 2013
Internal Control-Integrated
Framework
. Based on
its evaluation, management has concluded that the Company’s
internal control over financial reporting was not effective as of
September 30, 2017.
Pursuant to Regulation S-K Item 308(b), this Annual Report on Form
10-K does not include an attestation report of our company’s
registered public accounting firm regarding internal control over
financial reporting.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over
financial reporting may not prevent or detect
misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of
effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that
controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or
that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may
deteriorate. A control system, no matter how well designed and
operated can provide only reasonable, but not absolute, assurance
that the control system’s objectives will be
met. The design of a control system must reflect the
fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of
controls must be considered relative to their cost.
c) Changes in Internal Control over Financial
Reporting
There
have been no changes in our internal control over financial
reporting in the fiscal year ended September 30, 2017, which
were identified in connection with our management’s
evaluation required by paragraph (d) of rules 13a-15 and 15d-15
under the Exchange Act, that have materially affected, or are
reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over
financial reporting.
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION
There were no disclosures of any information required to be filed
on Form 8-K during the three months ended September 30, 2017 that
were not filed.
PART III
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE
GOVERNANCE
The
following table sets forth certain information about our current
directors and executive officers:
|
Name
|
Age
|
Director/ Executive Officer
|
Directors-
|
|
|
Ronald P. Erickson
|
73
|
Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and President
(1)
|
|
|
Interim Chief Financial Officer
|
Jon Pepper
|
66
|
Director (2)
|
Ichiro Takesako
|
58
|
Director
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Executive Officers-
|
|
|
Todd Martin Sames
|
63
|
Executive Vice President of Business Development
|
(1)
Chairman of the Nomination and Governance Committee.
|
(2)
Chairman of the Audit and Compensation Committees.
|
All
directors hold office until their successors are duly appointed or
until their earlier resignation or removal.
Background and Business Experience
Ronald P. Erickson
has been a
director and officer of Visualant since April 2003. He was
appointed as our CEO and President in November 2009 and as Chairman
of the Board in February 2015. Previously, Mr. Erickson was our
President and Chief Executive Officer from September 2003 through
August 2004, and was Chairman of the Board from August 2004 until
May 2011.
A senior executive with more than 30 years of experience in the
high technology, telecommunications, micro-computer, and digital
media industries, Mr. Erickson was the founder of Visualant. He is
formerly Chairman, CEO and Co-Founder of Blue Frog Media, a mobile
media and entertainment company; Chairman and CEO of eCharge
Corporation, an Internet-based transaction procession
company, Chairman, CEO and Co-founder of GlobalTel
Resources, a provider of telecommunications services; Chairman,
Interim President and CEO of Egghead Software, Inc. a software
reseller where he was an original investor; Chairman and CEO of
NBI, Inc.; and Co-founder of MicroRim, Inc. the database software
developer. Earlier, Mr. Erickson practiced law in Seattle and
worked in public policy in Washington, DC and New York, NY.
Additionally, Mr. Erickson has been an angel investor and board
member of a number of public and private technology
companies. In addition to his business activities, Mr.
Erickson serves on the Board of Trustees of Central Washington
University where he received his BA degree. He also holds a MA from
the University of Wyoming and a JD from the University of
California, Davis. He is licensed to practice law in the State of
Washington.
Mr. Erickson is our founder and was appointed as a director because
of his extensive experience in developing technology
companies.
Ichiro Takesako
has served as a
director since December 28, 2012. Mr. Takesako has held executive
positions with Sumitomo Precision Products Co., Ltd or Sumitomo
since 1983. Mr. Takesako graduated from Waseda University, Tokyo,
Japan where he majored in Social Science and graduated with a
Degree of Bachelor of Social Science.
In the past few years, Mr. Takesako has held the following
executive position in Sumitomo and its affiliates:
June 2008:
appointed
as General Manager of Sales and Marketing Department of Micro
Technology Division
April 2009:
appointed
as General Manager of Overseas Business Department of Micro
Technology Division,
in charge
of M&A activity of certain business segment and assets of Aviza
Technology, Inc.
July 2010:
appointed as Executive Director of SPP Process Technology
Systems, 100% owned subsidiary of
Sumitomo
Precision Products then, stationed in Newport, Wales
August 2011:
appointed
as General Manager, Corporate Strategic Planning Group
January
2013:
appointed
as Chief Executive Officer of M2M Technologies, Inc., a company
invested by
Sumitomo
Precision products
April 2013:
appointed
as General Manager of Business Development Department, in parallel
of CEO of M2M
Technologies,
Inc.
April
2014:
relieved
from General Manager of Business Development Department and is
responsible for M2M
Technologies
Inc. as its CEO
March
2017:
Established
own company, At Signal, Inc., and taking over the business and
technologies
previously
held by M2M Technologies, retired from Sumitomo Precision
Products
Mr. Takesako was appointed as a Director based on his position with
Sumitomo and Sumitomo's significant partnership with the Company.
After Sumitomo decided to exit from relationship, Mr. Takesako
remains as board member.
Jon Pepper
has served as an
independent director since April 2006. Mr. Pepper founded Pepcom in
1980, and continues as the founding partner of Pepcom, an industry
leader at producing press-only technology showcase events around
the country. Prior to that, Mr. Pepper started the DigitalFocus
newsletter, a ground-breaking newsletter on digital imaging that
was distributed to leading influencers worldwide. Mr. Pepper has
been closely involved with the high technology revolution since the
beginning of the personal computer era. He was formerly a
well-regarded journalist and columnist; his work on technology
subjects appeared in
The New York
Times
,
Fortune
,
PC Magazine
,
Men's
Journal
,
Working
Woman
,
PC Week
,
Popular Science
and many other well-known
publications. Pepper was educated at Union College in Schenectady,
New York and the Royal Academy of Fine Arts in
Copenhagen.
Mr. Pepper was appointed as a director because of his marketing
skills with technology companies.
Other Executive Officers
Todd Martin Sames
joined the
Company as Vice President, Business Development in September
2012. Mr. Sames was appointed Executive Vice President,
Business Development in March 2015. Mr. Sames is responsible for
global business development and sales of the ChromaID technology,
customer relations and creating new licensing agreements resulting
in the commercialization of Visualant’s technology across a
wide range of applications with device and equipment manufacturers
in several business verticals.
Mr. Sames brings over 25 years of successful emerging technology
sales and sales management experience in the areas of enterprise
software, audio and video conferencing and networking solutions to
corporate clients. From 2010 to 2012, Mr. Sames held a Business
Unit Director position at INX, focused on unified communications
and collaboration solutions for Fortune 1000 clients. From 2007 to
2010, Mr. Sames held a Regional Management position at BT
Conferencing, Video. Prior to that, Mr. Sames was the original
corporate sales resource for then start-up Portable Software, now
Concur Technologies,
During his tenure at Egghead Software, Mr. Sames was the Midwest
Regional Manager for Corporate Sales based in Chicago and
ultimately Director of Corporate Relationships overseeing corporate
purchasing contracts, special projects and innovative new corporate
service programs. Mr. Sames has a Bachelor of Arts Degree from the
University of Puget Sound and additional certifications in
communications technology from Cisco Systems, Polycom, TANDBERG and
other technology systems providers.
Family Relationships
There are no family relationships among our directors and executive
officers.
Involvement in Certain Legal Proceedings
None of our directors or executive officers has, during the past
ten years:
|
●
|
Had any petition under the federal bankruptcy laws or any state
insolvency law filed by or against, or had a receiver, fiscal
agent, or similar officer appointed by a court for the business or
property of such person, or any partnership in which he was a
general partner at or within two years before the time of such
filing, or any corporation or business association of which he was
an executive officer at or within two years before the time of such
filing;
|
|
●
|
Been convicted in a criminal proceeding or a named subject of a
pending criminal proceeding (excluding traffic violations and other
minor offenses);
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
Been the subject of any order, judgment, or decree, not
subsequently reversed, suspended, or vacated, of any court of
competent jurisdiction, permanently or temporarily enjoining him
from, or otherwise limiting, the following activities:
|
|
◦
|
Acting as a futures commission merchant, introducing broker,
commodity trading advisor, commodity pool operator, floor broker,
leverage transaction merchant, any other person regulated by the
Commodity Futures Trading Commission, or an associated person of
any of the foregoing, or as an investment adviser, underwriter,
broker or dealer in securities, or as an affiliated person,
director or employee of any investment company, bank, savings and
loan association or insurance company, or engaging in or continuing
any conduct or practice in connection with such
activity;
|
|
|
|
|
◦
|
Engaging in any type of business practice; or
|
|
|
|
|
◦
|
Engaging in any activity in connection with the purchase or sale of
any security or commodity or in connection with any violation of
federal or state securities laws or federal commodities
laws;
|
|
●
|
Been the subject of any order, judgment, or decree, not
subsequently reversed, suspended, or vacated, of any federal or
state authority barring, suspending, or otherwise limiting for more
than 60 days the right of such person to engage in any activity
described in (i) above, or to be associated with persons engaged in
any such activity;
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
Been found by a court of competent jurisdiction in a civil action
or by the SEC to have violated any federal or state securities law,
where the judgment in such civil action or finding by the SEC has
not been subsequently reversed, suspended, or vacated;
or
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
Been found by a court of competent jurisdiction in a civil action
or by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission to have violated any
federal commodities law, where the judgment in such civil action or
finding by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission has not been
subsequently reversed, suspended, or vacated.
|
Board Committees
The Board has three standing committees to facilitate and assist
the Board in the execution of its responsibilities. The committees
are currently the Audit Committee, the Nominations and Governance
Committee, and the Compensation Committee. The Committees were
formed in July 2010. The Audit and Compensation Committees are
comprised solely of non-employee, independent directors. The
Nominations and Governance Committee has one management director,
Ronald Erickson, as Chairman. Charters for each committee are
available on our website at www.visualant.net. The discussion below
describes current membership for each of the standing Board
committees.
Audit
|
|
Compensation
|
|
Nominations and Governance
|
Jon Pepper (Chairman)
|
|
Jon Pepper (Chairman)
|
|
Ron Erickson (Chairman)
|
|
|
|
|
Jon Pepper
|
Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider
Participation
No member of the Compensation Committee during the fiscal year
ended September 30, 2017 served as an officer, former officer, or
employee of the Company or participated in a related party
transaction that would be required to be disclosed in this
prospectus. Further, during this period, no executive officer of
the Company served as:
|
●
|
a member of the Compensation Committee or equivalent of any other
entity, one of whose executive officers served as one of our
directors or was an immediate family member of a director, or
served on our Compensation Committee; or
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
a director of any other entity, one of whose executive officers or
their immediate family member served on our Compensation
Committee.
|
Code of Ethics
We have
adopted conduct and ethics standards titled the code of ethics,
which is available at www.visualant.net. These standards were
adopted by our Board of Directors to promote transparency and
integrity. The standards apply to our Board of Directors,
executives and employees. Waivers of the requirements of our code
of ethics or associated polices with respect to members of our
Board of Directors or executive officers are subject to approval of
the full board.
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
Compensation Discussion and Analysis
Overview of Compensation Program
This Compensation Discussion and Analysis describes the material
elements of compensation awarded to, earned by or paid to each of
our executive officers named in the Compensation Table on page
31 under “Remuneration of Executive Officers” (the
“Named Executive Officers”) who served during the year
ended September 30, 2017. This compensation discussion primarily
focuses on the information contained in the following tables and
related footnotes and narrative for the last completed fiscal year.
We also describe compensation actions taken after the last
completed fiscal year to the extent that it enhances the
understanding of our executive compensation disclosure. The
principles and guidelines discussed herein would also apply to any
additional executive officers that the Company may hire in the
future.
The Compensation Committee of the Board has responsibility for
overseeing, reviewing and approving executive compensation and
benefit programs in accordance with the Compensation
Committee’s charter. The members of the Compensation
Committee are Jon Pepper. We expect to appoint an additional
independent Director to serve on the Compensation Committee by
early 2017.
Compensation Philosophy and Objectives
The major compensation objectives for the Company’s executive
officers are as follows:
|
|
|
|
●
|
to attract and retain highly qualified individuals capable of
making significant contributions to our long-term
success;
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
to motivate and reward named executive officers whose knowledge,
skills, and performance are critical to our success;
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
to closely align the interests of our named executive officers and
other key employees with those of its shareholders;
and
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
to utilize incentive based compensation to reinforce performance
objectives and reward superior performance.
|
Role of Chief Executive Officer in Compensation
Decisions
The Board approves all compensation for the chief executive
officer. The Compensation Committee makes recommendations on the
compensation for the chief executive officer and approves all
compensation decisions, including equity awards, for our executive
officers. Our chief executive officer makes recommendations
regarding the base salary and non-equity compensation of other
executive officers that are approved by the Compensation Committee
in its discretion.
Setting Executive Compensation
The Compensation Committee believes that compensation for the
Company’s executive officers must be managed to what we can
afford and in a way that allows for us to meet our goals for
overall performance. During 2017 and 2016, the Compensation
Committee and the Board compensated its Chief Executive Officer
with an annual salary of $180,000 effective June 1, 2012. During
2017 and 2016, the Committee compensated its Chief Financial
Officer with an annual salary of $120,000 effective June 1, 2012.
This compensation reflected the financial condition of the Company.
Other Named Executive Officers were paid by us during 2017 and
2016. The Compensation Committee does not use a peer group of
publicly-traded and privately-held companies in structuring the
compensation packages.
Executive Compensation Components for the Year Ended September 30,
2017
The Compensation Committee did not use a formula for allocating
compensation among the elements of total compensation during the
year that ended on September 30, 2017. The Compensation Committee
believes that in order to attract and retain highly effective
people it must maintain a flexible compensation structure. For the
year that ended on September 30, 2017, the principal components of
compensation for named executive officers were base
salary.
Base Salary
Base salary is intended to ensure that our employees are fairly and
equitably compensated. Generally, base salary is used to
appropriately recognize and reward the experience and skills that
employees bring to the Company and provides motivation for career
development and enhancement. Base salary ensures that all employees
continue to receive a basic level of compensation that reflects any
acquired skills which are competently demonstrated and are
consistently used at work.
Base salaries for the Company’s named executive officers are
initially established based on their prior experience, the scope of
their responsibilities and the applicable competitive market
compensation paid by other companies for similar positions. Mr.
Erickson and Mr. Wilson were compensated as described above based
on the financial condition of the Company.
Performance-Based Incentive Compensation
The Compensation Committee believes incentive compensation
reinforces performance objectives, rewards superior performance and
is consistent with the enhancement of stockholder value. All of the
Company’s Named Executive Officers are eligible to receive
performance-based incentive compensation. The Compensation
Committee did not recommend or approve payment of any
performance-based incentive compensation to the Named Executive
Officers during the year ended September 30, 2017 based on our
financial condition.
Ownership Guidelines
The Compensation Committee does not require our executive officers
to hold a minimum number of our shares. However, to directly align
the interests of executive officers with the interests of the
stockholders, the Compensation Committee encourages each executive
officer to maintain an ownership interest in the
Company.
Stock Option Program
Stock options are an integral part of our executive compensation
program. They are intended to encourage ownership and retention of
the Company’s common stock by named executive officers and
employees, as well as non-employee members of the Board. Through
stock options, the objective of aligning employees’ long-term
interest with those of stockholders may be met by providing
employees with the opportunity to build a meaningful stake in the
Company.
The Stock Option Program assists us by:
-
enhancing the link between the creation of stockholder value and
long-term executive incentive compensation;
-
providing an opportunity for increased equity ownership by
executive officers; and
-
maintaining competitive levels of total compensation.
Stock option award levels are determined by the Compensation
Committee and vary among participants’ positions within the
Company. Newly hired executive officers or promoted executive
officers are generally awarded stock options, at the discretion of
the Compensation Committee, at the next regularly scheduled
Compensation Committee meeting on or following their hire or
promotion date. In addition, such executives are eligible to
receive additional stock options on a discretionary basis after
performance criteria are achieved.
Options are awarded at the closing price of our common stock on the
date of the grant or last trading day prior to the date of the
grant. The Compensation Committee’s policy is not to grant
options with an exercise price that is less than the closing price
of our common stock on the grant date.
Generally, the majority of the options granted by the Compensation
Committee vest quarterly over two to three years or annually over
five years of the 5-10-year option term. Vesting and exercise
rights cease upon termination of employment and/or service, except
in the case of death (subject to a one year limitation), disability
or retirement. Stock options vest immediately upon termination of
employment without cause or an involuntary termination following a
change of control. Prior to the exercise of an option, the holder
has no rights as a stockholder with respect to the shares subject
to such option, including voting rights and the right to receive
dividends or dividend equivalents.
The Named Executive Officers did not receive stock grants and
option awards during the year ended September 30,
2017.
Retirement and Other Benefits
We have no other retirement, savings, long-term stock award or
other type of plans for the Named Executive Officers.
Perquisites and Other Personal Benefits
During the year ended September 30, 2016, we provided the Named
Executive Officers with medical insurance. No other personal
benefits were provided to these individuals. The committee expects
to review the levels of perquisites and other personal benefits
provided to Named Executive Officers annually.
Entry into Employment Agreement with Ronald P. Erickson, Chief
Executive Officer
On
August 4, 2017, the Board of Directors approved an Employment
Agreement with Ronald P. Erickson pursuant to which the we engaged
Mr. Erickson as our Chief Executive Officer through June 30,
2018.
Mr.
Erickson’s annual compensation is $180,000. Mr. Erickson is
also entitled to receive an annual bonus and equity awards
compensation as approved by the Board. The bonus should be paid no
later than 30 days following earning of the bonus.
Mr.
Erickson will be entitled to participate in all group employment
benefits that are offered by us to our senior executives and
management employees from time to time, subject to the terms and
conditions of such benefit plans, including any eligibility
requirements.
If we terminate Mr. Erickson’s employment at any time prior
to the expiration of the Term without Cause, as defined in the
Employment Agreement, or if Mr. Erickson terminates his employment
at any time for “Good Reason” or due to a
“Disability”, Mr. Erickson will be entitled to receive
(i) his Base Salary amount for one year; and (ii) medical benefits
for eighteen months.
Tax and Accounting Implications
Deductibility of Executive Compensation
Subject to certain exceptions, Section 162(m) of the Internal
Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code") generally denies a
deduction to any publicly held corporation for compensation paid to
its chief executive officer and its three other highest paid
executive officers (other than the principal financial officer) to
the extent that any such individual's compensation exceeds $1
million. “Performance-based compensation” (as defined
for purposes of Section 162(m)) is not taken into account for
purposes of calculating the $1 million compensation limit, provided
certain disclosure, shareholder approval and other requirements are
met. We periodically review the potential consequences of Section
162(m) and may structure the performance-based portion of our
executive compensation to comply with certain exceptions to Section
162(m). However, we may authorize compensation payments that do not
comply with the exceptions to Section 162(m) when we believe that
such payments are appropriate and in the best interests of the
stockholders, after taking into consideration changing business
conditions or the officer's performance.
Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation
Beginning on January 1, 2006, we began accounting for stock-based
payments including its Stock Option Program in accordance with the
requirements of ASC 718, “Compensation-Stock
Compensation.”
COMPENSATION COMMITTEE REPORT
The Compensation Committee, composed entirely of independent
directors in accordance with the applicable laws and regulations,
sets and administers policies that govern the Company's executive
compensation programs, and incentive and stock programs. The
Compensation Committee of the Company has reviewed and discussed
the Compensation Discussion and Analysis required by Item 402(b) of
Regulation S-K with management and, based on such review and
discussions, the Compensation Committee recommended to the Board
that the Compensation Discussion and Analysis be included in this
Proxy Statement.
THE COMPENSATION COMMITTEE
Jon Pepper, Chairman
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
REMUNERATION OF EXECUTIVE OFFICERS
The following table provides information concerning remuneration of
the chief executive officer, the chief financial officer and
another named executive officer for the fiscal years ended
September 30, 2017 and 2016:
Summary Compensation Table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
All
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stock
|
Option
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
Salary
|
Bonus
|
Awards
|
Awards
|
Compensation
|
Total
|
Name
|
Principal Position
|
|
($)
|
($)
|
($) (4)
|
($)
|
($)
|
($)
|
Salary-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ronald P. Erickson (1)
|
Chief Executive Officer and Interim Chief Financial
Officer
|
9/30/2017
|
$ 180,000
|
$ -
|
$ 34,000
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ 214,000
|
|
|
9/30/2016
|
$ 180,000
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ 180,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jeff T. Wilson (2)
|
Former Chief Financial Officer
|
9/30/2017
|
$ 87,500
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ 87,500
|
|
|
9/30/2016
|
$ 8,300
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ 8,300
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Todd Martin Sames (3)
|
Executive Vice President of Business Development
|
9/30/2017
|
$ 120,000
|
$ -
|
$ 25,500
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ 145,500
|
|
|
9/30/2016
|
$ 120,000
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ -
|
$ 120,000
|
(1) During the years ended September 30, 2017 and 2016, Mr.
Erickson was compensated at a monthly salary of $15,000. As of
September 30, 2017 and 2016, Mr. Erickson had accrued but unpaid
salary of $7,500 and $105,000, respectively. This accrual was based
on the tight cash flow of the Company and agreed to by Mr.
Erickson, but there was no formal deferral agreement. There was no
accrued interest paid on the unpaid salary. The 200,000 of
restricted common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to Mr.
Erickson at the grant date market value of $0.17 per
share.
(2) During the period October 1, 2016 to May 15, 2017, Mr.
Wilson was compensated at a monthly salary of $10,000. During the
period May 16, 2017 to July 31, 2017, Mr. Wilson was compensated at
a monthly rate of $5,000. As of September 30, 2017, Mr. Wilson had
alleged unpaid compensation of $12,500. During the period from
September 6, 2016 to September 30, 2016, Mr. Wilson was paid
$8,300. Mr. Wilson was appointed Chief Financial Officer on
September 6, 2016 and he departed July 31, 2017.
(3) During the year ended September 30, 2017 and 2016, Mr.
Sames was compensated at a monthly salary of $10,000. As of
September 30, 2017 and 2016, Mr. Sames had accrued but unpaid
salary of $10,000 and $25,000, respectively, This accrual was based
on the tight cash flow of the Company and agreed to by Mr. Sames,
but there was no formal deferral agreement. There was no accrued
interest paid on the unpaid salary. The 150,000 of restricted
common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to Mr. Sames at the
grant date market value of $0.17 per
share.
(4) These amounts reflect the grant date market value as required
by Regulation S-K Item 402(n)(2), computed in accordance with FASB
ASC Topic 718.
Grants of
Stock Based Awards in Fiscal Year Then Ended September 30,
2017
The Compensation Committee approved the following performance-based
incentive compensation to the Named Executive Officers during the
year ended September 30, 2017.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
All Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stock
|
|
|
Grant
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Awards;
|
All Other
|
|
Date
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number
|
Option
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
of
|
Awards;
|
|
|
|
|
Estimated Future Payouts Under
|
Estimated Future Payouts Under
|
Shares of
|
Number of
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Plan
|
|
of
|
Securities
|
Price
of
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stock or
|
Underlying
|
|
|
|
Grant
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Units
|
Options
|
Awards
|
|
Name
|
Date
|
($)
|
($)
|
($)
|
(#)
|
(#)
|
(#)
|
(#)
|
(#)
|
($/Sh) (4)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ronald P. Erickson (1)
|
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
300,000
|
300,000
|
300,000
|
200,000
|
-
|
$
0.170
|
$
34,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jeff T Wilson (2)
|
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Todd Martin Sames (3)
|
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
100,000
|
100,000
|
100,000
|
150,000
|
-
|
$
0.170
|
$
25,500
|
(1) The restricted common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to
Mr. Erickson at the grant date market value of $0.17 per
share. The estimated future payments include 100,000
shares to be issued on January 1, 2018, 2019 and 2020.
(2) Mr. Wilson was appointed Chief Financial Officer on September
6, 2016 and he departed July 31, 2017.
(3) The restricted common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to
Mr. Sames at the grant date market value of $0.17 per
share. The estimated future payments include 66,667
shares to be issued on January 1, 2018, 2019 and 2020.
(4) These amounts reflect the grant date market value as required
by Regulation S-K Item 402(n)(2), computed in accordance with FASB
ASC Topic 718.
Outstanding Equity Awards as of Fiscal Year Then Ended September
30, 2017
Our Named Executive Officers did not have any outstanding equity
awards as of September 30, 2017.
Option Exercises and Stock Vested
Our Named Executive Officers the following stock vested options
during the year ended September 30, 2017.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name
|
|
|
|
|
|
(#)
|
|
(#)
|
|
Ronald
P. Erickson (1)
|
-
|
$
-
|
200,000
|
$
34,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jeff
T. Wilson (2)
|
-
|
$
-
|
-
|
$
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Todd
Martin Sames (3)
|
-
|
$
-
|
150,000
|
$
25,500
|
(1) The restricted common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to
Mr. Erickson at the grant date market value of $0.17 per
share.
(2) Mr. Wilson was appointed Chief Financial Officer on September
6, 2016 and he departed July 31, 2017.
(3) The restricted common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to
Mr. Sames at the grant date market value of $0.17 per
share.
(4) These amounts reflect the grant date market value as required
by Regulation S-K Item 402(n)(2), computed in accordance with FASB
ASC Topic 718.
Pension Benefits
We do not provide any pension benefits.
Nonqualified Deferred Compensation
We do not have a nonqualified deferral program.
Employment Agreements
We have an employment agreement with Ronald P.
Erickson.
Potential Payments upon Termination or Change in
Control
We have the following
potential
payments upon termination or change in control with Ronald P.
Erickson:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Executive
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payments
Upon
|
|
|
|
|
|
Separation
|
|
|
|
|
|
Compensation:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Base
salary (1)
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
180,000
|
$
180,000
|
$
-
|
Performance-based
incentive
|
|
|
|
|
|
compensation
(2)
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
51,000
|
$
51,000
|
$
-
|
Stock
options
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Benefits
and Perquisites:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Health
and welfare benefits (3)
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
41,886
|
$
41,886
|
$
-
|
Accrued
vacation pay
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
34,615
|
$
34,615
|
$
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
307,501
|
$
307,501
|
$
-
|
(1)
Reflects a salary
for one year.
(2)
Reflects
the vesting of estimated future payments includes 100,000 shares to
be issued on January 1, 2018, 2019 and 2020 valued at $0.17 per
share.
(3)
Reflects
the cost of medical benefits for eighteen months.
We do
not have any
potential payments upon
termination or change in control with our other Named Executive
Officers.
DIRECTOR COMPENSATION
We primarily use stock options grants to incentive compensation to
attract and retain qualified candidates to serve on the Board. This
compensation reflected the financial condition of the Company. In
setting director compensation, we consider the significant amount
of time that Directors expend in fulfilling their duties to the
Company as well as the skill-level required by our members of the
Board. During year then ended September 30, 2017, Ronald Erickson
did not receive any compensation for his service as a director.
The compensation disclosed in the Summary Compensation Table
on page 31 represents the total compensation for Mr.
Erickson.
Compensation Paid to Board Members
Our independent non-employee directors are not compensated in
cash. The only compensation generally has been in the
form of stock awards. There is no formal stock compensation plan
for independent non-employee directors. Our non-employee directors
received the following compensation during the year ended September
30, 2017.
|
|
|
|
|
Name
|
|
|
|
|
Jon
Pepper (1)
|
$
25,500
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
25,500
|
Ichiro
Takesako (2)
|
17,000
|
-
|
-
|
17,000
|
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
$
42,500
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
$
42,500
|
(1) The restricted common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to
Mr. Pepper at the grant date market value of $0.17 per
share.
(2) The restricted common stock was issued on September 7, 2017 to
Mr. Pepper at the grant date market value of $0.17 per
share.
(3) These amounts reflect the grant date market value as
required by Regulation S-K Item 402(n)(2), computed in accordance
with FASB ASC Topic 718.
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND
MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
The following table sets forth certain information regarding the
ownership of our common stock as of September 30, 2017
by:
|
●
|
each director and nominee for director;
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
each person known by us to own beneficially 5% or more of our
common stock;
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
each executive officer named in the summary compensation table
elsewhere in this
report;
and
|
|
|
|
|
●
|
all of our current directors and executive officers as a
group.
|
The amounts and percentages of common stock beneficially owned are
reported on the basis of regulations of the SEC governing the
determination of beneficial ownership of securities. Under the
rules of the SEC, a person is deemed to be a “beneficial
owner” of a security if that person has or shares voting
power,” which includes the power to vote or to direct the
voting of such security, or has or shares “investment
power,” which includes the power to dispose of or to direct
the disposition of such security. A person is also deemed to be a
beneficial owner of any securities of which that person has the
right to acquire beneficial ownership within 60 days. Under these
rules more than one person may be deemed a beneficial owner of the
same securities and a person may be deemed to be a beneficial owner
of securities as to which such person has no economic
interest.
Unless otherwise indicated below, each beneficial owner named in
the table has sole voting and sole investment power with respect to
all shares beneficially owned, subject to community property laws
where applicable. The address for each person shown in the table is
c/o Visualant, Inc. 500 Union Street, Suite 810, Seattle
Washington, unless otherwise indicated.
|
Shares
Beneficially Owned
|
|
|
|
Directors
and Officers-
|
|
|
Ronald
P. Erickson (1)
|
358,085
|
7.7
%
|
Jon
Pepper (3)
|
163,000
|
3.5
%
|
Todd
Martin Sames (4)
|
151,667
|
3.3
%
|
Ichiro
Takesako (5)
|
115,385
|
2.5
%
|
|
-
|
-
|
Total
Directors and Officers (5 in total)
|
788,137
|
16.9
%
|
* Less than 1%.
(1) Includes 355,086 shares of shares of common stock beneficially
owned.
(2) Mr. Wilson was appointed Chief Financial Officer on September
6, 2016 and he departed July 31, 2017. Mr. Wilson does not have any
beneficial ownership.
(3) Includes 163,000 shares of shares of common stock beneficially
owned by Mr. Pepper.
(4) Includes 151,667 shares of shares of common stock beneficially
owned by Mr. Sames.
(5) Includes 115,385 shares of shares of common stock beneficially
owned by Ichiro Takesako.
|
Shares Beneficially Owned
|
|
Amount
|
Percentage
|
Greater Than 5% Ownership
|
|
|
|
|
|
Clayton A. Struve (1)
|
9,323,438
|
66.7%
|
|
Blocker at 4.99%
|
|
|
|
Dale Broadrick (2)
|
2,166,819
|
37.6%
|
|
|
|
Special Situations Technology Funds, L.P./ Adam Stettner
(3)
|
318,000
|
6.5%
|
|
Blocker at 9.99%
|
(1) Reflects the shares beneficially owned by Clayton A.
Struve. This total includes Preferred Stock that converts into
2,801,709 shares of common stock, a warrant to purchase 4,241,719
shares of common stock and Convertible notes of $570,000 that
convert into 2,280,000 shares of common stock. The address of
Clayton A. Struve is 175 West Jackson Blvd, Suite 440, Chicago,
Illinois.
(2) Reflects the shares beneficially owned by Dale
Broadrick. This total includes 1,053,801 shares and a total of
1,113,018 Warrants to purchase shares of our common stock. The
address of Dale Broadrick is 3003 Brick Church Pike, Nashville,
Tennessee.
(3) Reflects the shares beneficially owned by Special
Situations Technology Funds, L.P. This total includes 106,000
shares and a total of 212,000 Series A and B Warrants to purchase
shares of our common stock. The address of Special Situations
Technology Funds, L.P. is 527 Madison Avenue, Suite 2600, New York
City, New York.
ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND
DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
Related Party Transactions
Related party transactions for the year ended September 30, 2017
are detailed below and in the Footnotes to this Annual Report on
Form 10-K.
Review and Approval of Related Person Transactions
We have operated under a Code of Conduct for many years. Our Code
of Conduct requires all employees, officers and directors, without
exception, to avoid the engagement in activities or relationships
that conflict, or would be perceived to conflict, with the
Company’s interests or adversely affect its reputation. It is
understood, however, that certain relationships or transactions may
arise that would be deemed acceptable and appropriate upon full
disclosure of the transaction, following review and approval to
ensure there is a legitimate business reason for the transaction
and that the terms of the transaction are no less favorable to the
Company than could be obtained from an unrelated
person.
The Audit Committee is responsible for reviewing and approving all
transactions with related persons. The Company has not adopted a
written policy for reviewing related person transactions. The
Company reviews all relationships and transactions in which the
Company and our directors and executive officers or their immediate
family members are participants to determine whether such persons
have a direct or indirect material interest. As required under SEC
rules, transactions that are determined to be directly or
indirectly material to the Company or a related person are
disclosed.
Director Independence
The Board has affirmatively determined that Mr. Pepper and Mr.
Takesako are each an
independent
director
. For purposes of
making that determination, the Board used NASDAQ’s Listing
Rules even though the Company is not currently listed on
NASDAQ.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
Since
October 1, 2014, we have engaged in the following reportable
transactions with our directors, executive officers, holders of
more than 5% of our voting securities and affiliates, or
immediately family members of our directors, executive officers and
holders of more than 5% of our voting securities.
Policies and Procedures for Related Person
Transactions
We have
operated under a Code of Conduct and Ethics since December 28,
2012. Our Code of Conduct and Ethics requires all employees,
officers and directors, without exception, to avoid the engagement
in activities or relationships that conflict, or would be perceived
to conflict, with our interests.
Prior
to the adoption of our related person transaction policy, there was
a legitimate business reason for all the related person
transactions described above and we believe that, where applicable,
the terms of the transactions are no less favorable to us than
could be obtained from an unrelated person.
Our
Audit Committee reviews all relationships and transactions in which
we and our directors and executive officers or their immediate
family members are participants to determine whether such persons
have a direct or indirect material interest.
As
required under SEC rules, transactions that are determined to be
directly or indirectly material to us or a related person are
disclosed.
Services and License Agreement Allied Inventors,
L.L.C.
In
November 2013, we entered into a Services and License Agreement
with Invention Development Management Company. IDMC was a
subsidiary of Intellectual Ventures, which collaborates with
inventors and partners with pioneering companies and invests both
expertise and capital in the process of invention. On November 19,
2014, we amended the Services and License Agreement with IDMC. This
amendment exclusively licenses 10 filed patents to us. In May of
2016, Intellectual Ventures was spun out IDMC into an independent
company now called Allied Inventors, L.L.C. The relationship
remains intact.
We have received a worldwide, nontransferable, exclusive license to
the intellectual property developed under the Allied Inventors
agreement during the term of the agreement, and solely within the
identification, authentication and diagnostics field of use, to (a)
make, have made, use, import, sell and offer for sale products and
services; (b) make improvements; and (c) grant sublicenses of any
and all of the foregoing rights (including the right to grant
further sublicenses).
Allied Inventors is providing global business development services
to us for geographies not being pursued by Visualant. Also, Allied
Inventors has introduced us to potential customers, licensees and
distributors for the purpose of identifying and pursuing a license,
sale or distribution arrangement or other monetization
event.
We granted to Allied Inventors a nonexclusive, worldwide, fully
paid, nontransferable, sublicenseable, perpetual license to our
intellectual property solely outside the identification,
authentication and diagnostics field of use to (a) make, have made,
use, import, sell and offer for sale products and services and (b)
grant sublicenses of any and all of the foregoing rights (including
the right to grant further sublicenses).
We granted to Allied Inventors a nonexclusive, worldwide, fully
paid up, royalty-free, nontransferable, non-sublicenseable,
perpetual license to access and use our technology solely for the
purpose of marketing the aforementioned sublicenses of our
intellectual property to third parties outside the designated
fields of use.
In connection with the original license agreement, we issued a
warrant to purchase 97,169 shares of common stock to Allied
Inventors as consideration for the exclusive intellectual property
license and application development services. The warrant has a
current exercise price of $0.25 per share and expires November 10,
2018. The per share price is subject to adjustment based on any
issuances below $0.25 per share except as described in the
warrant.
We agreed to pay Allied Inventors a percentage of license revenue
for the global development business services and a percentage of
revenue received from any company introduce to us by Allied
Inventors. We also have also agreed to pay Allied Inventors a
royalty when we receive royalty product revenue from an
IDMC-introduced company. Allied Inventors has agreed to pay us a
license fee for the nonexclusive license of our intellectual
property.
The term of both the exclusive intellectual property license and
the nonexclusive intellectual property license commences on the
effective date of November 11, 2013, and terminates when all claims
of the patents expire or are held in valid or unenforceable by a
court of competent jurisdiction from which no appeal can be
taken.
The term of the Agreement commences on the effective date until
either party terminates the Agreement at any time following the
fifth anniversary of the effective date by providing at least
ninety days’ prior written notice to the other
party.
Related Party Transactions with Ronald P. Erickson
We have a $199,935 Business Loan Agreement with Umpqua Bank. On
December 19, 2017, the Umpqua Loan maturity was extended to March
31, 2018 and provides for interest at 4.00% per year.
Related to this Umpqua Loan, we entered into a demand promissory
note for $200,000 on January 10, 2014 with an entity affiliated
with Ronald P. Erickson, our Chief Executive Officer. This demand
promissory note will be effective in case of a default by us under
the Umpqua Loan.
We also have two other demand promissory notes payable to entities
affiliated with Mr. Erickson, totaling $600,000. Each of these
notes were issued between January and July 2014, provide for
interest of 3% per year and now mature on December 31, 2017. The
notes payable also provide for a second lien on our assets if not
repaid by December 31, 2017 or converted into convertible
debentures or equity on terms acceptable to the Mr. Erickson. We
recorded accrued interest of $58,167 as of September 30,
2017.
Mr. Erickson and/or entities with which he is affiliated also have
advanced $519,833 and have unreimbursed expenses and compensation
of approximately $450,679. We owe Mr. Erickson, or entities with
which he is affiliated, $1,570,511 as of September 30,
2017.
On July 12, 2016, Mr. Erickson and/or entities with which he is
affiliated exercised a warrant for 66,667 shares of our common
stock at $2.50 per share or $166,668.
On
August 4, 2017, the Board of Direc
tors approved an
Employment Agreement with Ronald P. Erickson pursuant to which we
engaged Mr. Erickson as the Company’s Chief Executive Officer
through June 30, 2018.
Stock Issuances to Named Executive Officers and
Directors
On September 7, 2017, the Company issued 600,000 shares of
restricted common stock to two Named Executive Officers employees
and two directors for services during 2015-2017. The shares were
issued in accordance with the 2011 Stock Incentive Plan and were
valued at $0.17 per share, the market price of our common stock.
The Company expensed $102,000 during the year ended September 30,
2017.
Stock Option Grant Cancellations
During the year ended September 30, 2017, two Named Executive
Officers forfeited stock option grants for 35,366 shares of common
stock at $19.53 per share.
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policy
The Audit Committee has established a pre-approval policy and
procedures for audit, audit-related and tax services that can be
performed by the independent auditors without specific
authorization from the Audit Committee subject to certain
restrictions. The policy sets out the specific services
pre-approved by the Audit Committee and the applicable limitations,
while ensuring the independence of the independent auditors to
audit the Company's financial statements is not impaired. The
pre-approval policy does not include a delegation to management of
the Audit Committee’s responsibilities under the Exchange
Act. During the year ended September 30, 2017, the Audit Committee
pre-approved all audit and permissible non-audit services provided
by our independent auditors.
Service Fees Paid to the Independent Registered Public Accounting
Firm
The Audit Committee engaged SD Mayer and Associates, LLP to perform
an annual audit of the Company’s financial statements for the
fiscal years ended September 30, 2017 and 2016. The following is
the breakdown of aggregate fees paid to auditors for the Company
for the last two fiscal years:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Audit
fees
|
$
41,399
|
$
37,920
|
Audit
related fees
|
26,900
|
22,000
|
Tax
fees
|
11,825
|
16,450
|
All
other fees
|
17,000
|
26,200
|
|
|
|
|
$
97,124
|
$
102,570
|
-
“Audit Fees” are fees paid for professional services
for the audit of our financial statements.
-
“Audit-Related fees” are fees paid for professional
services not included in the first two categories, specifically,
SAS 100 reviews, SEC filings and consents, and accounting
consultations on matters addressed during the audit or interim
reviews, and review work related to quarterly filings.
-
“Tax Fees” are fees primarily for tax compliance in
connection with filing US income tax returns.
-
“All other fees” for 2017 related to three year SEC
review. All other fees for 2016 related to the review of
registration statements on Form S-1.
SECTION16(a) BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP REPORTING COMPLIANCE
Our executive officers, directors and 10% stockholders are required
under Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act to file reports of
ownership and changes in ownership with the SEC. Copies of these
reports must also be furnished to us.
Based solely on a review of copies of reports furnished to us, as
of September 30, 2017 our executive officers, directors and 10%
holders complied with all filing requirements.
PART IV
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
(a) FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
The company’s financial statements, as indicated by the Index
to Consolidated Financial Statements set forth below, begin on page
F-1 of this Form 10-K, and are hereby incorporated by reference.
Financial statement schedules have been omitted because they are
not applicable or the required information is included in the
financial statements or notes thereto.
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Title of Document
|
|
Page
|
|
|
|
Report of SD Mayer and Associates, LLP.
|
|
F-1
|
|
|
|
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of September 30, 2017 and
2016
|
|
F-2
|
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended September
30, 2017 and 2016
|
|
F-3
|
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' (Deficit) for
the years ended September 30, 2017 and 2016
|
|
F-4
|
|
|
|
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended September
30, 2016 and 2015
|
|
F-5
|
|
|
|
Notes to the Financial Statements
|
|
F-6
|
101.INS*
|
XBRL Instance
Document
|
101.SCH*
|
XBRL Taxonomy Extension
Schema Document
|
101.CAL*
|
XBRL Taxonomy Extension
Calculation Linkbase Document
|
101.LAB*
|
XBRL Taxonomy Extension
Labels Linkbase Document
|
101.PRE*
|
XBRL Taxonomy Extension
Presentation Linkbase Document
|
101.DEF*
|
XBRL Taxonomy Extension
Definition Linkbase Document
|
|
|
*Filed Herewith. Pursuant to Regulation S-T, this interactive data
file is deemed not filed or part of a registration statement or
prospectus for purposes of Sections 11 or 12 of the Securities
Act of 1933, is deemed not filed for purposes of Section 18 of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and otherwise is not subject
to liability under these sections.
|
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting
Firm
The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Visualant, Incorporated:
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of
Visualant, Incorporated (the “Company”) as of September
30, 2017 and 2016 and the related consolidated statements of
operations, stockholders’ (deficit), and cash flows for the
years ended September 30, 2017 and 2016. These consolidated
financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s
management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these
consolidated financial statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the
Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are
free of material misstatement. The Company is not required to have,
nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control
over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration
of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for
designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the
circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on
the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over
financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such
opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis,
evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial
statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting
principles used and significant estimates made by management, as
well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We
believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our
opinion.
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to
above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial
position of Visualant, Incorporated as of September 30, 2017 and
2016, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the
years ended September 30, 2017 and 2016 in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of
America.
The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been
prepared assuming that the Company will continue as a going
concern. As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial
statements, the Company has sustained a net loss from operations
and has an accumulated deficit since inception. These factors
raise substantial doubt about the Company’s ability to
continue as a going concern. Management’s plans in this
regard are also described in Note 1. The consolidated
financial statements do not include any adjustments that might
result from the outcome of this
uncertainty.
SD Mayer and Associates, LLP
/s/ SD Mayer and Associates, LLP
December 29, 2017
Seattle, Washington
|
VISUALANT, INCORPORATED AND SUBSIDIARIES
|
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
|
|
|
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
CURRENT
ASSETS:
|
|
|
Cash
and cash equivalents
|
$
103,181
|
$
188,309
|
Accounts
receivable, net of allowance of $60,000 and $55,000,
respectively
|
693,320
|
808,955
|
Prepaid
expenses
|
27,687
|
20,483
|
Inventories,
net
|
225,909
|
295,218
|
Total
current assets
|
1,050,097
|
1,312,965
|
|
|
|
EQUIPMENT,
NET
|
133,204
|
285,415
|
|
|
|
OTHER
ASSETS
|
|
|
Intangible
assets, net
|
-
|
43,750
|
Goodwill
|
-
|
983,645
|
Other
assets
|
5,070
|
5,070
|
|
|
|
TOTAL
ASSETS
|
$
1,188,371
|
$
2,630,845
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' (DEFICIT)
|
|
|
|
|
|
CURRENT
LIABILITIES:
|
|
|
Accounts
payable - trade
|
$
2,156,646
|
$
1,984,326
|
Accounts
payable - related parties
|
2,905
|
41,365
|
Accrued
expenses
|
24,000
|
80,481
|
Accrued
expenses - related parties
|
1,166,049
|
1,109,046
|
Deferred
revenue
|
63,902
|
-
|
Derivative
liability
|
-
|
145,282
|
Convertible
notes payable
|
570,000
|
909,500
|
Notes
payable - current portion of long term debt
|
1,165,660
|
1,170,339
|
Total
current liabilities
|
5,149,162
|
5,440,339
|
|
|
|
COMMITMENTS
AND CONTINGENCIES
|
-
|
-
|
|
|
|
STOCKHOLDERS'
DEFICIT
|
|
|
Preferred
stock - $0.001 par value, 5,000,000 shares authorized, 0 shares
issued and
|
|
|
outstanding
at 9/30/2017 and 9/30/2016, respectively
|
-
|
-
|
Series
A Convertible Preferred stock - $0.001 par value, 23,334 shares
authorized, 23,334
|
|
|
issued
and outstanding at 9/30/2017 and 9/30/2016,
respectively
|
23
|
23
|
Series
C Convertible Preferred stock - $0.001 par value, 1,785,715 shares
authorized,
|
|
|
1,785,715
shares issued and outstanding at 9/30/2017 and 9/30/2016,
respectively
|
1,790
|
1,790
|
Series
D Convertible Preferred stock - $0.001 par value, 3,906,250 shares
authorized,
|
|
|
1,016,014
and 0 shares issued and outstanding at 9/30/2017 and 9/30/2016,
respectively
|
1,015
|
-
|
Common
stock - $0.001 par value, 100,000,000 shares authorized,
4,655,486
|
|
|
and
2,356,152 shares issued and outstanding at 9/30/2017 and 9/30/2016,
respectively
|
4,655
|
2,356
|
Additional
paid in capital
|
27,565,453
|
24,259,702
|
Accumulated
deficit
|
(31,533,727
)
|
(27,073,365
)
|
Total
stockholders' deficit
|
(3,960,791
)
|
(2,809,494
)
|
|
|
|
TOTAL
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT
|
$
1,188,371
|
$
2,630,845
|
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
financial statements.
VISUALANT, INCORPORATED AND SUBSIDIARIES
|
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
REVENUE
|
$
4,874,359
|
$
6,023,600
|
COST
OF SALES
|
3,966,607
|
5,035,699
|
GROSS
PROFIT
|
907,752
|
987,901
|
RESEARCH
AND DEVELOPMENT EXPENSES
|
79,405
|
325,803
|
SELLING,
GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES
|
3,088,178
|
3,355,263
|
IMPAIRMENT
OF GOODWILL
|
983,645
|
-
|
OPERATING
LOSS
|
(3,243,476
)
|
(2,693,165
)
|
|
|
|
OTHER
INCOME (EXPENSE):
|
|
|
Interest
expense
|
(376,974
)
|
(323,928
)
|
Other
expense
|
(62,954
)
|
(11,228
)
|
(Loss)
gain on change - derivative liability
|
(217,828
)
|
2,559,558
|
(Loss)
on conversion of debt
|
-
|
(1,277,732
)
|
Total
other (expense) income
|
(657,756
)
|
946,670
|
|
|
|
(LOSS)
BEFORE INCOME TAXES
|
(3,901,232
)
|
(1,746,495
)
|
|
|
|
Income
taxes - current provision
|
-
|
-
|
|
|
.
|
NET
(LOSS)
|
$
(3,901,232
)
|
$
(1,746,495
)
|
|
|
|
Basic
and diluted loss per common share attributable to
Visualant,
|
|
|
Inc.
and subsidiaries common shareholders-
|
|
|
Basic
and diluted loss per share
|
$
(1.01
)
|
$
(1.22
)
|
|
|
|
Weighted
average shares of common stock outstanding- basic and
diluted
|
3,844,840
|
1,428,763
|
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
financial statements.
VISUALANT, INCORPORATED AND SUBSIDIARIES
|
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS'
(DEFICIT)
|
|
|
Series
B Redeemable Convertible
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance
as of September 30, 2015
|
11,667
|
$
12
|
-
|
$
-
|
-
|
$
-
|
-
|
$
-
|
$
1,155,992
|
$
1,156
|
$
18,786,694
|
$
(24,166,156
)
|
$
(5,378,294
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stock
compensation expense - employee options
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
46,398
|
-
|
46,398
|
Issuance
of common stock for services
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
63,979
|
63
|
273,948
|
-
|
274,011
|
Issuance
of warrant for services
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
120,751
|
-
|
120,751
|
Issuance
of common stock for warrant exercise
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
207,666
|
207
|
518,955
|
-
|
519,162
|
Issuance
of common stock
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
850,850
|
852
|
1,245,626
|
-
|
1,246,478
|
Issuance
of convertible notes payable
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
120,501
|
-
|
120,501
|
Issuance
of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock
|
11,667
|
11
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(11
)
|
-
|
-
|
Issuance
of Series B Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
|
-
|
-
|
51
|
5
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
504,995
|
-
|
505,000
|
Cancellation
of Series B Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
|
-
|
-
|
(51
)
|
(5
)
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(5
)
|
Issuance
of Series C Convertible Preferred Stock
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
1,785,715
|
1,790
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
1,248,214
|
-
|
1,250,004
|
Benefical
conversion feature of Preferred Stock/dividend
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
1,160,714
|
(1,160,714
)
|
-
|
Issuance
of common stock for conversion of liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
77,665
|
78
|
232,917
|
-
|
232,995
|
Net
loss
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(1,746,495
)
|
(1,746,495
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance
as of September 30, 2016
|
23,334
|
23
|
-
|
-
|
1,785,715
|
1,790
|
-
|
-
|
2,356,152
|
2,356
|
24,259,702
|
(27,073,365
)
|
(2,809,494
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stock
compensation expense - employee options
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
37,848
|
-
|
37,848
|
Issuance
of common stock for services
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
1,354,386
|
1,353
|
545,103
|
-
|
546,456
|
Issuance
of Series D Convertible Preferred Stock
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
1,016,004
|
1,015
|
-
|
-
|
998,132
|
-
|
999,147
|
Benefical
conversion feature of Preferred Stock/dividend
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
559,130
|
(559,130
)
|
-
|
Issuance
of common stock for conversion of liabilities
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
944,948
|
946
|
755,014
|
-
|
755,960
|
Write-off
of derivative liability to additional paid in capital
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
410,524
|
-
|
410,524
|
Net
loss
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
(3,901,232
)
|
(3,901,232
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance
a as of September 30, 2017
|
23,334
|
$
23
|
-
|
$
-
|
1,785,715
|
$
1,790
|
1,016,004
|
$
1,015
|
$
4,655,486
|
$
4,655
|
$
27,565,453
|
$
(31,533,727
)
|
$
(3,960,791
)
|
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
financial statements.
VISUALANT, INCORPORATED AND SUBSIDIARIES
|
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CASH
FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
|
|
|
Net
loss
|
$
(3,901,232
)
|
$
(1,746,495
)
|
Adjustments
to reconcile net loss to net cash (used in)
|
|
|
operating
activities
|
|
|
Depreciation
and amortization
|
81,283
|
178,762
|
Issuance
of capital stock for services and expenses
|
547,838
|
394,825
|
Conversion
of interest
|
68,043
|
-
|
Loss
on conversion of preferred stock
|
-
|
675,695
|
Stock
based compensation
|
37,848
|
46,398
|
Loss
on termination of stock purchase agreement
|
-
|
505,000
|
Non
cash loss on debt settlement
|
-
|
97,037
|
Loss
on sale of assets
|
113,244
|
34,027
|
Loss
on change - derivative liability
|
(145,282
)
|
(2,559,558
)
|
Reclassification
of derivative liability
|
410,324
|
-
|
Amortization
of debt discount
|
158,941
|
299,412
|
Bad
debt expense
|
136,217
|
-
|
Provision
on loss on accounts receivable
|
5,000
|
-
|
Impairment
of goodwill
|
983,645
|
-
|
Changes
in operating assets and liabilities:
|
|
|
Accounts
receivable
|
(20,582
)
|
(189,106
)
|
Prepaid
expenses
|
(7,204
)
|
7,291
|
Inventory
|
69,309
|
(77,394
)
|
Accounts
payable - trade and accrued expenses
|
134,382
|
(406,394
)
|
Deferred
revenue
|
63,902
|
(5,833
)
|
NET
CASH (USED IN) OPERATING ACTIVITIES
|
(1,264,324
)
|
(2,746,333
)
|
|
|
|
CASH
FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
|
|
|
Investment
in BioMedx, Inc., net
|
(260,000
)
|
-
|
Repayment
from investment in BioMedx, Inc., net
|
290,000
|
-
|
Capital
expenditures
|
2,441
|
(23,437
)
|
Proceeds
from sale of equipment
|
1,434
|
6,585
|
NET
CASH PROVIDED BY (USED IN) INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
|
33,875
|
(16,852
)
|
|
|
|
CASH
FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
|
|
|
Proceeds
from line of credit
|
30,321
|
5,647
|
Proceeds
from sale of common and preferred stock, net
|
-
|
2,255,004
|
Proceeds
from warrant exercises
|
-
|
519,162
|
Proceeds
from convertible notes payable
|
690,000
|
1,174,500
|
Loss
on termination of stock purchase agreement
|
-
|
(505,000
)
|
Proceeds
from issuance of common/preferred stock, net of costs
|
550,000
|
-
|
Repayment
of convertible notes
|
(125,000
)
|
(580,085
)
|
NET
CASH PROVIDED BY FINANCING ACTIVITIES
|
1,145,321
|
2,869,228
|
|
|
|
NET
(DECREASE) INCREASE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
|
(85,128
)
|
106,043
|
|
|
|
CASH
AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, beginning of period
|
188,309
|
82,266
|
|
|
|
CASH
AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, end of period
|
$
103,181
|
$
188,309
|
|
|
|
Supplemental
disclosures of cash flow information:
|
|
|
Interest
paid
|
$
47,789
|
$
50,327
|
Taxes
paid
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
|
|
|
Non-cash
investing and financing activities:
|
|
|
Conversion
of convertible debt
|
$
695,000
|
$
-
|
Benificial
conversion feature
|
$
559,130
|
$
-
|
Conversion
of conertible debt to preferred shares
|
$
220,000
|
$
-
|
The
accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
financial statements.
VISUALANT, INCORPORATED AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The
accompanying financial statements have been prepared on a going
concern basis, which contemplates the realization of assets and the
satisfaction of liabilities in the normal course of business. The
Company incurred net losses of $3,901,232 and $1,746,495 for the
years ended September 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Net cash
used in operating activities was $(1,264,324) and $(2,746,333) for
the years ended September 30, 2017 and 2016,
respectively.
The
Company anticipates that it will record losses from operations for
the foreseeable future. As of September 30, 2017, the
Company’s accumulated deficit was $31,533,727. The
Company has limited capital resources, and operations to date have
been funded with the proceeds from private equity and debt
financings and loans from Ronald P. Erickson, our Chief Executive
Officer, or entities with which he is affiliated. These conditions
raise substantial doubt about our ability to continue as a going
concern. The audit report prepared by the Company’s
independent registered public accounting firm relating to our
financial statements for the year ended September 30, 2017 includes
an explanatory paragraph expressing the substantial doubt about the
Company’s ability to continue as a going
concern.
We
believe that our cash on hand will be sufficient to fund our
operations until January 31, 2018.
We
need additional financing to implement our business plan and to
service our ongoing operations and pay our current debts. There can
be no assurance that we will be able to secure any needed funding,
or that if such funding is available, the terms or conditions would
be acceptable to us. If we are unable to obtain additional
financing when it is needed, we will need to restructure our
operations, and divest all or a portion of our business.
We may seek
additional capital through a combination of private and public
equity offerings, debt financings and strategic collaborations.
Debt financing, if obtained, may involve agreements that include
covenants limiting or restricting our ability to take specific
actions, such as incurring additional debt, and could increase our
expenses and require that our assets secure such debt. Equity
financing, if obtained, could result in dilution to our
then-existing stockholders and/or require such stockholders to
waive certain rights and preferences. If such financing is not
available on satisfactory terms, or is not available at all, we may
be required to delay, scale back, eliminate the development of
business opportunities or file for bankruptcy and our operations
and financial condition may be materially adversely
affected.
Visualant, Incorporated (the “Company,”
“Visualant, Inc.” or “Visualant”) was
incorporated under the laws of the State of Nevada in 1998.
The Company has authorized 105,000,000 shares of capital stock, of
which 100,000,000 are shares of voting common stock, par value
$0.001 per share, and 5,000,000 are shares preferred stock, par
value $0.001 per share.
Since 2007, the Company has been focused primarily on the
development of a proprietary technology, which is capable of
uniquely identifying and authenticating almost any substance using
light at the “photon” level to detect the unique
digital “signature” of the substance. The Company calls
this its “ChromaID™” technology.
In 2010, the Company acquired TransTech Systems, Inc. as an adjunct
to its business. TransTech is a distributor of products for
employee and personnel identification. TransTech currently provides
substantially all of the Company’s revenues.
The Company is in the process of commercializing its
ChromaID™ technology. To date, the Company has entered into
License Agreements with Sumitomo Precision Products Co., Ltd. and
Intellicheck, Inc. In addition, it has a technology license
agreement with
Xinova,
formerly
Invention Development Management Company, a subsidiary of
Intellectual Ventures.
The Company believes that its commercialization success is
dependent upon its ability to significantly increase the number of
customers that are purchasing and using its products. To date the
Company has generated minimal revenue from sales of its ChromaID
products. The Company is currently not profitable. Even if the
Company succeeds in introducing the ChromaID technology and related
products to its target markets, the Company may not be able to
generate sufficient revenue to achieve or sustain
profitability.
ChromaID was invented by scientists from the University of
Washington under contract with Visualant. The Company has pursued
an intellectual property strategy and have been granted eleven
patents. The Company also has 20 patents pending. The Company
possess all right, title and interest to the issued patents. Ten of
the pending patents are licensed exclusively to the Company in
perpetuity by the Company’s strategic partner, Allied
Inventors.
3.
|
SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES: ADOPTION OF ACCOUNTING
STANDARDS
|
Basis of Presentation
–
The accompanying unaudited
consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the
Company. Intercompany accounts and transactions have been
eliminated. The preparation of these unaudited condensed
consolidated financial statements were prepared in conformity with
U.S. generally accepted accounting principles
(“GAAP”).
Principles of Consolidation
– The consolidated financial statements
include the accounts of the Company and its wholly owned and
majority-owned subsidiaries, TransTech Systems, Inc. Inter-Company
items and transactions have been eliminated in
consolidation.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
– The Company classifies highly liquid
temporary investments with an original maturity of three months or
less when purchased as cash equivalents. The Company maintains cash
balances at various financial institutions. Balances at US banks
are insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation up to
$250,000. The Company has not experienced any losses in such
accounts and believes it is not exposed to any significant risk for
cash on deposit.
Accounts Receivable and Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
– Accounts receivable consist
primarily of amounts due to the Company from normal business
activities. The Company maintains an allowance for doubtful
accounts to reflect the expected non-collection of accounts
receivable based on past collection history and specific risks
identified within the portfolio. If the financial condition of the
customers were to deteriorate resulting in an impairment of their
ability to make payments, or if payments from customers are
significantly delayed, additional allowances might be
required.
Inventories
– Inventories
consist primarily of printers and consumable supplies, including
ribbons and cards, badge accessories, capture devices, and access
control components held for resale and are stated at the lower of
cost or market on the first-in, first-out (“FIFO”)
method. Inventories are considered available for resale
when drop shipped and invoiced directly to a customer from a
vendor, or when physically received by TransTech at a warehouse
location. The Company records a provision for excess and
obsolete inventory whenever an impairment has been identified.
There is a $35,000 and $25,000 reserve for impaired inventory as of
and September 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Equipment
– Equipment
consists of machinery, leasehold improvements, furniture and
fixtures and software, which are stated at cost less accumulated
depreciation and amortization. Depreciation is computed by the
straight-line method over the estimated useful lives or lease
period of the relevant asset, generally 2-10 years, except for
leasehold improvements which are depreciated over 2-3
years.
Goodwill
– Goodwill is
the excess of cost of an acquired entity over the fair value of
amounts assigned to assets acquired and liabilities assumed in a
business combination. With the adoption of ASC 350, goodwill is not
amortized, rather it is tested for impairment annually, and will be
tested for impairment between annual tests if an event occurs or
circumstances change that would indicate the carrying amount may be
impaired. Impairment testing for goodwill is done at a reporting
unit level. Reporting units are one level below the business
segment level, but are combined when reporting units within the
same segment have similar economic characteristics. Under the
criteria set forth by ASC 350, the Company has one reporting unit
based on the current structure. An impairment loss generally
would be recognized when the carrying amount of the reporting
unit’s net assets exceeds the estimated fair value of the
reporting unit. The Company determined that its goodwill
related to the 2010 acquisition of TransTech Systems was impaired
and recorded an impairment of $983,645 as selling, general and
administrative expenses during the year ended September 30,
2017.
Long-Lived Assets
– The
Company reviews its long-lived assets for impairment annually or
when changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of
an asset may not be recoverable. Long-lived assets under certain
circumstances are reported at the lower of carrying amount or fair
value. Assets to be disposed of and assets not expected to provide
any future service potential to the Company are recorded at the
lower of carrying amount or fair value (less the projected cost
associated with selling the asset). To the extent carrying values
exceed fair values, an impairment loss is recognized in operating
results.
Fair Value Measurements and Financial Instruments
–
ASC Topic 820,
Fair Value Measurement and Disclosures
,
defines fair value as the exchange price that would be received for
an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the
principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in
an orderly transaction between market participants on the
measurement date. This topic also establishes a fair
value hierarchy, which requires classification based on observable
and unobservable inputs when measuring fair value. The
fair value hierarchy distinguishes between assumptions based on
market data (observable inputs) and an entity’s own
assumptions (unobservable inputs). The hierarchy
consists of three levels:
Level 1
– Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and
liabilities;
|
Level 2
– Inputs other than level one inputs that are either directly
or indirectly observable; and.
Level 3
- Inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable and
significant to the fair value measurement.
|
The
recorded value of other financial assets and liabilities, which
consist primarily of cash and cash equivalents, accounts
receivable, other current assets, and accounts payable and accrued
expenses approximate the fair value of the respective assets and
liabilities as of September 30, 2017 and 2016 based upon the
short-term nature of the assets and liabilities.
Derivative financial instruments -
The Company evaluates all
of its financial instruments to determine if such instruments are
derivatives or contain features that qualify as embedded
derivatives. For derivative financial instruments that are
accounted for as liabilities, the derivative instrument is
initially recorded at its fair value and is then re-valued at each
reporting date, with changes in the fair value reported in the
consolidated statements of operations. For stock-based derivative
financial instruments, the Company uses a Black-Scholes-Merton
option pricing model to value the derivative instruments at
inception and on subsequent valuation dates. The classification of
derivative instruments, including whether such instruments should
be recorded as liabilities or as equity, is evaluated at the end of
each reporting period. Derivative instrument liabilities are
classified in the balance sheet as current or non-current based on
whether or not net-cash settlement of the derivative instrument
could be required within twelve months of the balance sheet
date.
Revenue Recognition
–
Visualant and TransTech revenue are derived from products and
services. Revenue is considered realized when the products or
services have been provided to the customer, the work has been
accepted by the customer and collectability is reasonably
assured. Furthermore, if an actual measurement of revenue cannot be
determined, the Company defers all revenue recognition until such
time that an actual measurement can be determined. If during the
course of a contract management determines that losses are expected
to be incurred, such costs are charged to operations in the period
such losses are determined. Revenues are deferred when cash has
been received from the customer but the revenue has not been
earned.
Stock Based Compensation
– The Company has share-based compensation
plans under which employees, consultants, suppliers and directors
may be granted restricted stock, as well as options to purchase
shares of Company common stock at the fair market value at the time
of grant. Stock-based compensation cost is measured by the Company
at the grant date, based on the fair value of the award, over the
requisite service period. For options issued to employees, the
Company recognizes stock compensation costs utilizing the fair
value methodology over the related period of
benefit. Grants of stock options and stock to
non-employees and other parties are accounted for in accordance
with the ASC 505.
Convertible Securities
–
Based upon ASC 815-15, we have
adopted a sequencing approach regarding the application of ASC
815-40 to convertible securities issued subsequent to September 30,
2015. We will evaluate our contracts based upon the earliest
issuance date. In the event partial reclassification of contracts
subject to ASC 815-40-25 is necessary, due to our inability to
demonstrate we have sufficient shares authorized and unissued,
shares will be allocated on the basis of issuance date, with the
earliest issuance date receiving first allocation of shares. If a
reclassification of an instrument were required, it would result in
the instrument issued latest being reclassified first.
Net Loss per Share
–
Under the provisions of ASC 260, “Earnings Per Share,”
basic loss per common share is computed by dividing net loss
available to common stockholders by the weighted average number of
shares of common stock outstanding for the periods presented.
Diluted net loss per share reflects the potential dilution that
could occur if securities or other contracts to issue common stock
were exercised or converted into common stock or resulted in the
issuance of common stock that would then share in the income of the
Company, subject to anti-dilution limitations. The common stock
equivalents have not been included as they are anti-dilutive. As of
September 30, 2017, there were options outstanding for the purchase
of 15,404 common shares, warrants for the purchase of 6,900,356
common shares, 2,825,053 shares of the Company’s common
stock issuable upon the conversion of Series A, Series C and Series
D Convertible Preferred Stock and up to 332,940 shares of the
Company’s common stock issuable upon the exercise of
placement agent warrants. In addition, the Company has an unknown
number of shares are issuable upon conversion of convertible
debentures of $570,000. All of which could potentially dilute
future earnings per share.
As of September 30, 2016, there were options outstanding for the
purchase of 50,908 common shares, warrants for the purchase of
3,182,732 common shares,
1,809,048 shares of our common
stock issuable upon the conversion of Series A and Series C
Convertible Preferred Stock, up to 270,439 shares of our common
stock issuable upon the exercise of placement agent warrants
and an unknown number of shares
related to the conversion of $885,000 in convertible promissory
notes.
Dividend Policy
– The
Company has never paid any cash dividends and intends, for the
foreseeable future, to retain any future earnings for the
development of our business. Our future dividend policy will be
determined by the board of directors on the basis of various
factors, including our results of operations, financial condition,
capital requirements and investment
opportunities.
Use of Estimates
– The
preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting
principles generally accepted in the United States requires
management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the
reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of
contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during
the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those
estimates.
Impact of Recently Issued Accounting Standards on Future
Filings
In May
2014, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”)
issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2014-09,
“Revenue from Contracts with Customers,” which requires
an entity to recognize the amount of revenue to which it expects to
be entitled for the transfer of promised goods or services to
customers. This ASU will replace most existing revenue recognition
guidance in U.S. GAAP when it becomes effective. Subsequent to the
issuance of ASU No. 2014-09, the FASB issued additional ASUs
related to this revenue guidance. In March 2016, the FASB issued
ASU No. 2016-08, “Principal versus Agent
Considerations,” which is intended to improve the operability
and understandability of the implementation guidance on principal
versus agent considerations. In April 2016, the FASB issued ASU No.
2016-10, “Identifying Performance Obligations and
Licensing,” which clarifies the implementation guidance on
identifying performance obligations and licenses in customer
contracts. In May 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-12,
"Narrow-Scope Improvements and Practical Expedients," which
addresses completed contracts and contract modifications at
transition, noncash consideration, the presentation of sales taxes
and other taxes collected from customers, and assessment of
collectibility when determining whether a transaction represents a
valid contract. In December 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-20,
"Technical Corrections and Improvements to Topic 606," which
includes thirteen technical corrections or improvements that affect
only narrow aspects of the guidance in ASU No. 2014-09. ASU No.
2014-09 and all of the related ASUs have the same effective date.
On July 9, 2015, the FASB deferred the effective date of ASU No.
2014-09 for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15,
2017, including interim periods within that reporting period. Early
adoption is permitted as of the original effective date, which is
annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2016 and
interim periods within those annual periods. The new standard is to
be applied retrospectively and permits the use of either the
retrospective or cumulative effect transition method. The adoption
of this update is not expected to have a material impact on
Visualant’s consolidated financial statements.
In
January 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-01, "Recognition and
Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities," which
provides guidance for the recognition, measurement, presentation,
and disclosure of financial assets and liabilities. The amendment
is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December
15, 2018 and interim periods within those annual periods. The
adoption of this update is not expected to have a material impact
on Visualant’s consolidated financial
statements.
In
February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02,
“Leases,” which seeks to increase transparency and
comparability among organizations by recognizing lease assets and
lease liabilities on the balance sheet and by disclosing key
information about leasing arrangements. In general, a right-of-use
asset and lease obligation will be recorded for leases exceeding a
twelve-month term whether operating or financing, while the income
statement will reflect lease expense for operating leases and
amortization/interest expense for financing leases. The balance
sheet amount recorded for existing leases at the date of adoption
must be calculated using the applicable incremental borrowing rate
at the date of adoption. This ASU is effective for annual reporting
periods beginning after December 15, 2018, and interim periods
within those annual periods, and requires the use of the modified
retrospective method, which will require adjustment to all
comparative periods presented in the consolidated financial
statements. Visualant is currently evaluating the effect that the
adoption of this update will have on the consolidated financial
statements.
In
March 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-07, “Simplifying the
Transition to the Equity Method of Accounting,” which
eliminates the requirement that when an investment subsequently
qualifies for use of the equity method as a result of an increase
in level of ownership interest or degree of influence, an investor
must adjust the investment, results of operations, and retained
earnings retroactively on a step-by-step basis as if the equity
method had been in effect during all previous periods that the
investment had been held. This ASU requires that the equity method
investor add the cost of acquiring the additional interest in the
investee to the current basis of the investor’s previously
held interest and to adopt the equity method of accounting as of
the date the investment becomes qualified for equity method
accounting. In addition, the ASU requires that an entity that has
an available-for-sale equity security that becomes qualified for
the equity method of accounting recognize through earnings the
unrealized gain or loss in accumulated other comprehensive income
at the date the investment becomes qualified for use of the equity
method. This ASU is effective for annual reporting periods
beginning after December 15, 2016 and interim periods within those
annual periods, with early adoption permitted. The adoption of this
update is not expected to have a material impact on
Visualant’s consolidated financial statements.
In
March 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-09, “Improvements to
Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting,” which includes
provisions intended to simplify various aspects related to how
share-based payments are accounted for and presented in the
financial statements. This ASU is effective for annual periods
beginning after December 15, 2016 and interim periods within those
annual periods. The adoption of this update did not have a material
impact on Visualant’s consolidated financial
statements.
In
August 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-15, “Classification
of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments,” which addresses
the classification of certain specific cash flow issues including
debt prepayment or extinguishment costs, settlement of certain debt
instruments, contingent consideration payments made after a
business combination, proceeds from the settlement of certain
insurance claims and distributions received from equity method
investees. The guidance is effective for annual reporting periods
beginning after December 15, 2017 and interim periods within those
annual periods. Early adoption is permitted, provided that all of
the amendments are adopted in the same period. The adoption of this
update is not expected to have a material impact on
Visualant’s consolidated financial statements.
In
October 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-16, “Intra-Entity
Transfers of Assets Other Than Inventory,” which provides
guidance on recognition of current income tax consequences for
intra-entity asset transfers (other than inventory) at the time of
transfer. This represents a change from current GAAP, where the
consolidated tax consequences of intra-entity asset transfers are
deferred until the transferred asset is sold to a third party or
otherwise recovered through use. The guidance is effective for
annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017 and
interim periods within those annual periods. Early adoption at the
beginning of an annual period is permitted. The adoption of this
update is not expected to have a material impact on
Visualant’s consolidated financial statements.
In
October 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-17, “Interests
Held through Related Parties That Are under Common Control,”
which modifies existing guidance with respect to how a decision
maker that holds an indirect interest in a VIE through a common
control party determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of
the VIE as part of the analysis of whether the VIE would need to be
consolidated. Under this ASU, a decision maker would need to
consider only its proportionate indirect interest in the VIE held
through a common control party. This ASU is effective for annual
reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2016 and interim
periods within those annual periods. The adoption of this update
did not have a material impact on Visualant’s consolidated
financial statements.
In
November 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-18, "Statement of Cash
Flows - Restricted Cash," which requires that a statement of cash
flows explain the change during the period in the total of cash,
cash equivalents and amounts generally described as restricted cash
or restricted cash equivalents. Thus, amounts generally described
as restricted cash and restricted cash equivalents should be
included with cash and cash equivalents when reconciling the
beginning-of-period and the end-of-period total amounts set forth
on the statement of cash flows. This ASU is effective for annual
reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017 and interim
periods within those annual periods. The amendments should be
applied using a retrospective transition method to each period
presented. The adoption of this update will impact the presentation
of the cash flow statements if Visualant has restricted cash at the
time of adoption.
In
February 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-05, “Clarifying
the Scope of Asset Derecognition Guidance and Accounting for
Partial Sales of Nonfinancial Assets,” which clarifies the
scope of Subtopic 610-20 and adds guidance for partial sales of
nonfinancial assets. ASU No. 2017-05 is effective at the same time
as the revenue standard in ASU No. 2014-09, “Revenue from
Contracts with Customers” goes into effect, which is annual
reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017 and interim
periods within those annual periods. The adoption of the update is
not expected to have an impact on Visualant’s consolidated
financial statements.
In May
2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-09, “Stock Compensation -
Scope of Modification Accounting,” which provides
clarification on when modification accounting should be used for
changes to the terms or conditions of a share-based payment award.
This ASU is effective for interim and annual reporting periods
beginning after December 15, 2017, with early adoption permitted.
The adoption of this update is not expected to have a material
impact on Visualant’s consolidated financial
statements.
Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements
In
August 2014, the Financial Accounting Standards Board
(“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update
(“ASU”) No. 2014-15, “Disclosure of Uncertainties
about an Entity’s Ability to Continue as a Going
Concern,” which requires an entity to evaluate at each
reporting period whether there are conditions or events, in the
aggregate, that raise substantial doubt about the entity’s
ability to continue as a going concern within one year from the
date the financial statements are issued and to provide related
footnote disclosures in certain circumstances. The Company adopted
the provisions of this ASU for the annual reporting period ended
September 30, 2017. The adoption of this update did not have a
material impact on Visualant’s consolidated financial
statements. Visualant has included a going concern footnote
disclosure.
In
January 2015, the FASB issued ASU No. 2015-01, “Simplifying
Income Statement Presentation by Eliminating the Concept of
Extraordinary Items,” which eliminates the concept of an
extraordinary item from GAAP. As a result, an entity will no longer
be required to separately classify, present and disclose
extraordinary events and transactions. The Company adopted the
provisions of this ASU effective October 1, 2016. The adoption of
this update did not have a material impact on Visualant’s
consolidated financial statements.
In
February 2015, the FASB issued ASU No. 2015-02, "Amendments to the
Consolidation Analysis," which simplifies the current consolidation
guidance and will require companies to reevaluate limited
partnerships and similar entities for consolidation. The Company
adopted the provisions of this ASU effective October 1, 2016. The
adoption of this update had no material impact on Visualant’s
consolidated financial statements.
In
April 2015, the FASB issued ASU No. 2015-03, "Simplifying the
Presentation of Debt Issuance Costs." This amendment was issued to
simplify the presentation of debt issuance costs by requiring debt
issuance costs to be presented as a deduction from the
corresponding debt liability. This will make the presentation of
debt issuance costs consistent with the presentation of debt
discounts or premiums. The Company adopted the provisions of this
ASU effective October 1, 2016. The adoption of this update did not
have a material impact on Visualant’s consolidated financial
statements.
In
September 2015, the FASB issued ASU No. 2015-16, "Simplifying the
Accounting for Measurement-Period Adjustments." This ASU eliminates
the requirement to account for business combination measurement
period adjustments retrospectively. Measurement period adjustments
will now be recognized prospectively in the reporting period in
which the adjustment amount is determined. The nature and amount of
any measurement period adjustments recognized during the reporting
period must be disclosed, including the value of the adjustment to
each current period income statement line item relating to the
income effects that would have been recognized in previous periods
if the adjustment to provisional amounts were recognized as of the
acquisition date. The Company adopted the provisions of this ASU
effective October 1, 2016. The adoption of this update had no
impact on Visualant’s consolidated financial
statements.
In
January 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-01, "Clarifying the
Definition of a Business," which clarifies the definition of a
business with the objective of adding guidance to assist entities
with evaluating whether transactions should be accounted for as
acquisitions (or disposals) of assets or businesses. The amendments
in ASU No. 2017-01 provide a screen to determine when a set is not
a business. The screen requires that when substantially all of the
fair value of the gross assets acquired (or disposed of) is
concentrated in a single identifiable asset or a group of similar
identifiable assets, the set is not a business. This screen reduces
the number of transactions that need to be further evaluated. If,
however, the screen is not met, then the amendments in this ASU (1)
require that to be considered a business, a set must include, at a
minimum, an input and a substantive process that together
significantly contribute to the ability to create output and (2)
remove the evaluation of whether a market participant could replace
missing elements. Finally, the amendments in this ASU narrow the
definition of the term "output" so that it is consistent with the
manner in which outputs are described in Topic 606. The adoption of
this update is expected to have no material impact on
Visualant’s consolidated financial statements.
In July
2017, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”)
issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2017-11,
Earnings Per Share (Topic 260), Distinguishing Liabilities from
Equity (Topic 480), Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815). The
amendments in Part I of this Update change the classification
analysis of certain equity-linked financial instruments (or
embedded features) with down round features. When determining
whether certain financial instruments should be classified as
liabilities or equity instruments, a down round feature no longer
precludes equity classification when assessing whether the
instrument is indexed to an entity’s own stock. The
amendments also clarify existing disclosure requirements for
equity-classified instruments. As a result, a freestanding
equity-linked financial instrument (or embedded conversion option)
no longer would be accounted for as a derivative liability at fair
value as a result of the existence of a down round feature. For
freestanding equity classified financial instruments, the
amendments require entities that present earnings per share (EPS)
in accordance with Topic 260 to recognize the effect of the down
round feature when it is triggered. That effect is treated as a
dividend and as a reduction of income available to common
shareholders in basic EPS. Convertible instruments with embedded
conversion options that have down round features are now subject to
the specialized guidance for contingent beneficial conversion
features (in Subtopic 470-20, Debt—Debt with Conversion and
Other Options), including related EPS guidance (in Topic 260). The
amendments in Part II of this Update recharacterize the indefinite
deferral of certain provisions of Topic 480 that now are presented
as pending content in the Codification, to a scope exception. Those
amendments do not have an accounting effect. For public business
entities, the amendments in Part I of this Update are effective for
fiscal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years,
beginning after December 15, 2018. For all other entities, the
amendments in Part I of this Update are effective for fiscal years
beginning after December 15, 2019, and interim periods within
fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2020. Early adoption is
permitted for all entities, including adoption in an interim
period. If an entity early adopts the amendments in an interim
period, any adjustments should be reflected as of the beginning of
the fiscal year that includes that interim period. The Company
early adopted ASU 2017-11 and has reclassified it’s financial
instrument with down round features to equity in the amount of
$410,524.
4.
A
CCOUNTS RECEIVABLE/CUSTOMER
CONCENTRATION
Accounts receivable were $693,320 and $808,955, net of allowance,
as of September 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The Company had
one customer (14.1%) in excess of 10% of the Company’s
consolidated revenues for the year ended September 30, 2017. The
Company had one customer (48.3%) with accounts receivable in excess
of 10% as of September 30, 2017. The Company has a total allowance
for bad debt in the amount of $60,000 as of September 30,
2017.
5.
I
NVENTORIES
Inventories were $225,909 and $295,218 as of September 30, 2017 and
2016, respectively. Inventories consist primarily of printers and
consumable supplies, including ribbons and cards, badge
accessories, capture devices, and access control components held
for resale. There was a $35,000 and $25,000 reserve for impaired
inventory as of September 30, 2017 and 2016,
respectively.
6. NOTES
RECEIVABLE FROM BIOMEDX, INC
On
November 1, 2016, the Company purchased an Original Issue Discount
Convertible Promissory Note from BioMedx, Inc. The Company paid
$260,000 for the Note with a principal amount of $286,000. The Note
matured one year from issuance and bears interest at 5%. The
principal and interest was convertible into BioMedx common stock at
the option of the Company. The Company received 150,000 shares of
BioMedx common stock as partial consideration for purchasing the
Note. In addition, if BioMedx does not repay the Promissory Note,
the Company would have the right to convert the Promissory Note
into 51% of the ownership of BioMedx.
In
addition, the Company and BioMedx agreed to negotiate in good faith
to enter into a joint development agreement and subsequent merger
transaction prior to December 31, 2017.
Due to
the uncertainty involved with a start-up company, The
Company’s management determined that the value of the
Promissory Note and BioMedx common stock was zero at December 31,
2016 and recorded an impairment reserve for the full value as of
December 31, 2016. During the three months ended March 31, 2017,
BioMedx paid the Company $290,608 in full satisfaction of the Note.
The Company recorded the gain as a reduction in SG&A expense
during the three months ended March 31, 2017. In addition, the
Company has not valued the 150,000 shares of BioMedx common
stock.
7.
F
IXED ASSETS
Fixed assets, net of accumulated depreciation, was $133,204 and
$285,415 as of September 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Accumulated depreciation was $662,855 and $796,481 as of September
30, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Total depreciation expense, was
$38,031 and $64,512 for the years ended September 30, 2016 and
2015, respectively. The Company record a loss on sale of assets of
$113,044 during the year ended September 30, 2017. All equipment is
used for selling, general and administrative purposes and
accordingly all depreciation is classified in selling, general and
administrative expenses.
Property and equipment as of September 30, 2017 was comprised of
the following:
|
Estimated
|
|
|
Useful
Lives
|
|
|
|
Machinery
and equipment
|
2-10
years
|
$
251,699
|
$
57,181
|
$
308,880
|
Leasehold
improvements
|
2-3
years
|
276,112
|
-
|
276,112
|
Furniture
and fixtures
|
2-3
years
|
73,977
|
101,260
|
175,237
|
Software
and websites
|
3-
7 years
|
35,830
|
-
|
35,830
|
Less:
accumulated depreciation
|
|
(504,414
)
|
(158,441
)
|
(662,855
)
|
|
$
133,204
|
$
-
|
$
133,204
|
8.
GOODWILL
The Company’s TransTech business is very capital intensive.
The Company reviewed TransTech’s operations based on its
overall financial constraints and determined the value has been
impaired. The company recorded an impairment of goodwill associated
with TransTech of $983,645 during the year ended September 30,
2017.
9. ACCOUNTS PAYABLE
Accounts payable were $2,154,646 and $1,984,326 as
of September 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Such liabilities
consisted of amounts due to vendors for inventory purchases and
technology development, external audit, legal and other expenses
incurred by the Company. The Company had two vendors (10.5% and
10.4%) with accounts payable in excess of 10% of its accounts
payable as of September 30, 2017. The Company does expect to have
vendors with accounts payable balances of 10% of total accounts
payable in the foreseeable future.
10.
DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS
In
April 2008, the FASB issued a pronouncement that provides guidance
on determining what types of instruments or embedded features in an
instrument held by a reporting entity can be considered indexed to
its own stock for the purpose of evaluating the first criteria of
the scope exception in the pronouncement on accounting for
derivatives. This pronouncement was effective for financial
statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15,
2008. The adoption of these requirements can affect the accounting
for warrants and many convertible instruments with provisions that
protect holders from a decline in the stock price (or
“down-round” provisions). For example, warrants or
conversion features with such provisions are no longer recorded in
equity. Down-round provisions reduce the exercise price of a
warrant or convertible instrument if a company either issues equity
shares for a price that is lower than the exercise price of those
instruments or issues new warrants or convertible instruments that
have a lower exercise price.
There
was no derivative liability as of
September 30, 2017.
For the year ended
September 30, 2017, the Company recorded non-cash loss of $217,828
related to the “change in fair value of derivative”
expense related to its derivative instruments. The Company early
adopted ASU 2017-11 and has reclassified its financial instrument
with down round features to equity in the amount of
$410,524.
Derivative
liability as of September 30, 2016 is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fair Value
Measurements Using Inputs
|
|
Financial
Instruments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
Derivative
Instruments
|
$
-
|
$
145,282
|
$
-
|
$
145,282
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
$
-
|
$
145,282
|
$
-
|
$
145,282
|
For the
year ended September 30, 2016, the Company recorded non-cash income
of $1,324,384 related to the “change in fair value of
derivative” expense related to its 6%, 7% and 18% convertible
notes.
Derivative Instruments – Warrants with the June 2013 Private
Placement
The
Company issued warrants to purchase 697,370 shares of common stock
in connection with our June 2013 private placement of 348,685
shares of common stock. The per share price is subject
to adjustment. In August 2016, the exercise price was reset to
$0.70 per share. These warrants were not issued with the
intent of effectively hedging any future cash flow, fair value of
any asset, liability or any net investment in a foreign
operation. These warrants were issued with a down-round
provision whereby the exercise price would be adjusted downward in
the event that additional shares of our common stock or securities
exercisable, convertible or exchangeable for the Company’s
common stock were issued at a price less than the exercise
price. Therefore, the fair value of these warrants were
recorded as a liability in the consolidated balance sheet and are
marked to market each reporting period until they are exercised or
expire or otherwise extinguished.
The
proceeds from the private placement were allocated between the
shares of common stock and the warrants issued in connection with
the private placement based upon their estimated fair values as of
the closing date at June 14, 2013, resulting in the aggregate
amount of $2,494,710 allocated to stockholders’ equity and
$2,735,290 allocated to the warrant derivative. The
Company recognized $1,448,710 of other expense resulting from the
increase in the fair value of the warrant liability at September
30, 2013. During the year ended September 30, 2014, the Company
recognized $2,092,000 of other income resulting from the decrease
in the fair value of the warrant liability at September 30, 2014.
During the year ended September 30, 2015, the Company recognized
$104,716 of other expense resulting from the decrease in the fair
value of the warrant liability at September 30, 2015. During the
year ended September 30, 2016, the Company recognized $2,085,536 of
other income resulting from the decrease in the fair value of the
warrant liability at September 30, 2016.
As of
June 30, 2017, the Company had outstanding 524,559 warrants to
purchase shares of common stock in connection with our June 2013
private placement that the Company determined had an embedded
derivative liability due to the “reset” clause
associated with the note’s conversion price. The Company
valued the derivative liability of these notes at $22,556 using the
Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing model, which approximates the
Monte Carlo and other binomial valuation techniques, with the
following assumptions (i) dividend yield of 0%; (ii) expected
volatility of 113.0%; (iii) risk free rate of .007%, (iv) stock
price of $0.25, (v) per share conversion price of $0.70, and (vi)
expected term of 1.0 year. During the nine months June 30, 2017,
the Company recognized $88,624 of income resulting from the
decrease in the fair value of the warrant liability as of June 30,
2017.
Derivative Instruments – Warrant with the November 2013
Allied Inventors Services and License Agreement
|
The
Company issued a warrant to purchase 97,169 shares of common stock
in connection with the November 2013 Allied Inventors Services
and License Agreement. The warrant price of $30.00 per share
expires November 10, 2018 and the per share price is subject to
adjustment. In August 2016, the exercise price was reset to
$0.70 per share. This warrant was not issued with the intent
of effectively hedging any future cash flow, fair value of any
asset, liability or any net investment in a foreign
operation. This warrant was issued with a down-round
provision whereby the exercise price would be adjusted downward in
the event that additional shares of our common stock or securities
exercisable, convertible or exchangeable for our common stock were
issued at a price less than the exercise
price. Therefore, the fair value of these warrants was
recorded as a liability in the consolidated balance sheet and are
marked to market each reporting period until they are exercised or
expire or otherwise extinguished. During the year ended September
30, 2014, the Company recognized $320,657 of other expense related
to the Allied Inventors warrant. During the year ended September
30, 2015, the Company recognized $14,574 of other income related to
the Allied Inventors warrant. During the year ended September 30,
2016, the Company recognized $286,260 of other income from the
decrease in the fair value of the warrant liability at September
30, 2016.
As of
June 30, 2017, the Company had outstanding 97,169 warrants to
purchase shares of common stock in connection with
the November 2013 Allied Inventors Services and License
Agreement that the Company determined had an embedded derivative
liability due to the “reset” clause associated with the
note’s conversion price. The Company valued the derivative
liability of these notes at $4,178 using the Black-Scholes-Merton
option pricing model, which approximates the Monte Carlo and other
binomial valuation techniques, with the following
assumptions (i) dividend yield of 0%; (ii) expected volatility
of 113.0%; (iii) risk free rate of .007%, (iv) stock price of
$0.25, (v) per share conversion price of $0.70, and (vi) expected
term of 1.0 year. During the nine months June 30, 2017, the Company
recognized $15,644 of income resulting from the decrease in the
fair value of the warrant liability as of June 30,
2017.
Derivative Instrument – Series A Convertible Preferred
Stock
The
Company issued 11,667 shares of Series A Convertible Preferred
Stock with attached warrants during the year ended September 30,
2015. The Company allocated $233,322 to stockholder’s equity
and $116,678 to the derivative warrant liability. The warrants were
issued with a down round provision. The warrants have a term of
five years, 23,334 are exercisable at $30 per common share and
23,334 are exercisable at $45 per common share. On August 4, 2016,
the exercise price was adjusted to $0.70 per share. During the year
ended September 30, 2015, the Company recognized $30,338 of other
expense related to the warrant liability. During the year ended
September 30, 2016, the Company recognized $132,724 of other income
resulting from the decrease in the fair value of the warrant
liability at September 30, 2016.
As of
June 30, 2017, the Company had outstanding 11,667 shares of Series
A Convertible Preferred Stock with attached warrants that the
Company determined had an embedded derivative liability due to the
“reset” clause associated with the note’s
conversion price. The Company valued the derivative liability of
these notes at $3,010 using the Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing
model, which approximates the Monte Carlo and other binomial
valuation techniques, with the following assumptions (i)
dividend yield of 0%;(ii) expected volatility of 113.0%; (iii) risk
free rate of .007%, (iv) stock price of $0.25, (v) per share
conversion price of $0.70, and (vi) expected term of 1.0 year.
During the nine months June 30, 2017, the Company recognized
$11,270 of income resulting from the increase in the fair value of
the warrant liability as of June 30, 2017.
Derivative Instrument – Series C Convertible Preferred
Stock
The
Company issued 1,785,715 shares of Series C Convertible Preferred
Stock with attached warrants during the year ended September 30,
2016. In February 2017, the Company modified the term of the
warrants to provide a down round provision.
As of
June 30, 2017, the Company had outstanding 1,785,715 shares of
Series C Convertible Preferred Stock with attached warrants that
the Company determined had an embedded derivative liability due to
the “reset” clause associated with the note’s
conversion price. The Company valued the derivative liability of
these notes at $266,071 using the Black-Scholes-Merton option
pricing model, which approximates the Monte Carlo and other
binomial valuation techniques, with the following
assumptions (i) dividend yield of 0%; (ii) expected volatility
of 113.0%; (iii) risk free rate of .007%, (iv) stock price of
$0.25, (v) per share conversion price of $0.70, and (vi) expected
term of 4.0 years. During the nine months June 30, 2017, the
Company recognized $266,071 of other expense resulting from the
modification of the warrant, net of the decrease in the fair value
of the warrant liability as of June 30, 2017.
Derivative Instrument – Placement Agent Warrants
During
the nine months ended June 30, 2017, the Company revised five year
placement agent warrants to purchase 312,500 shares of common
stock. In February 2017, the Company reduced the price from $1.00
to $0.70 per share and the exercise price is now subject to
adjustment.
As of
June 30, 2017, the Company had placement agent warrants to purchase
312,500 shares of common stock that the Company determined had an
embedded derivative liability due to the “reset” clause
associated with the note’s conversion price. The Company
valued the derivative liability of these notes at $13,438 using the
Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing model, which approximates the
Monte Carlo and other binomial valuation techniques, with the
following assumptions (i) dividend yield of 0%; (ii) expected
volatility of 113.0%; (iii) risk free rate of .007%, (iv) stock
price of $0.25, (v) per share conversion price of $0.70, and (vi)
expected term of 1.0 year. During the nine months June 30, 2017,
the Company recognized $13,428 of other expense resulting from the
modification of the warrant, net of the decrease in the fair value
of the warrant liability as of June 30, 2017.
Derivative Instrument – Series D Convertible Preferred
Stock
The
Company issued 1,016,014 shares of Series C Convertible Preferred
Stock with attached warrants during the nine months ended June 30,
2017. In February 2017, the Company modified the term of the
warrants to provide a down round provision.
As of
June 30, 2017, the Company had outstanding 1,016,014 shares of
Series D Convertible Preferred Stock with attached warrants that
the Company determined had an embedded derivative liability due to
the “reset” clause associated with the note’s
conversion price. The Company valued the derivative liability of
these notes at $101,271 using the Black-Scholes-Merton option
pricing model, which approximates the Monte Carlo and other
binomial valuation techniques, with the following
assumptions (i) dividend yield of 0%; (ii) expected volatility
of 113.0%; (iii) risk free rate of .007%, (iv) stock price of
$0.25, (v) per share conversion price of $0.70, and (vi) expected
term of 4.35 years. During the nine months June 30, 2017, the
Company recognized $101,171 of other expense resulting from the
modification of the warrant, net of the decrease in the fair value
of the warrant liability as of June 30, 2017.
11. CONVERTIBLE NOTES PAYABLE
Convertible notes payable as of September 30, 2017 and September
30, 2016 consisted of the following:
The Company entered into Convertible Promissory Notes totaling
$710,000 with accredited investors during September 2015 to
February 2016 to fund short-term working capital. The Notes accrue
interest at a rate of 8% per annum and become due September 2016 to
February 2017 and are convertible into common stock at the same
price of our next financing. On November 31, 2016, holders of
$695,000 of the Convertible Promissory Notes converted to 944,948
shares of common stock and five year warrants to purchase common
stock at a price of $1.00 per share.
The
Company recorded accrued interest of $14,687
during the year ended September 30, 2017. On February 15, 2017, the
Company repaid the remaining $15,000 Promissory Note and accrued
interest in cash.
On September 30, 2016, the Company entered into a $210,000
Convertible Promissory Note with Clayton A. Struve, an accredited
investor and affiliate of the Company, to fund short-term working
capital. The Convertible Promissory Note accrues interest at a rate
of 10% per annum and becomes due on March 30, 2017. The Note holder
can convert to common stock at $0.70 per share. During the year
ended September 30, 2017, the Company recorded interest of $ 21,000
related to the convertible note.
This note was extended in the Securities Purchase Agreement,
General Security Agreement and Subordination Agreement dated August
14, 2017 with a maturity date of August 13, 2018.
The Company entered into two Convertible Promissory Notes totaling
$330,000 with accredited investors during on November 1, 2016. The
Notes accrue interest at a rate of 10% per annum and become due May
1, 2017 and are convertible into Preferred stock at a conversion
price of $0.80 per share and a five-year warrant to purchasea share
of common stock at $1.00 per share. The company first allocated the
value received to the warrants based on the Black Scholes value
assuming a 1 year life, 130% volatility and .7% risk free interest
rate. The remaining value was below the fair market value on the
date of issuance and as a result the company recorded and
beneficial conversion dividend of $326,687 at the time
issuance.
The
Company recorded
interest of $10,633 as of February 24, 2017.
On February 24,
2016, The Company paid $113,544 in full payment of an Original
Issue Discount Convertible Promissory Note issued to an accredited
investor on November 1, 2016. On February 24, 2017, the holder of
an Original Issue Discount Convertible Promissory Note issued on
November 1, 2016 converted the principal and outstanding interest
of $227,088 into 283,861 shares of the Company’s Series D
Preferred Stock and a five-year warrant to purchase 283,861 shares
of common stock.
On August 14, 2017, the Company issued a senior convertible
exchangeable debenture with a principal amount of $360,000 and a
common stock purchase warrant to purchase 1,440,000 shares of
common stock in a private placement to Clayton Struve for gross
proceeds of $300,000 pursuant to a Securities Purchase Agreement
dated August 14, 2017. The debenture accrues interest at 20% per
annum and matures August 13, 2018. The convertible debenture
contains a beneficial conversion valued at $110,629. The warrants
were valued at $111,429. Because the note is immediately
convertible, the warrants and beneficial conversion were expensed
as interest.
On the same date, the Company entered into a General Security
Agreement with the investor, pursuant to which the Company has
agreed to grant a security interest to the investor in
substantially all the Company’s assets, effective upon the
filing of a UCC-3 termination statement to terminate the security
interest held by Capital Source Business Finance Group in the
assets of the Company. In addition, an entity affiliated with
Ronald P. Erickson, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer,
entered into a Subordination Agreement with the investor pursuant
to which all debt owed by the Company to such entity is
subordinated to amounts owed by the Company to the investor under
the Debenture (including amounts that become owing under any
Debentures issued to the investor in the future).
The initial conversion price of the Debenture is $0.25 per share,
subject to certain adjustments. The initial exercise price of the
Warrant is $0.25 per share, also subject to certain
adjustments.
As part of the Purchase Agreement, the Company granted the investor
“piggyback” registration rights to register the shares
of common stock issuable upon the conversion of the Debenture and
the exercise of the Warrant with the Securities and Exchange
Commission for resale or other disposition.
The Debenture and the Warrant were issued in a transaction that was
not registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
“Act”) in reliance upon applicable exemptions from
registration under Section 4(a)(2) of the Act and Rule 506 of SEC
Regulation D under the Act.
In connection with the private placement, the placement agent for
the Debenture and the Warrant received a cash fee of $30,000 and
the Company expects to issue warrants to purchase shares of the
Company’s common stock to the placement agent based on 10% of
proceeds.
Under the terms of the Purchase Agreement, the investor may
purchase up to an aggregate of $1,000,000 principal amount of
Debentures (before a 20% original issue discount) (and Warrants to
purchase up to an aggregate of 250,000 shares of common stock).
These securities are being offered on a “best efforts”
basis by the placement agent.
During the year ended September 30, 2017 and 2016, $156,941 and
$299,412, respectively, has been recorded as interest expense
related to debt discounts, beneficial conversions and warrants
associated with Convertible Promissory Notes.
12.
|
NOTES PAYABLE, CAPITALIZED LEASES AND LONG-TERM DEBT
|
Notes payable, capitalized leases and long-term debt as of
September 30, 2017 and 2016 consisted of the
following:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital
Source Business Finance Group
|
$
365,725
|
$
370,404
|
Note
payable to Umpqua Bank
|
199,935
|
199,935
|
Secured
note payable to J3E2A2Z LP - related party
|
600,000
|
600,000
|
Total
debt
|
1,165,660
|
1,170,339
|
Less
current portion of long term debt
|
(1,165,660
)
|
(1,170,339
)
|
Long
term debt
|
$
-
|
$
-
|
Capital Source Business Finance Group
The
Company finances its TransTech operations from operations and a
Secured Credit Facility with Capital Source
Business
Finance
Group. On December 9, 2008,
TransTech entered into a $1,000,000 secured credit facility with
Capital Source
to fund
its operations. On June 6, 2017, TransTech entered into the
Fourth Modification to the Loan and Security Agreement. This
secured credit facility was renewed until June 12, 2018 with a
floor for prime interest of 4.5% (currently 4.5%) plus 2.5%. The
eligible borrowing is based on 80% of eligible trade accounts
receivable, not to exceed $500,000. The secured credit facility is
collateralized by the assets of TransTech, with a guarantee by
Visualant, including a security interest in all assets of
Visualant. The remaining balance on the accounts receivable line of
$365,725 ($16,000 available) as of September 30, 2017 must be
repaid by the time the secured credit facility expires on June 12,
2018, or the Company renews by automatic extension for the next
successive one year term.
Note Payable to Umpqua Bank
The Company has a $199,935 Business Loan Agreement with Umpqua
Bank. On December 19, 2017, the Umpqua Loan maturity was extended
to March 31, 2018 and provides for interest at 4.00% per
year.
Related to this Umpqua Loan, the Company entered into
a demand promissory note for $200,000 on January 10, 2014 with an
entity affiliated with Ronald P. Erickson, our Chief Executive
Officer. This demand promissory note will be effective in case of a
default by the Company under the Umpqua Loan.
Note Payables to Ronald P. Erickson or J3E2A2Z LP
The Company also has two other demand promissory notes payable to
entities affiliated with Mr. Erickson, totaling $600,000. Each of
these notes were issued between January and July 2014, provide for
interest of 3% per year and now mature on December 31, 2017. The
notes payable also provide for a second lien on our assets if not
repaid by December 31, 2017 or converted into convertible
debentures or equity on terms acceptable to the Mr. Erickson. The
Company recorded accrued interest of $58,167 as of September 30,
2017.
Aggregate maturities totaling $1,165,660 are all due within twelve
months.
13. EQUITY
Authorized Capital Stock
The
Company authorized 105,000,000 shares of capital stock, of which
100,000,000 are shares of voting common stock, par value $0.001 per
share, and 5,000,000 are shares preferred stock, par value $0.001
per share.
Voting Preferred Stock
The Company is authorized to issue up to 5,000,000 shares of
preferred stock with a par value of $0.001.
Series A Preferred Stock
On July 21, 2015, the Company filed with the Nevada Secretary of
State an Amended and Restated Certificate of Designations,
Preferences and Rights for our Series A Convertible Preferred
Stock. Among other things, the Amended and Restated Certificate
changed the conversion price and the stated value of the Series A
Preferred from $0.10 (pre reverse stock split) to $30.00
(post-reverse stock split), and added a provision adjusting the
conversion price upon the occurrence of certain
events.
Under
the Amended and Restated Certificate, the Company had 11,667 shares
of Series A Preferred authorized, all of which are outstanding.
Each holder of outstanding shares of Series A Preferred is entitled
to the number of votes equal to the number of whole shares of
common stock into which the shares of Series A Preferred held by
such holder are then convertible as of the applicable record date.
The Company cannot amend, alter or repeal any preferences, rights,
or other terms of the Series A Preferred so as to adversely affect
the Series A Preferred, without the written consent or affirmative
vote of the holders of at least 66% of the then outstanding shares
of Series A Preferred, voting as a separate voting group, given by
written consent or by vote at a meeting called for such purpose for
which notice shall have been duly given to the holders of the
Series A Preferred.
During
the year ended September 30, 2015, the Company sold 11,667 Series A
Preferred Stock to two investors totaling $350,000. These shares
are expected to be convertible into 11,667 shares of common stock
at $30.00 per share, subject to adjustment, for a period of five
years. The Series A Preferred Stock has voting rights
and may not be redeemed without the consent of the
holder.
The
Company also issued (i) a Series C five-year Warrant for 23,334
shares of common stock at an exercise price of $30.00 per share,
which is callable at $60.00 per share; and (ii) a Series D
five-year Warrant for 23,334 shares of common stock at an exercise
price of $45.00 per share, which is callable at $90.00 per share.
The Series A Preferred Stock and Series C and D Warrants had
registration rights.
On July 20, 2015, the two investors entered into an Amendment to
Series A Preferred Stock Terms whereby they agreed to the terms of
the
Amended and Restated Certificate of Designations,
Preferences and Rights of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock and
waived all registration rights.
On
August 4, 2016, the price of the
Series A Preferred Stock
was adjusted to
$0.70 per share due to the issuance of common stock at that
price.
On
March 8, 2016, we received approval from the State of Nevada for
the Correction to the Company’s Amended and Restated
Certificate of Designations, Preferences and Rights of its Series A
Convertible Preferred Stock. The Amended and Restated Certificate
filed July 21, 2015 changed the conversion price and the stated
value from $0.10 (pre reverse stock split) to $30.00 (post-reverse
stock split), and adding a provision adjusting the conversion price
upon the occurrence of certain events. On February 19, 2016, the
holders of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock entered into
Amendment 2 of Series A Preferred Stock Terms and increased the
number of Preferred Stock Shares to properly account for the
reverse stock split. The Company has 23,334 Series A Preferred
Stock issued and outstanding.
On August 14, 2017,
the price of the
Series A Preferred Stock
and Series C
Warrants were adjusted to $0.25 per share
pursuant to the documents governing such
instruments.
Series B Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock
On
March 8, 2016, the Company received approval from the State of
Nevada for the Certificate of Designations of Preferences, Powers,
Rights and Limitations of Series B Redeemable Convertible Preferred
Stock. The Certificate authorized 5,000 shares of Series B
Preferred Stock at a par value of $.001 per share that is
convertible into common stock at $7.50 per share, subject to
certain adjustments as set forth in the Certificate.
The
Company entered into a Stock Purchase Agreement with an
institutional investor pursuant to which the Company issued 255
Shares of Series B Redeemable Preferred Shares (“Series B
Preferred Shares”) of the Company at $10,000 per share with a
5.0% original issue discount for the sum of
$2,500,000.
At
closing, the Company sold 51 Series B Preferred Shares in exchange
for payment to the Company of $505,000 in cash and issued an
additional 204 Series B Preferred Shares in exchange for delivery
of a full recourse 1% Promissory Note (“Note”) for
$1,995,000 and payment to the Company of $5,000 in cash (paid). The
Note is collateralized by the Series B Preferred Shares. Under the
terms of the Note, the Company is to receive an additional $500,000
for each $5 million, or in certain cases a lower amount, in
aggregate trading volume of the common stock, so long as it meets
certain other requirements. Any remaining balance under the Note is
payable at its maturity in seven years. Due to the uncertainty on
the receipt of achieving future funding, the Company has not booked
the full recourse 1% Promissory Note.
The
Series B Preferred Shares are convertible into common stock at
$7.50 per share; provided that the institutional investor may not
convert any Series B Preferred Shares into common stock until that
portion of the Note underlying the purchase of the converted
portion of Series B Preferred Shares is paid in cash to
Company.
The Company may issue, at our sole discretion in lieu of cash, as a
conversion premium or in payment of dividends on such shares of
Series B Preferred Shares. The number of additional common shares
that we may issue as a conversion premium or in payment of
dividends, is dependent on the dividend rate which can vary
depending on our underlying stock price at the time of conversion
and assuming no triggering event has occurred.
The
Company filed a Registration Statement on Form S-1, which was
declared effective May 6, 2016, to register $2,675,000 for the
resale of all shares of common stock issuable upon conversion of
the Series B Shares.
In the
third quarter ended June 30, 2016, the investor converted 35
preferred shares into 74,064 shares of common stock valued at
$506,695. Prior to the closing of the First Amendment to the Stock
Purchase Agreement the investor converted the remaining 16
preferred shares into 52,000 shares of common stock valued at
$169,000.
On August 5, 2016, the Company closed the First Amendment to Stock
Purchase Agreement with the institutional investor. As a result of
this amendment agreement the Company paid the sum of $505,000 to
the institutional investor and cancelled the remaining 204 shares
of Series B Preferred Stock that had not been purchased, and the
parties terminated the relationship and all aspects of the Stock
Purchase Agreement described above in its entirety.
We recorded an expense of $674,000
related to this Amendment Agreement during the three months ended
September 30, 2016, which includes the conversion of the remaining
16 shares.
On September 1, 2016, the Company filed a Withdrawal of
Certificate of Designations of Preferences, Powers, Rights and
Limitations of Series B Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock with
the State of Nevada. In August 15, 2016, the SEC approved the
withdrawal of the Registration Statement on Form S-1.
Series C and D Preferred Stock and Warrants
On
August 5, 2016, the Company closed a Series C Preferred Stock and
Warrant Purchase Agreement with Clayton A. Struve, an accredited
investor for the purchase of $1,250,000 of preferred stock with a
conversion price of $0.70 per share. The preferred stock has a
yield of 8% and an ownership blocker of 4.99%. In addition, Mr.
Struve received a five year warrant to acquire 1,785,714 shares of
common stock at $0.70 per share.
To
determine the effective conversion price, a portion of the proceeds
received by the Company upon issuance of the Series C Preferred
Stock was first allocated to the freestanding warrants issued as
part of this transaction. Given that the warrants will not
subsequently be measured at fair value, the Company determined that
the warrants should receive an allocation of the proceeds based on
their relative fair value. This is based on the understanding that
the FASB staff and the SEC staff believe that a freestanding
instrument issued in a basket transaction should be initially
measured at fair value if it is required to be subsequently
measured at fair value pursuant to US generally accepted accounting
principles (“GAAP”), with the residual proceeds from
the transaction allocated to any remaining instruments based on
their relative fair values. As such, the warrants were allocated a
fair value of approximately $514,706 upon issuance, with the
remaining $735,294 of proceeds allocated to the Series C Preferred
Stock.
Proportionately,
this allocation resulted in approximately 59% of the face amount of
the Series C Preferred Stock issuance remaining, which applied to
the stated conversion price of $0.70 resulted in an effective
conversion price of approximately $0.41.
Having
determined the effective conversion price, the Company then
compared this to the fair value of the underlying Common Stock as
of the commitment date, which was approximately $1.06 per share,
and concluded that the conversion feature did have an intrinsic
value of $0.65 per share. As such, the Company concluded that the
Series C Preferred Stock did contain a beneficial conversion
feature and an accounting entry and additional financial statement
disclosure was required.
Because
our preferred stock is perpetual, with no stated maturity date, and
the conversions may occur any time from inception, the dividend is
recognized immediately when a beneficial conversion exists at
issuance. During the year ending September 30, 2016, the Company.
recognized preferred stock dividends of $1.16 million on Series C
preferred stock related to the beneficial conversion feature
arising from a common stock effective conversion rate of $0.41
versus a current market price of $1.06 per common
share.
On
November 14, 2016, the Company issued 187,500 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 187,500
shares of common stock in a private placement to certain accredited
investors for gross proceeds of $150,000 pursuant to a Series D
Preferred Stock and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated November 10,
2016.
The
warrants associated with the November 14, 2016 issuance were
allocated a fair value of approximately $56,539 upon issuance, with
the remaining $63,539 of net proceeds allocated to the Series D
Preferred Stock. Proportionately, this allocation resulted in
approximately 53% of the amount of the Series D Preferred Stock
issuance remaining, which applied to the stated conversion price of
$0.80 resulted in an effective conversion price of approximately
$0.34. Having determined the effective conversion price, the
Company then compared this to the fair value of the underlying
Common Stock as of the commitment date, which was approximately
$1.14 per share, and concluded that the conversion feature did have
an intrinsic value of $0.80 per share. As such, the Company
concluded that the Series D Preferred Stock did contain a
beneficial conversion feature of $150,211 which was recorded as a
beneficial conversion in stockholders’ equity.
On
December 19, 2016, the Company issued 187,500 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 187,500
shares of common stock in a private placement to an accredited
investor for gross proceeds of $150,000 pursuant to a Series D
Preferred Stock and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated December 14,
2016.
The
warrants associated with the December 19, 2016 issuance were
allocated a fair value of approximately $60,357 upon issuance, with
the remaining $69,643 of net proceeds allocated to the Series D
Preferred Stock. Proportionately, this allocation resulted in
approximately 54% of the amount of the Series D Preferred Stock
issuance remaining, which applied to the stated conversion price of
$0.80 resulted in an effective conversion price of approximately
$0.37. Having determined the effective conversion price, the
Company then compared this to the fair value of the underlying
Common Stock as of the commitment date, which was approximately
$0.81 per share, and concluded that the conversion feature did have
an intrinsic value of $0.44 per share. As such, the Company
concluded that the Series C Preferred Stock did contain a
beneficial conversion feature of $82,232 which was recorded as a
beneficial conversion in stockholders’ equity.
Because
the Company’s preferred stock is perpetual, with no stated
maturity date, and the conversions may occur any time from
inception, the dividend is recognized immediately when a beneficial
conversion exists at issuance. During the year ending September 30,
2017, the Company. recognized preferred stock dividends of $234,443
million on Series D preferred stock related to the beneficial
conversion feature arising from a common stock effective conversion
rate of $0.34 and $0.37 versus the original market price of $1.14
and $1.06 per common share, respectively.
On May 1, 2017, the Company issued 357,143 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock (the “Series D Shares”) and
a warrant to purchase 357,143 shares of common stock in a private
placement to an accredited investor for gross proceeds of $250,000
pursuant to a Series D Preferred Stock and Warrant Purchase
Agreement dated May 1, 2016.
The initial conversion price of the Series D Shares is $0.70 per
share, subject to certain adjustments. The initial exercise price
of the warrant is $0.70 per share, also subject to certain
adjustments. The Company also amended and restated the Certificate
of Designation for the Series D Shares, resulting in an adjustment
to the conversion price of all currently outstanding Series D
Shares to $0.70 per share.
Having determined the effective conversion price, the Company then
compared this to the fair value of the underlying Common Stock as
of the commitment date, which was approximately $0.48 per share,
and concluded that the conversion feature did not have an intrinsic
value. As such, the Company concluded that the Series D Preferred
Stock did not contain a beneficial conversion feature and an
accounting entry and additional financial statement disclosure was
not required
Common Stock
All of the offerings and sales described below were deemed to be
exempt under Rule 506 of Regulation D and/or Section 4(a)(2) of the
Securities Act. No advertising or general solicitation was employed
in offering the securities, the offerings and sales were made to a
limited number of persons, all of whom were accredited investors
and transfer was restrictedby the company in accordance with the
requirements of Regulation D and the Securities Act. All issuances
to accredited and non-accredited investors were structured to
comply with the requirements of the safe harbor afforded by Rule
506 of Regulation D, including limiting the number of
non-accredited investors to no more than 35 investors who have
sufficient knowledge and experience in financial and business
matters to make them capable of evaluating the merits and risks of
an investment in our securities.
The following equity issuances occurred during the year ended
September 30, 2017:
On October 21, 2015, the Company entered into a Public Relations
Agreement with Financial Genetics LLC for public relation services.
On October 18, 2016, the Company entered into an Amendment to
Public Relations Agreement with Financial Genetics LLC. Under the
Agreements, Financial Genetics was issued 359,386 shares of our
common stock during the year ended September 30, 2017. The Company
expensed $271,309 during the year ended September 30,
2017.
On October 6, 2016, the Company entered into a Services Agreement
with Redwood Investment Group LLC for financial services. Under the
Agreement, Redwood was issued 200,000 shares of our common stock.
The Company expensed $140,000 during the year ended September 30,
2017.
The Company entered into Convertible Promissory Notes totaling
$710,000 with accredited investors during September 2015 to
February 2016 to fund short-term working capital. The Notes accrued
interest at a rate of 8% per annum and became due September 2016 to
February 2017 and were convertible into common stock as part of our
next financing. On November 30, 2016, the Company converted
$695,000 of the /Convertible Promissory Notes and interest of
$54,078 into 936,348 shares of comment stock. The Company also
issued warrants to purchase 936,348 shares of the Company’s
common stock. The five-year warrants are exercisable at $1.00 per
share, subject to adjustment.
On December 22, 2016, a supplier converted accounts payable
totaling $6,880 into 8,600 shares of common stock.
On the year ended September 30, 2017, the Company issued 795,000
shares of restricted common stock to two Names Executive Officers
employees, two directors and six employees and consultants and for
services during 2015-2017. The shares were issued in accordance
with the 2011 Stock Incentive Plan and were valued at $0.17 per
share, the market price of our common stock. The Company expensed
$135,150 during the year ended September 30, 2017.
The following equity issuances occurred during the year ended
September 30, 2016:
Thirteen investors exercised warrants at $2.50 per share and were
issued 207,667 shares of common stock, for a total of $519,162 in
proceeds to the Company.
On October 21, 2015, the Company entered into a Public Relations
Agreement with Financial Genetics LLC for public relation services.
Under the Agreement, Financial Genetics was issued 35,268 shares of
our common stock. The Company expensed $218,653 during the year
ended September 30, 2016.
On October 6, 2015, the Company entered into a Consulting Agreement
with Joshua Conroy for business development services. Under the
Agreement, Mr. Conroy was issued 1,711 shares of our common stock.
The Company expensed $11,977 during the year ended September 30,
2016.
The Company entered into Convertible Promissory Notes totaling
$710,000 with accredited investors during September 2015 to
February 2016 to fund short-term working capital. The Notes accrue
interest at a rate of 8% per annum and become due September 2016 to
February 2017 and are convertible into common stock as part of our
next financing. The investors received $710,000 in warrants that
are exercisable into common stock at the price equal to the price
of the common stock sold in our next public financing.
The Company entered into 8%-10% Convertible Promissory Notes and
Securities Purchase Agreements with three accredited investors on
February 4, 2016, totaling $165,000 with an original issue discount
of $15,000.
The Company issued a total of 10,500 shares of
restricted common stock to the investors valued at $70,875 and paid
$7,500 in legal fees. The Company received $128,500 net of all
fees.
On February 23, 2016, the Company entered into a Consulting
Agreement with David Markowski for business development services.
On February 29, 2016, Mr. Markowski was issued 2,000 shares of our
common stock. The Company expensed $14,600 during the year ended
September 30, 2016.
On July 12, 2016, a supplier converted accounts payable totaling
$232,966 into 77,665 shares of common stock valued at $3.00 per
share.
On August 1, 2016, the Company entered an Agreement with Axiom
Financial, Inc. for business development services. Under the
Agreement, the Company issued 25,000 shares of our common stock.
The Company expensed $29,000 during the year ended September 30,
2016.
On August 10, 2016, the Company closed a Stock Purchase Agreement
with Dale Broadrick, an accredited investor and affiliate of the
Company for the purchase of $500,000 of the Company’s common
stock at $0.70 per share or 714,286 shares of common stock. In
addition, the investor received 100% warrant coverage with a five
year warrant having a strike price of $0.70. These common shares
and warrants are not subject to a registration
statement.
Warrants to Purchase Common Stock
The following warrants were issued during the year ended September
30, 2017:
The Company entered into Convertible Promissory Notes totaling
$710,000 with accredited investors during September 2015 to
February 2016 to fund short-term working capital. The Notes accrued
interest at a rate of 8% per annum and became due September 2016 to
February 2017 and were convertible into common stock as part of our
next financing. On November 30, 2016, the Company converted
$695,000 of the /Convertible Promissory Notes and interest of
$54,078 into 936,348 shares of comment stock. The Company also
issued warrants to purchase 936,348 shares of the Company’s
common stock. The five-year warrants are exercisable at $1.00 per
share, subject to adjustment.
On
November 14, 2016, the Company issued 187,500 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 187,500
shares of common stock in a private placement to certain accredited
investors for gross proceeds of $150,000 pursuant to a Series D
Preferred Stock and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated November 10,
2016. The warrant was valued at $189,938.
On
December 19, 2016, the Company issued 187,500 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 187,500
shares of common stock in a private placement to an accredited
investor for gross proceeds of $150,000 pursuant to a Series D
Preferred Stock and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated December 14,
2016. The warrant was valued at $131,250.
On
February 24, 2017, the Company issued 283,861 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 283,861
shares of common stock in a private placement to an accredited
investor for conversion of a $220,000 Promissory Note and accrued
interest of $7,089 pursuant to a Series D Preferred Stock and
Warrant Purchase Agreement dated February 28, 2017. The warrant was
valued at $198,703.
During
the year ended September 30, 2017, the Company revised five year
placement agent warrants to purchase 312,500 shares of common
stock. The price was reduced from $1.00 to $0.70 per share and the
exercise price is now subject to adjustment. The Company recorded
250,000 shares during the year ended September 30, 2016 the fair
value of these warrants is $218,751 as of June 30,
2017.
On May 1, 2017, the Company issued 357,143 shares of Series D
Convertible Preferred Stock and a warrant to purchase 357,143
shares of common stock in a private placement to an accredited
investor for gross proceeds of $250,000 pursuant to a Series D
Preferred Stock and Warrant Purchase Agreement dated May 1,
2017.
The warrant was valued at $5,357.
On August 14, 2017, the Company issued a common stock purchase
warrant to purchase 1,440,000 shares of common stock in a private
placement to Clayton Struve for gross proceeds of $300,000 pursuant
to a Securities Purchase Agreement dated August 14, 2017. The
initial exercise price of the Warrant is $0.25 per share, also
subject to certain adjustments. The warrants were valued at
$111,429.
Warrants to acquire 7,668 shares of common stock at $30.00 per
share expired.
The
conversion price of the Series A, C and D Shares and related
warrants is currently $0.250 per share, subject to certain
adjustments.
The following warrant issuances occurred during the year ended
September 30, 2016:
On August 4, 2016, the Company adjusted the exercise price of the
warrants and conversion price of the Series A Convertible Preferred
Stock detailed above to $0.70 per share.
On August 5, 2016, the Company closed a Series C Preferred Stock
and Warrant Purchase Agreement with Clayton A. Struve, an
accredited investor for the purchase of $1,250,000 of preferred
stock with a conversion price of $0.70 per share. The preferred
stock has a yield of8% and an ownership blocker of 4.99%. In
addition, Mr. Struve received a five year warrant to acquire
1,785,714 shares of common stock at $0.70 per share. Both the
Series C and warrants will be included in a registration statement
to be filed by the Company.
On August 10, 2016, the Company closed a Stock Purchase Agreement
with Dale Broadrick, an accredited investor and affiliate of the
Company for the purchase of $500,000 of the Company’s common
stock at $0.70 per share. In addition, the investor received a five
year warrant to acquire 714,286 shares of common stock at $0.70 per
share. These common shares and warrants are not subject to a
registration statement.
The Company issued a five year warrant to Garden State Securities,
Inc. to acquire 250,000 shares of common stock at $1.00 per share.
The warrants were valued at $120,750.
The Company issued five year warrants to placement agents to
acquire 20,439 shares of common stock at $0.70 per
share.
Thirteen investors exercised warrants at $2.50 per share and were
issued 207,670 shares of common stock, for a total of $519,162 in
proceeds to the Company.
Warrants to acquire 9,348 shares of common stock at $26.22 per
share expired.
The Company entered into Convertible Promissory Notes totaling
$710,000 with accredited investors during September 2015 to
February 2016 to fund short-term working capital. The investors
received $710,000 in warrants that are exercisable into common
stock at the price equal to the price of the common stock sold in
our next public financing. The number of warrants convertible into
shares of common stock is not known at this time as the number of
shares is determined by the price of the next up-lift offering by
an investment banker.
A summary of the warrants issued as of September 30, 2017 were as
follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Outstanding
at beginning of period
|
3,453,171
|
$
0.840
|
Issued
|
3,454,853
|
0.399
|
Exercised
|
-
|
-
|
Forfeited
|
-
|
-
|
Expired
|
(7,668
)
|
(30.000
)
|
Outstanding
at end of period
|
6,900,356
|
$
0.428
|
Exerciseable
at end of period
|
6,900,356
|
|
A summary of the status of the warrants outstanding as of September
30, 2017 is presented below:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5,222,616
|
3.77
|
$
0.250
|
5,222,616
|
$
0.250
|
734,725
|
3.74
|
0.700
|
734,725
|
0.700
|
936,348
|
4.17
|
1.000
|
936,348
|
1.000
|
6,667
|
1.25
|
30.000
|
6,667
|
30.000
|
6,900,356
|
3.72
|
$
0.428
|
6,900,356
|
$
0.428
|
The significant weighted average assumptions relating to the
valuation of the Company’s warrants for the year ended
September 30, 2017 were as follows:
Dividend yield
|
0%
|
Expected life
|
.25-3
|
Expected volatility
|
90%
|
Risk free interest rate
|
.01-.07%
|
At September 30, 2017, vested warrants totaling 6,900,356 shares
had an aggregate intrinsic value of $0.
Description of Stock Option Plan
On March 21, 2013, an amendment to the Stock Option Plan was
approved by the stockholders of the Company, increasing the number
of shares reserved for issuance under the Plan to 93,333
shares.
Determining Fair Value under ASC 505
The Company records compensation expense associated with stock
options and other equity-based compensation using the
Black-Scholes-Merton option valuation model for estimating fair
value of stock options granted under our plan. The Company
amortizes the fair value of stock options on a ratable basis over
the requisite service periods, which are generally the vesting
periods. The expected life of awards granted represents the period
of time that they are expected to be outstanding. The
Company estimates the volatility of our common stock based on the
historical volatility of its own common stock over the most recent
period corresponding with the estimated expected life of the award.
The Company bases the risk-free interest rate used in the Black
Scholes-Merton option valuation model on the implied yield
currently available on U.S. Treasury zero-coupon issues with an
equivalent remaining term equal to the expected life of the award.
The Company has not paid any cash dividends on our common stock and
does not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable
future. Consequently, the Company uses an expected dividend yield
of zero in the Black-Scholes-Merton option valuation model and
adjusts share-based compensation for changes to the estimate of
expected equity award forfeitures based on actual forfeiture
experience. The effect of adjusting the forfeiture rate is
recognized in the period the forfeiture estimate is
changed.
Stock Option Activity
The Company had the following stock option transactions during the
year ended December 31, 2017:
During the year ended September 30, 2017, employees forfeited stock
option grants for 35,504 shares of common stock at $19.51 per
share.
The Company had the following stock option transactions during the
year ended December 31, 2016:
During the year ended September 30, 2016, employees forfeited stock
option grants for 6,499 shares of common stock at $21.40 per
share.
There are currently 15,404 options to purchase common stock at an
average exercise price of $14.68 per share outstanding as of
September 30, 2017 under the 2011 Stock Incentive Plan. The Company
recorded $37,848 and $46,398 of compensation expense, net of
related tax effects, relative to stock options for the year ended
September 30, 2017 and 2016 in accordance with ASC 505. Net loss
per share (basic and diluted) associated with this expense was
approximately ($0.01) and ($0.03) per share, respectively. As of
September 30, 2017, there is approximately $20,215 of total
unrecognized costs related to employee granted stock options that
are not vested. These costs are expected to be recognized over a
period of approximately 1.78 years.
Stock option activity for the year ended September 30, 2017 and
2016 was as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
Outstanding
as of September 30, 2015
|
57,407
|
18.425
|
1,057,725
|
Granted
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Exercised
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Forfeitures
|
(6,499
)
|
(21,403
)
|
(139,098
)
|
Outstanding
as of September 30, 2016
|
50,908
|
18.045
|
918,627
|
Granted
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Exercised
|
-
|
-
|
-
|
Forfeitures
|
(35,504
)
|
(19.507
)
|
(692,568
)
|
Outstanding
as of September 30, 2017
|
15,404
|
$
14.675
|
$
226,059
|
The following table summarizes information about stock options
outstanding and exercisable at September 30, 2017:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
13.500
|
3,334
|
2.75
|
$
13.500
|
3,334
|
$
13.50
|
15.000
|
12,238
|
1.52
|
15.000
|
7,570
|
15.00
|
|
15,572
|
1.78
|
$
14.679
|
10,904
|
$
14.54
|
There is no aggregate intrinsic value of the exercisable options as
of September 30, 2017.
15.
|
OTHER SIGNIFICANT TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES
|
Related Party Transactions with Ronald P. Erickson
See Note 12 for Notes Payable to Ronald P. Erickson, our Chief
Executive Officer Chief and/or entities in which Mr. Erickson has a
beneficial interest.
Note Payable to Umpqua Bank
The Company has a $199,935 Business Loan Agreement with Umpqua
Bank. On December 19, 2017, the Umpqua Loan maturity was extended
to March 31, 2018 and provides for interest at 4.00% per
year.
Related to this Umpqua Loan, the Company entered into
a demand promissory note for $200,000 on January 10, 2014 with an
entity affiliated with Ronald P. Erickson, our Chief Executive
Officer. This demand promissory note will be effective in case of a
default by the Company under the Umpqua Loan.
Note Payables to Ronald P. Erickson or J3E2A2Z LP
The Company also has two other demand promissory notes payable to
entities affiliated with Mr. Erickson, totaling $600,000. Each of
these notes were issued between January and July 2014, provide for
interest of 3% per year and now mature on December 31, 2017. The
notes payable also provide for a second lien on our assets if not
repaid by December 31, 2017 or converted into convertible
debentures or equity on terms acceptable to the Mr. Erickson. The
Company recorded accrued interest of $58,167 as of September 30,
2017.
Other Amounts Due to Mr. Erickson
Mr. Erickson and/or entities with which he is affiliated also have
advanced $519,833 and have unreimbursed expenses and compensation
of approximately $450,679. The Company owes Mr. Erickson, or
entities with which he is affiliated, $1,570,511 as of September
30, 2017.
Issuance of Common Stock to Mr. Erickson
On July 12, 2016, Mr. Erickson and/or entities with which he is
affiliated exercised a warrant for 66,667 shares of the
Company’s common stock at $2.50 per share or
$166,668.
Entry into Employment Agreement with Ronald P. Erickson, Chief
Executive Officer
On
August 4, 2017, the Board of Directors approved an Employment
Agreement with Ronald P. Erickson pursuant to which we engaged Mr.
Erickson as the Company’s Chief Executive Officer through
June 30, 2018.
Stock Issuances to Named Executive Officers and
Directors
On September 7, 2017, the Company issued 600,000 shares of
restricted common stock to two Names Executive Officers employees
and two directors for services during 2015-2017. The shares were
issued in accordance with the 2011 Stock Incentive Plan and were
valued at $0.17 per share, the market price of our common stock.
The Company expensed $102,000 during the year ended September 30,
2017.
Stock Option Grant Cancellations
During the year ended September 30, 2017, two Names Executive
Officers forfeited stock option grants for 35,366 shares of common
stock at $19.53 per share.
16. COMMITMENTS, CONTINGENCIES AND LEGAL
PROCEEDINGS
Legal Proceedings
The
Company may from time to time become a party to various legal
proceedings arising in the ordinary course of our business. The
Company is currently not a party to any pending legal proceeding
that is not ordinary routine litigation incidental to our
business.
Entry into Employment Agreement with Ronald P. Erickson, Chief
Executive Officer
On
August 4, 2017, the Board of Directors approved an Employment
Agreement with Ronald P. Erickson pursuant to which the Company
engaged Mr. Erickson as the Company’s Chief Executive Officer
through June 30, 2018.
Mr.
Erickson’s annual compensation is $180,000. Mr. Erickson is
also entitled to receive an annual bonus and equity awards
compensation as approved by the Board. The bonus should be paid no
later than 30 days following earning of the bonus.
Mr.
Erickson will be entitled to participate in all group employment
benefits that are offered by the Company to the Company’s
senior executives and management employees from time to time,
subject to the terms and conditions of such benefit plans,
including any eligibility requirements.
If the Company terminates Mr. Erickson’s employment at any
time prior to the expiration of the Term without Cause, as defined
in the Employment Agreement, or if Mr. Erickson terminates his
employment at any time for “Good Reason” or due to a
“Disability”, Mr. Erickson will be entitled to receive
(i) his Base Salary amount for one year; and (ii) medical benefits
for eighteen months.
Properties and Operating Leases
The Company is obligated under the following non-cancelable
operating leases for its various facilities and certain
equipment.
Years
Ended September 30,
|
|
2018
|
$
75,726
|
2019
|
119,600
|
2020
|
73,450
|
2021
|
-
|
2022
|
-
|
Beyond
|
-
|
Total
|
$
268,776
|
Corporate Offices
On April 13, 2017, the Company leased its executive office located
at 500 Union Street, Suite 810, Seattle, Washington, USA, 98101.
The Company leases 943 square feet and the net monthly payment is
$2,672. The monthly payment increases approximately 3% each year
and the lease expires on May 31, 2022.
TransTech Facilities
TransTech is located at 12142 NE Sky Lane, Suite 130, Aurora, OR
97002. TransTech leases a total of approximately 6,340 square feet
of office and warehouse space for its administrative offices,
product inventory and shipping operations. Effective December 1,
2017, TransTech leases this office from December 1, 2017 at $4,465
per month. The monthly payment increases approximately 3% each year
and the lease expires on January 31, 2020. Until December 1, 2017,
TransTech leased this office on a month to month basis at $6,942
per month.
17. INCOME TAXES
The
Company has incurred losses since inception, which have generated
net operating loss carryforwards. The net operating loss
carryforwards arise from United States
sources.
Pretax
losses arising from United States operations were approximately
$1,222,000 for the year ended September 30, 2017.
Pretax
losses arising from United States operations were approximately
$2,634,000 for the year ended September 30, 2016.
The
Company has net operating loss carryforwards of approximately
$23,927,000, which expire in 2021-2035. Because it is not more
likely than not that sufficient tax earnings will be generated to
utilize the net operating loss carryforwards, a corresponding
valuation allowance of approximately $8,135,000 was established as
of September 30, 2017. Additionally, under the Tax Reform Act of
1986, the amounts of, and benefits from, net operating losses may
be limited in certain circumstances, including a change in
control.
Section 382
of the Internal Revenue Code generally imposes an annual limitation
on the amount of net operating loss carryforwards that may be used
to offset taxable income when a corporation has undergone
significant changes in its stock ownership. There can be no
assurance that the Company will be able to utilize any net
operating loss carryforwards in the future. The Company is subject
to possible tax examination for the years 2011 through
2017.
For the year ended September 30, 2016, the Company’s
effective tax rate differs from the federal statutory rate
principally due to net operating losses and warrants issued for
services.
The principal components of the Company’s deferred tax assets
at September 30, 2017 and 2016 are as follows:
|
|
|
U.S.
operations loss carry forward at statutory rate of 34%
|
$
(8,135,208
)
|
$
(7,719,634
)
|
Non-U.S.
operations loss carry forward at statutory rate of
20.5%
|
-
|
-
|
Total
|
(8,135,208
)
|
(7,719,634
)
|
Less
Valuation Allowance
|
8,135,208
|
7,719,634
|
Net
Deferred Tax Assets
|
-
|
-
|
Change
in Valuation allowance
|
$
(530,842
)
|
$
(129,654
)
|
A reconciliation of the United States Federal Statutory rate to the
Company’s effective tax rate for the years ended September
30, 2017 and 2016 are as follows:
|
|
|
Federal
Statutory Rate
|
-34.0
%
|
-34.0
%
|
Increase
in Income Taxes Resulting from:
|
|
|
Change
in Valuation allowance
|
34.0
%
|
34.0
%
|
Effective
Tax Rate
|
0.0
%
|
0.0
%
|
The Company evaluated subsequent events, for the purpose of
adjustment or disclosure, up through the date the financial
statements were issued.
Business Loan Agreement
The Company has a $199,935 Business Loan Agreement with Umpqua
Bank. On December 19, 2017, the Umpqua Loan maturity was extended
to March 31, 2018 and provides for interest at 4.00% per
year.
Related to this Umpqua Loan, the Company entered into
a demand promissory note for $200,000 on January 10, 2014 with an
entity affiliated with Ronald P. Erickson, our Chief Executive
Officer. This demand promissory note will be effective in case of a
default by the Company under the Umpqua Loan.
TransTech Facilities
TransTech is located at 12142 NE Sky Lane, Suite 130, Aurora, OR
97002. TransTech leases a total of approximately 6,340 square feet
of office and warehouse space for its administrative offices,
product inventory and shipping operations. Effective December 1,
2017, TransTech leases this office from December 1, 2017 at $4,465
per month. The monthly payment increases approximately 3% each year
and the lease expires on January 31, 2020. Until December 1, 2017,
TransTech leased this office on a month to month basis at $6,942
per month.
Senior Convertible Exchangeable Debenture
On December 15, 2017, the Company received $250,000 and issued a
senior convertible exchangeable debenture with a principal amount
of $300,000 (the “Debenture”) and a common stock
purchase warrant to purchase 1,200,000 shares of common stock (the
“Warrant”) in a private placement dated December 14,
2017 to an accredited investor pursuant to a Securities Purchase
Agreement dated August 14, 2017 (the “Purchase
Agreement”).
Previously, On August 14, 2017, the Company issued a senior
convertible exchangeable debenture with a principal amount of
$360,000 (the “Debenture”) and a common stock purchase
warrant to purchase 1,440,000 shares of common stock (the
“Warrant”) in a private placement to an accredited
investor for gross proceeds of $300,000 pursuant to a Securities
Purchase Agreement dated August 14, 2017. Under the terms of the
Purchase Agreement, the investor may purchase up to an aggregate of
$1,000,000 principal amount of Debentures (before a 20% original
issue discount) (and Warrants to purchase up to an aggregate of
250,000 shares of common stock).
The Company entered into a General Security Agreement with the
investor, pursuant to which the Company has agreed to grant a
security interest to the investor in substantially all the
Company’s assets, effective upon the filing of a UCC-3
termination statement to terminate the security interest held by
Capital Source Business Finance Group in the assets of the Company.
In addition, an entity affiliated with Ronald P. Erickson, the
Company’s Chief Executive Officer, entered into a
Subordination Agreement with the investor pursuant to which all
debt owed by the Company to such entity is subordinated to amounts
owed by the Company to the investor under the Debenture (including
amounts that become owing under any Debentures issued to the
investor in the future).
The initial conversion price of the Debenture is $0.25 per share,
subject to certain adjustments. The initial exercise price of the
Warrant is $0.25 per share, also subject to certain
adjustments.
As part of the Purchase Agreement, the Company granted the investor
“piggyback” registration rights to register the shares
of common stock issuable upon the conversion of the Debenture and
the exercise of the Warrant with the Securities and Exchange
Commission for resale or other disposition.
The Debenture and the Warrant were issued in a transaction that was
not registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
“Act”) in reliance upon applicable exemptions from
registration under Section 4(a)(2) of the Act and Rule 506 of SEC
Regulation D under the Act.
In connection with the private placement, the placement agent for
the Debenture and the Warrant received a cash fee of $25,000 and
the Company expects to issue warrants to purchase shares of the
Company’s common stock to the placement agent based on 10% of
proceeds.
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, Visualant, Inc. (the "Registrant")
has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
|
VISUALANT, INC.
|
|
|
|
Date: December 29, 2017
|
By:
|
/s/ Ronald P. Erickson
|
|
|
Ronald P. Erickson
|
|
|
Chief Executive Officer, President and Director
(Principal Executive Officer)
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/ Ronald P. Erickson
|
|
|
Ronald P. Erickson
|
|
|
Interim Chief Financial Officer and Secretary
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)
|
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on
behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates
indicated:
SIGNATURES
|
TITLE
|
DATE
|
|
|
|
/s/ Ronald P. Erickson
|
Chief Executive Officer, President and Director
|
December 29, 2017
|
Ronald P. Erickson
|
(Principal Executive Officer)
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Ronald P. Erickson
|
Interim Chief Financial Officer and Secretary
|
December 29, 2017
|
Ronald P. Erickson
|
(Principal Financial/Accounting Officer)
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Jon Pepper
|
Independent Director
|
December 29, 2017
|
Jon Pepper
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Ichiro Takesako
|
Management Director
|
December 29, 2017
|
Ichiro Takesako
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exhibit
10.33
OFFICE LEASE
LOGAN BUILDING LLC
“LANDLORD”
WITH
VISUALANT INCORPORATED
“TENANT”
BUILDING: LOGAN BUILDING
SUITES: 810 and 815
DATED: December 13, 2016
|
Table Of Contents
|
Page
|
SECTION 1: BASIC PROVISIONS
|
1
|
|
|
SECTION 2: PREMISES AND PREPARATION OF PREMISES
|
2
|
|
|
SECTION 3: TERM AND COMMENCEMENT
|
2
|
|
|
SECTION 4: BASE RENT AND ADDITIONAL RENT
|
3
|
|
|
SECTION 5: QUIET ENJOYMENT
|
5
|
|
|
SECTION 6: UTILITIES AND SERVICES
|
5
|
|
|
SECTION 7: DEPOSITS
|
6
|
|
|
SECTION 8: USE, COMPLIANCE WITH LAWS AND RULES
|
7
|
|
|
SECTION 9: MAINTENANCE AND REPAIRS
|
7
|
|
|
SECTION 10: ALTERATIONS AND LIENS
|
8
|
|
|
SECTION 11: INSURANCE AND WAIVER OF SUBROGATION
|
8
|
|
|
SECTION 12: CASUALTY DAMAGE
|
9
|
|
|
SECTION 13: CONDEMNATION
|
10
|
|
|
SECTION 14: ASSIGNMENT AND SUBLETTING
|
10
|
|
|
SECTION 15: PERSONAL PROPERTY, RENT AND OTHER TAXES
|
11
|
|
|
SECTION 16: TENANT’S DEFAULT; LANDLORD’S
REMEDIES
|
12
|
|
|
SECTION 17: SUBORDINATION, ATTORNMENT AND LENDER
PROTECTION
|
13
|
|
|
SECTION 18: ESTOPPEL CERTIFICATES
|
14
|
|
|
SECTION 19: RIGHTS RESERVED BY LANDLORD
|
14
|
|
|
SECTION 20: LANDLORD’S DEFAULT; REMEDIES
|
15
|
|
|
SECTION 21: RELEASE AND INDEMNITY
|
16
|
|
|
SECTION 22: RETURN OF POSSESSION
|
16
|
|
|
SECTION 23: HOLDING OVER
|
17
|
|
|
SECTION 24: NOTICES
|
17
|
|
|
SECTION 25: REAL ESTATE BROKERS
|
17
|
|
|
SECTION 26: NO WAIVER
|
17
|
|
|
SECTION 27: SAFETY AND SECURITY DEVICES, SERVICES AND
PROGRAMS
|
18
|
|
|
SECTION 28: TELECOMMUNICATION LINES AND EQUIPMENT
|
18
|
|
|
SECTION 29: HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES; DISRUPTIVE
ACTIVITIES
|
19
|
|
|
SECTION 30: DISABILITIES ACTS
|
19
|
|
|
SECTION 31: DEFINITIONS
|
20
|
|
|
SECTION 32: OFFER
|
21
|
|
|
SECTION 33: MISCELLANEOUS
|
21
|
|
|
SECTION 34: ENTIRE AGREEMENT
|
23
|
|
|
EXHIBIT A: LEGAL DESCRIPTION OF PROPERTY
|
|
|
|
EXHIBIT B: FLOOR PLATE SHOWING PREMISES
|
|
|
|
EXHIBIT C: WORK LETTER
|
|
|
|
RIDER ONE: RULES
|
|
|
|
RIDER TWO: GREEN ADDENDUM
|
|
OFFICE LEASE
THIS
OFFICE LEASE (“Lease”) is made and entered into as of
this 13
th
day of December, 2016, by and between LOGAN BUILDING LLC, a
Delaware limited liability company (“Landlord”), and
VISUALANT INCORPORATED, a Nevada corporation
(“Tenant”). In consideration of this Lease, Landlord
and Tenant covenant and agree as follows:
SECTION
1: BASIC PROVISIONS
This
Section contains the basic lease provisions between Landlord and
Tenant.
A. Building:
500 Union Street,
Seattle, Washington 98101 (“Building”), located on a
portion of the real property legally described in Exhibit A
attached hereto (“Property”).
B. Premises:
Suites 810 and 815
in the Building as identified in Exhibit B.
C. Commencement Date:
January 1, 2017,
subject to Section 3.
D. Expiration Date:
January 31, 2022,
subject to Section 3.
E. Rentable Area:
The rentable area
of the Premises shall be deemed to contain 943 rentable square feet
(“RSF”), subject to Section 31(O).
F. Tenant’s
Share:
00.80%, subject to
Section 4 and Section 31(O).
G. Base Rent:
From the
Commencement Date through the Expiration Date, as further described
in Section 4, as follows:
Months 1 –
12*:
$34.00/RSF/year
($2,671.83 per month)
Months 13 –
24:
$35.00/RSF/year
($2,750.42 per month)
Months 25 –
36:
$36.00/RSF/year
($2,829.00 per month)
Months 37 –
48:
$37.00/RSF/year
($2,907.58 per month)
Months 49 –
60:
$38.00/RSF/year
($2,986.17 per month)
Month
61:
$39.00/RSF/year
($3,064.75 per month)
*Tenant
shall be entitled to an abatement of Base Rent in the amount of
$2,671.83, which amount shall be credited against Base Rent for the
first calendar month of the Term.
H. Additional Rent:
Tenant shall pay
Tenant’s Share of Taxes and Tenant’s Share of Expenses
in excess of such amounts for the period September 1, 2016 –
August 31, 2017 (“Base Year”) as further described in
Section 4.
I. Permitted Use:
Executive and
administrative office use, subject to Section 8.
J. Deposits:
$5,070.00, which
Landlord already holds and will not be increased, and shall be
subject to Section 7.
K. Parking:
Tenants at the
Logan Building may arrange for parking spaces at the neighboring US
Bank Center garage (“Garage”), subject to availability
of parking spaces within the Garage and payment of the
Garage’s then applicable monthly rate.
L. Broker (if any):
Scott Driver of
Scott Driver & Co., P.S., as Tenant's broker
Oscar
Oliveira, Damon McCartney and David Marks of Broderick Group, Inc.,
as Landlord's broker
N. Riders/Exhibits:
Exhibit A
(Property)
Exhibit
B (Premises)
Exhibit
C (Work Letter)
Rider
One (Rules)
Rider
Two (Green Addendum)
O. Landlord’s Notice Address (subject to
Section 24):
Logan
Building LLC
c/o
Unico Properties LLC
Attn:
Senior Vice President / CFO
1215
Fourth Avenue, Suite 600
Seattle, WA
98161
With a
copy to:
Logan
Building LLC
c/o
Unico Properties LLC
Attn:
Logan Building Property Manager
1215
Fourth Avenue, Suite 600
Seattle, WA
98161
P. Tenant’s Notice Address (subject to
Section 24):
Visualant
Incorporated
Attn:
Office Manager
The
Logan Building
500
Union Street, Suite 810
Seattle, WA
98101
Q. Rent Payments:
Rent shall be paid
to the following, or to such other parties and addresses as to
which Landlord shall provide advance notice:
Logan
Building LLC
c/o
Unico Properties LLC
Attn:
Accounts Receivable
1215
Fourth Avenue, Suite 600
Seattle, WA
98161
The
foregoing provisions shall be interpreted and applied in accordance
with the other provisions of this Lease. The terms of this Section,
and the terms defined in Section 31 and other Sections, shall
have the meanings specified therefor when used as capitalized terms
in other provisions of this Lease or related documentation (except
as expressly provided to the contrary therein).
SECTION
2: PREMISES AND PREPARATION OF PREMISES
A.
Premises.
Landlord hereby leases to Tenant and Tenant hereby leases from
Landlord the Premises subject to the provisions herein contained.
Tenant agrees to accept the Premises “as is” without
any agreements, representations, understandings or obligations on
the part of Landlord to construct any improvements within the
Premises other than the Tenant Improvements, if any, described in
Exhibit C, or to perform any repairs or maintenance to the Premises
or Building except as expressly provided under this Lease. Tenant
further acknowledges that, except as otherwise expressly stated in
this Lease, Landlord has not made any representation or warranty
(express or implied) with respect to the habitability, condition or
suitability of the Premises, Building or Property for
Tenant’s purposes or any particular purpose.
B.
Preparation
of Premises.
The obligations of Landlord and Tenant to
perform work and supply materials and labor to prepare the Premises
for Tenant’s occupancy shall be as set forth in
Exhibit C attached hereto and incorporated herein.
Landlord’s obligation, if any, for completion of the Premises
(“Landlord’s Work”) shall be defined and limited
by said Exhibit C, and Landlord shall not be required to furnish or
install any item not indicated thereon. Any additional alterations
or improvements to the Premises beyond those set forth on Exhibit C
shall be at Tenant’s sole cost and expense and subject to all
provisions of Section 10, including without limitation the prior
approval of Landlord. Taking possession of the Premises by Tenant
shall be conclusive evidence the Premises were, on that date, in
good, clean and tenantable condition and delivered in accordance
with this Lease, unless set forth otherwise in a mutually agreed
upon written “punch list.”
C.
Governing
Property Documents.
The Property is subject to and governed
by that First Amended and Restated Pacific First Center/Logan
Building Agreement recorded under King County Recording No.
8704210116, as amended by any other amendments thereto hereafter
adopted (collectively, “Governing Property Documents”).
Tenant’s use of the Premises, Property and Common Areas, and
rights and interest in this Lease, all are subject to the Governing
Property Documents, and Tenant shall be responsible for complying
with those requirements in the Governing Property Documents
applicable to Tenant’s use of the Premises. Additions and
modifications to Governing Property Documents shall be binding on
Tenant upon delivery of a copy of them to Tenant.
SECTION
3: TERM AND COMMENCEMENT
A.
Term
and Confirmation.
The term (“Term”) of this
Lease shall commence on the Commencement Date and end on the
Expiration Date as specified in Section 1 above, unless sooner
terminated as provided herein, subject to adjustment as provided
below and the other provisions hereof. If the Commencement Date is
advanced or postponed as provided below, the Expiration Date set
forth in Section 1 shall not be changed, unless Landlord so elects
by notice to Tenant. Tenant shall execute a confirmation of the
Commencement Date and other matters in such form as Landlord may
reasonably request within ten (10) days after requested (but
nothing herein shall require Landlord to so request); any failure
to respond within such time shall be deemed an acceptance of the
matters as set forth in Landlord’s confirmation. If Tenant
disagrees with Landlord’s adjustment of the Commencement
Date, Tenant shall pay Rent and perform all other obligations
commencing on the date determined by Landlord, subject to refund or
credit when the matter is resolved.
B.
Adjustments
to Commencement Date.
The parties acknowledge that the
Commencement Date specified in Section 1 is an estimated date. This
Lease shall commence on the Commencement Date specified in Section
1 if Landlord’s Work is Substantially Complete (as that term
is defined in Exhibit C) by such date but otherwise the
Commencement Date shall be adjusted to be the first to occur of the
following events: (i) the date Landlord provides Tenant notice that
Landlord’s Work is Substantially Complete; (ii) the date on
which Tenant takes possession or commences beneficial occupancy of
the Premises; or (iii) if Substantial Completion of
Landlord’s Work is delayed in whole or in part due to Tenant
Delay (as that term is defined in Exhibit C), then the date
determined by Landlord as the date upon which Landlord’s Work
would have been Substantially Complete, but for Tenant’s acts
or omissions. In no event shall Landlord have any liability for
loss or damage to Tenant resulting in any delay in the Commencement
Date, nor shall Tenant have any right to terminate this Lease, and
Tenant’s sole recourse shall be the postponement of Rent and
other obligations until the Commencement Date is established as set
forth above.
C.
Early
Access.
If Landlord’s Work is Substantially Complete
prior to the Commencement Date specified in Section 1, upon
reasonable notice from Tenant to Landlord, Tenant shall be entitled
to enter the Premises for fixturing and move in purposes provided
(i) Tenant shall not interfere with Landlord’s completion of
Landlord’s Work and shall coordinate its activities and
comply with Landlord’s directives, (ii) all provisions
of this Lease other than those relating to payment of Rent shall
apply to any such pre-commencement entry (including without
limitation all insurance, indemnity and freedom from lien
provisions), and (iii) Tenant shall not beneficially occupy the
Premises (or any part thereof) or commence business operations from
the Premises (or any part thereof) during such period.
SECTION
4: BASE RENT AND ADDITIONAL RENT
A.
Base
Rent.
Subject to adjustment for expenses, taxes and required
capital expenditures as set forth in this Section 4, Tenant shall
pay Landlord the monthly Base Rent set forth in Section 1 in
advance on or before the first day of each calendar month during
the Term. The Base Rent for any fractional month occurring prior to
the Rent Abatement Period and for the first full month of the Lease
Term which occurs after the expiration of the Rent Abatement Period
shall be paid by Tenant at the time of Tenant’s execution of
this Lease.
B.
Taxes
and Expenses.
Tenant shall pay Landlord
“Tenant’s Share of Taxes” and
“Tenant’s Share of Expenses” in the manner
described below. All such charges shall be deemed to constitute
“Additional Rent” which shall be deemed to accrue
uniformly during the calendar year in which the payment is
due.
(i)
During each
calendar year after the Base Year identified in Section 1(H) above,
Tenant agrees to pay as “Additional Rent” for the
Premises, “Tenant’s Share” (defined below) of all
increases in Taxes and Expenses incurred by Landlord in the
operation of the Building and Property, over the amount of the
Property Taxes and Expenses incurred by Landlord in the operation
of the Building and Property during the Base Year. For purposes of
this Lease, “Tenant’s Share” shall mean the ratio
between the rentable area of the Premises and the rentable area of
the Building. Tenant’s Share, calculated based on the initial
square foot area of the Premises, is set forth in Section 1(F)
above, and is subject to adjustment as set forth in Section
31(O).
(ii)
Prior
to or promptly after the commencement of each calendar year
following the Base Year, Landlord shall give Tenant a written
estimate of the anticipated increases in Taxes and Expenses over
the Base Year and Tenant’s Share of such increases. Tenant
shall pay such estimated amount to Landlord in equal monthly
installments, in advance, without deduction or offset, on or before
the first day of each calendar month, with the monthly installment
of Base Rent payable in accordance with Section 4(A) above. After
the end of each calendar year, Landlord shall furnish to Tenant a
statement showing in reasonable detail the actual increases over
the Base Year in the Taxes and Expenses incurred by Landlord during
the applicable calendar year and Tenant’s Share thereof. If
the statement shows Tenant’s Share of the actual increases
exceeds the amount of Tenant’s estimated payments, within
thirty (30) days after receiving the statement, Tenant shall pay
the amount of the deficiency to Landlord. If the statement shows
Tenant has overpaid, the amount of the excess shall be credited
against installments next coming due under this Section 4;
provided, however upon the expiration or earlier termination of the
Lease Term, if Tenant is not then in default under this Lease,
Landlord shall refund the excess to Tenant.
(iii)
If
at any time during any calendar year of the Lease Term (other than
the Base Year) the Taxes applicable to the Building and Property
change and/or any information used by Landlord to calculate the
estimated Expenses changes, Tenant’s estimated share of such
Taxes and/or Expenses, as applicable, may be adjusted accordingly
effective as of the month in which such changes become effective,
by written notice from Landlord to Tenant of the amount or
estimated amount of the change, the month in which effective, and
Tenant’s Share thereof. Tenant shall pay such increase to
Landlord as a part of Tenant’s monthly payments of estimated
Taxes or Expenses as provided above, commencing with the month
following the month in which Tenant is notified of the
adjustment.
(iv)
For
purposes of this Lease, the term “Expenses” means all
costs of and expenses paid or incurred by Landlord for maintaining,
operating, repairing, replacing and administering the Building and
Property, including all Common Areas and facilities and Systems and
Equipment, and shall include the following costs by way of
illustration but not limitation: water and sewer charges; insurance
premiums; license, permit, and inspection fees; heat; light; power;
steam; janitorial and security services; labor; salaries; air
conditioning; landscaping; maintenance and repair of driveways and
surface areas; supplies; materials; equipment; tools; the cost of
capital replacements (as opposed to capital improvements); the cost
of any capital improvements or modifications made to the Building
by Landlord that are intended to reduce Expenses, are required
under any Laws not applicable to the Building or Property or not in
effect at the time the Building was constructed, or are made for
the general benefit and convenience of all tenants of the Building;
all property management costs, including office rent for any
property management office and professional property management
fees; legal and accounting expenses; and all other expenses or
charges which, in accordance with industry standard accounting and
management practices, would be considered an expense of
maintaining, operating, repairing, replacing or administering the
Building or Property. Capital costs included in Expenses shall be
amortized over such reasonable period as Landlord shall determine
with a return on capital at the current market rate per annum on
the unamortized balance or at such higher rate as may have been
paid by Landlord on funds borrowed for the purpose of constructing
such capital replacements or improvements.
(v)
For purposes of
this Lease, the term “Taxes” means all real estate
taxes or personal property taxes and other taxes, surcharges and
assessments, unforeseen as well as foreseen, which are levied with
respect to the Building and Property and any improvements, fixtures
and equipment and other property of Landlord, real or personal,
located in the Building or on the Property and used in connection
with the operation of the Building or Property and any tax,
surcharge or assessment which shall be levied in addition to or in
lieu of real estate or personal property taxes, other than taxes
covered in Section 15. The term “Taxes” shall also
include any rental, excise, sales, transaction, privilege, or other
tax or levy, however denominated, imposed upon or measured by the
rental reserved hereunder or on Landlord’s business of
leasing the Premises, excepting only net income, inheritance, gift
and franchise taxes.
(vi)
Notwithstanding
anything to the contrary contained above, as to each specific
category of expense which one or more tenants of the Building, at
Landlord’s sole discretion, either pays directly to third
parties or specifically reimburses to Landlord (e.g., separately
metered utilities, separately contracted janitorial service,
property taxes directly reimbursed to Landlord, etc.) such
tenant(s) payments with respect thereto shall not be included in
Expenses for purposes of this Section 4, but Tenant’s Share
of each of such category of expense shall be adjusted by excluding
from the denominator thereof the rentable area of all such tenants
paying such category of expense directly to third parties or
reimbursing the same directly to Landlord. Tenant shall not enter
into separate contracts to provide any specific utility or service
normally provided by the Building, without Landlord’s prior
written consent in Landlord’s sole discretion. Moreover, if
Tenant pays or directly reimburses Landlord for any such category
of expense (which shall only be Landlord’s prior consent),
such category of expense shall be excluded from the determination
of Expenses for Tenant to the extent such expense was incurred with
respect to space in the Building actually leased to or occupied by
other Tenants.
(vii)
Notwithstanding
anything to the contrary contained above, Landlord shall have the
right, from time to time, to equitably allocate some or all of the
Expenses among different portions or occupants of the Building
(“Cost Pools”), in good faith and in its reasonable
discretion. Such Cost Pools may include, but shall not be limited
to, the office space tenants of the Building, and the retail space
tenants of the Building. The Expenses within each such Cost Pool
shall be allocated and charged to the tenants within such Cost Pool
reasonably, in good faith and in an equitable manner.
(viii)
If
the average occupancy of the Building is less than ninety-five
percent (95%) during any calendar year, Landlord will, in
accordance with industry standard accounting and management
practices, determine the amount of variable Taxes and Expenses
(i.e. those items which vary according to occupancy levels) that
would have been paid had the Property been ninety-five percent
(95%) occupied, and the amount so determined shall be deemed to
have been the amount of Taxes and Expenses for such
year.
C.
Prorations.
If the Term commences on a day other than the first day of a
calendar month or ends on a day other than the last day of a
calendar month, the Base Rent and any other amounts payable on a
monthly basis shall be prorated on a per diem basis for such
partial calendar months. If the Base Rent is scheduled to increase
under Section 1 other than on the first day of a calendar month,
the amount for such month shall be prorated on a per diem basis to
reflect the number of days of such month at the then current and
increased rates, respectively. If the Term commences other than on
January 1, or ends other than on December 31, Tenant’s
obligations to pay amounts under this Section 4 towards Taxes and
Expenses for such first or final calendar years shall be prorated
on a per diem basis to reflect the portion of such years included
in the Term.
D.
Payments
After Lease Term Ends.
Tenant’s obligations to pay its
share of Taxes and Expenses (or any other amounts) as provided in
this Lease accruing during, or relating to, the period prior to
expiration or earlier termination of this Lease, shall survive such
expiration or termination. Landlord may reasonably estimate all or
any of such obligations within a reasonable time before, or anytime
after, such expiration or termination. Tenant shall pay the full
amount of such estimate, and any additional amount due after the
actual amounts are determined, in each case within ten (10) days
after Landlord sends a statement therefor. If the actual amount is
less than the amount Tenant pays as an estimate, Landlord shall
refund the difference within thirty (30) days after such
determination is made.
E.
Landlord’s
Accounting Practices and Records.
Unless Tenant takes
exception by notice to Landlord within thirty (30) days after
Landlord provides any statement to Tenant for any item of
Additional Rent, such statement shall be considered final and
binding on Tenant (except as to additional Expenses or Taxes not
then known or omitted by error). If Tenant takes exception by
notice within such time, Landlord may seek confirmation from
Landlord’s independent certified public accountant as to the
proper amount of Taxes and Expenses determined in accordance with
sound accounting practices. In such case: (i) such confirmation
shall be considered final and binding on both parties (except as to
additional expenses or taxes not then known or omitted by error),
and (ii) Tenant shall pay Landlord for the cost of such
confirmation, unless it shows that Taxes and Expenses were
overstated by at least five percent (5%). Pending resolution of any
such exceptions, Tenant shall pay all amounts shown on such
Landlord’s statement, subject to credit, refund or additional
payment after any such exceptions are resolved.
F.
General
Payment Matters.
Base Rent, Additional Rent which includes
without limitation Tenant’s Share of Taxes, Tenant’s
Share of Expenses and any other amounts which Tenant is or becomes
obligated to pay Landlord under this Lease or other agreement
entered in connection herewith, are sometimes herein referred to
collectively as “Rent,” and all remedies applicable to
the nonpayment of Rent shall be applicable thereto. Rent shall be
paid in good funds and legal tender of the United States of America
without prior demand, deduction, recoupment, set-off or
counterclaim, and without relief from any valuation or appraisement
Laws. Rent obligations hereunder are independent covenants. In
addition to all other Landlord remedies (i) any Rent not paid by
Tenant when due shall accrue interest from the due date at the
Default Rate until payment is received by Landlord and (ii) in
addition to such interest, Tenant shall pay Landlord a service
charge of two hundred fifty dollars ($250.00) or five percent (5%)
of the delinquent amount, whichever is greater, if any portion of
Rent is not received within five (5) business days after the due
date. No delay by Landlord in providing any Rent statement to
Tenant shall be deemed a default by Landlord or a waiver of
Landlord’s right to require payment of Tenant’s
obligations hereunder including those for actual or estimated
taxes, expenses or capital expenditures. In no event shall a
decrease in Taxes or Expenses, below their respective Base Year
levels, ever decrease the monthly Base Rent or give rise to a
credit in favor of Tenant. Landlord may apply payments received
from Tenant to any obligations of Tenant then accrued, without
regard to such obligations as may be designated by
Tenant.
SECTION
5: QUIET ENJOYMENT
Landlord agrees
that if Tenant timely pays the Rent and performs the terms and
provisions hereunder, Tenant shall hold the Premises during the
Term, free of lawful claims by any party acting by or through
Landlord, subject to all other terms and provisions of this
Lease.
SECTION
6: UTILITIES AND SERVICES
A.
Standard
Landlord Utilities and Services.
Provided Tenant is not in
default of this Lease, Landlord shall provide Tenant the following
utilities and services:
(i)
Elevator service
during Normal Business Hours and the service of at least one
elevator during all other hours.
(ii)
Heating
and cooling to maintain a temperature condition which in
Landlord’s judgment provides for comfortable occupancy of the
Premises under normal business operations during Normal Business
Hours, but not Saturdays, Sundays or those legal holidays generally
observed in the State of Washington, provided Tenant complies with
Landlord’s instructions regarding use of window coverings and
thermostats and Tenant does not utilize heat generating machines or
equipment which affect the temperature otherwise maintained by the
air cooling system. Upon request Landlord shall make available at
Tenant’s expense after-hours heat or air cooling. The minimum
use of after-hours heat or air cooling and the cost thereof shall
be determined by Landlord and confirmed in writing to Tenant, as
the same may change from time to time.
(iii)
Water
for drinking, lavatory, and toilet purposes.
(iv)
Electricity
for building-standard overhead office lighting fixtures, and
equipment and accessories customary for offices (up to 280 hours
per month), where: (a) the connected electrical load of all of the
same does not exceed an average of 4 watts per usable square foot
of the Premises (or such lesser amount as may be available, based
on the safe and lawful capacity of the electrical circuit(s) and
facilities serving the Premises), (b) the electricity is at nominal
120 volts, single phase (or 110 volts, depending on available
service in the Building), and (c) the systems and equipment are
suitable, the safe and lawful capacity thereof is not exceeded, and
sufficient capacity remains at all times for other existing and
future tenants, as determined in Landlord’s reasonable
discretion.
(v)
Janitorial service.
Janitorial service as customary for comparable buildings within the
market which includes vacuum cleaning of carpets and cleaning of
Building standard vinyl composition tile, but no other services
with respect to carpets or nonstandard floor
coverings.
(vi)
Maintain
the windows, doors, floors and walls (exclusive of coverings),
ceilings, plumbing and plumbing fixtures, and electrical
distribution system and lighting fixtures in good condition and
repair, except for damage caused by Tenant, its employees, agents,
invitees or visitors, except that such service will not be provided
as to any of the foregoing items that are not standard for the
Building.
(vii)
Replacement
of burned out fluorescent lamps in light fixtures which are
standard for the Building. Burned out lamps or other light sources
in fixtures which are not standard for the Building will be
replaced by Landlord at Tenant’s expense.
B.
Interruptions.
Landlord shall use reasonable diligence to remedy an interruption
in the furnishing of such services and utilities. If, however, any
governmental authority imposes regulations, controls or other
restrictions upon Landlord or the Building which would require a
change in the services provided by Landlord under this Lease,
Landlord may comply with such regulations, controls or other
restrictions, including without limitation, curtailment, rationing
or restrictions on the use of electricity or any other form of
energy serving the Premises. Tenant will cooperate and do such
things as are reasonably necessary to enable Landlord to comply
with such regulations, controls or other restrictions.
C.
Non-Standard
Usage.
Whenever heat generating machines or equipment or
lighting other than building standard lights are used in the
Premises by Tenant which affect the temperature otherwise
maintained by the air cooling system, Landlord shall have the right
to install supplementary air cooling units in the Premises, and the
cost thereof, including the cost of installation and the cost of
operation and maintenance thereof, shall be paid by Tenant to
Landlord upon billing by Landlord. Landlord may impose a reasonable
charge for utilities and services, including without limitation,
air cooling, electric current and water, required to be provided
the Premises by reason of (a) any substantial recurrent use of the
Premises at any time other than during Normal Business Hours (b)
any use beyond what Landlord agrees to furnish as described above,
(c) electricity used by equipment designated by Landlord as high
power usage equipment or (d) the installation, maintenance, repair,
replacement or operation of supplementary air cooling equipment,
additional electrical systems or other equipment required by reason
of special electrical, heating, cooling or ventilating requirements
of equipment used by Tenant at the Premises. High power usage
equipment includes without limitation, data processing machines,
punch card machines, computers and machines which operate on
220-volt circuits. Tenant shall not install or operate high power
usage equipment on the Premises without Landlord’s prior
written consent, which may be refused unless (i) Tenant confirms in
writing its obligation to pay the additional charges necessitated
by such equipment and such equipment does not adversely affect
operation of the Building, and (ii) the Building electrical
capacity to the floor(s) containing the Premises will not be
exceeded. At Landlord’s option, separate meters for such
utilities and services may be installed for the Premises and Tenant
upon demand therefor, shall immediately pay Landlord for the
installation, maintenance, repair and replacement of such
meters.
D.
Limitation.
Landlord does not warrant that any of the services and utilities
referred to in this Section 6 will be free from interruption.
Interruption of services and utilities shall not be deemed an
eviction or disturbance of Tenant’s use and possession of the
Premises or any part thereof or render Landlord liable to Tenant
for damages or loss of any kind, or relieve Tenant from performance
of Tenant’s obligations under this Lease.
E.
Utility
Providers.
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this
Lease, Landlord shall have the sole, exclusive and absolute right
to determine, select and contract with utility company or companies
that will provide electricity and other basic utility service to
the Building, Property and Premises. If permitted by Law, during
the Term of this Lease, Landlord shall have the right at any time,
and from time to time, to either contract for services from a
different company or companies providing electricity or other basic
utility service (each such company hereinafter an “Alternate
Service Provider”) or continue to contract for service from
the service provider(s) that is providing such utility service to
the Building, Property or Premises at the Commencement Date (each
the “Existing Service Provider”). Tenant shall
cooperate with Landlord, the Existing Service Provider and any
Alternate Service Provider at all times and, as reasonably
necessary, shall allow Landlord, the Existing Service Provider and
any Alternate Service Provider access to the Building’s
utility lines, plumbing, feeders, risers, wiring, and any other
machinery or utility access ways within the Premises.
SECTION
7: DEPOSITS
A.
Security
Deposit.
Upon execution of this Lease, Tenant shall deposit
a security deposit in the amount set forth in Section 1 with
Landlord. If Tenant is in default, Landlord can use the security
deposit or any portion of it to cure the default or to compensate
Landlord for any damages sustained by Landlord resulting from
Tenant’s default. Upon demand, Tenant shall immediately pay
to Landlord a sum equal to the portion of the security deposit
expended or applied by Landlord to restore the security deposit to
its full amount. In no event will Tenant have the right to apply
any part of the security deposit to any Rent or other sums due
under this Lease. If Tenant is not in default at the expiration or
termination of this Lease, Landlord shall return the security
deposit to Tenant. Landlord’s obligations with respect to the
deposit are those of a debtor and not of a trustee, and Landlord
can commingle the security deposit with Landlord’s general
funds. Landlord shall not be required to pay Tenant interest on the
deposit. Landlord shall be entitled to immediately endorse and cash
Tenant’s prepaid deposit; however, such endorsement and
cashing shall not constitute Landlord’s acceptance of this
Lease. In the event Landlord does not accept this Lease, Landlord
shall return said prepaid deposit. In addition, Tenant hereby
grants to Landlord a security interest in all of Tenant’s
tangible personal property and fixtures located at the Premises,
and in all of Tenant’s intangible property used in regard to,
or arising from, business conducted at or from the Premises,
including but not limited to all equipment, inventory, accounts,
furniture, trade fixtures, instruments, general intangibles and all
other rights to payment, and the proceeds and products therefrom,
and all after acquired property. This Security Agreement and this
grant of a security interest is given to secure Tenant’s
performance and payment of all Rent and all other obligations of
Tenant to Landlord under this Lease. Tenant hereby appoints
Landlord as its attorney-in-fact for the limited purpose of
preparing, executing and filing on Tenant’s behalf all
appropriate UCC financing statements Landlord deems reasonably
necessary to perfect the security interest granted Landlord
hereunder, all without further notice to Tenant.
SECTION
8: USE, COMPLIANCE WITH LAWS AND RULES
A.
Use
of Premises and Compliance With Laws.
Tenant shall use the
Premises solely for the purposes set forth in Section 1 and for no
other purpose without obtaining the prior written consent of
Landlord, which shall not be unreasonably withheld for uses
consistent with Landlord’s then existing use criteria for the
Building. Tenant acknowledges that neither Landlord nor any agent
of Landlord has made any representation or warranty with respect to
the Premises or with respect to the suitability of the Premises or
the Building for the conduct of Tenant’s business, nor has
Landlord agreed to undertake any modification, alteration or
improvement to the Premises or the Building, except as provided in
writing in this Lease. Tenant acknowledges that Landlord may from
time to time, at its sole discretion, make such modifications,
alterations, repairs, deletions or improvements to the Building or
Property as Landlord may deem necessary or desirable, without
compensation or notice to Tenant, provided that such alterations,
repairs, deletions or improvements shall not materially adversely
affect Tenant’s use of the Premises during Normal Business
Hours and in no event shall Landlord be liable for any
consequential damages. Tenant shall promptly comply with all Laws
affecting the Premises and the Building, as well as the Rules
(defined below), and to any reasonable modifications to the Rules
as Landlord may adopt from time to time. Tenant acknowledges that,
except for Landlord’s obligations pursuant to Sections 9 and
30, Tenant is solely responsible for ensuring that the Premises
comply with any and all Laws applicable to Tenant’s use of
and conduct of business on the Premises, and that Tenant is solely
responsible for any alterations or improvements that may be
required by such Laws, now existing or hereafter adopted. Tenant
shall not do or permit anything to be done in or about the Premises
or bring or keep anything in the Premises that will in any way
increase the premiums paid by Landlord on its insurance related to
the Building or which will in any way increase the premiums for
fire or casualty insurance carried by other tenants in the
Building. Tenant will not perform any act or carry on any practices
that may injure the Premises or the Building that may be a nuisance
or menace to other tenants in the Building or that shall in any way
interfere with the quiet enjoyment of such other tenants. Tenant
shall not do anything on the Premises which will overload any
existing parking or service to the Premises.
B.
Rules.
Tenant shall comply with the Rules set forth in Rider One attached
hereto (the “Rules”) in addition to all other terms of
this Lease. Landlord shall have the right, by notice to Tenant or
by posting at the Building, to reasonably amend such Rules and
supplement the same with other reasonable Rules relating to the
Building or Property, or the promotion of safety, care, efficiency,
cleanliness or good order therein. Nothing herein shall be
construed to give Tenant or any other Person any claim, demand or
cause of action against Landlord arising out of the violation of
such Rules by any other tenant or visitor of the Building or
Property, or out of the enforcement, modification or waiver of the
Rules by Landlord in any particular instance.
SECTION
9: MAINTENANCE AND REPAIRS
Unless
expressly provided otherwise in this Lease, and in addition to the
provisions of Section 6(A)(vi), Landlord shall maintain, in good
condition, the Common Areas of the Building, the structural parts
of the Building which shall include only the foundations, bearing
and exterior walls, subflooring, gutters, downspouts, and the roof
of the Building and the Building Systems and Equipment; provided,
in the event any such replacements, repairs or maintenance are
caused by or result from Tenant’s excessive or improper use
or occupation thereof or which are caused by or result from the
negligence or improper conduct of Tenant, its agents, employees or
invitees, the cost of such repairs shall be paid solely by Tenant
and Tenant shall pay the cost thereof within ten (10) days of
notice from Landlord. Except as provided above, and subject to
Section 10 of this Lease, Tenant shall maintain and repair the
Premises in neat, clean, sanitary and good condition, including,
without limitation, maintaining and repairing all walls,
storefronts, ceilings, interior and exterior doors, exterior and
interior windows and fixtures, Premises’ specific systems and
equipment, and interior plumbing serving the Premises as well as
any damage to the Building, Property or Premises caused by Tenant,
its agents, employees or invitees. If Tenant shall fail to keep and
preserve the Premises in said condition and state or repair,
Landlord may, at its option (but with no obligation) put or cause
the same to be put into the condition and state of repair agreed
upon, and in such case Tenant, on demand, shall pay the cost
thereof.
SECTION
10: ALTERATIONS AND LIENS
A.
Alterations.
Subsequent to the completion of any Landlord’s Work pursuant
to Section 2, Tenant shall not attach any fixtures, equipment or
other items to the Premises, or paint or make any other additions,
changes, alterations, repairs or improvements (collectively
hereinafter “alterations”) to the Premises, Building or
Property without Landlord’s prior written consent, which with
respect to alterations to the Premises will not be unreasonably
withheld so long as Tenant is not then, nor has been, in default of
this Lease (beyond any applicable cure period). If Landlord
consents to any alteration, Landlord may post notices of
nonresponsibility in accordance with Law. Any alterations so made
shall remain on and be surrendered with the Premises upon
expiration or earlier termination of this Lease, except that
Landlord may, within thirty (30) days before or thirty (30) days
after expiration or earlier termination hereof elect to require
Tenant to remove any or all alterations at Tenant’s sole
costs and expense. At the time Tenant submits plans for requested
alterations to Landlord for Landlord’s approval, Tenant may
request Landlord to identify which alterations Landlord may require
Tenant to remove at the termination of or expiration of this Lease,
and Landlord shall make such identification simultaneous with its
approval (if any) of the alterations. If Landlord elects to require
removal of alterations, then at its own and sole cost Tenant shall
restore the Premises to the condition designated by Landlord in its
election, before the last day of the term or within thirty (30)
days after notice of its election is given, whichever is
later.
B.
Performance.
In the event Landlord consents in writing to Tenant’s
requested alteration of the Premises, Tenant shall only contract
with a contractor approved by Landlord for the construction of such
alterations, shall secure all appropriate governmental approvals
and permits and shall complete such alterations with due diligence,
in a neat, clean, good and workmanlike manner and in strict
compliance with the plans and specifications approved by Landlord.
All such construction shall be performed in a manner which shall
not interfere with the occupancy of the other tenants of the
Building. All cost, expenses and fees related to or arising from
construction of any alteration shall be paid by Tenant prior to
delinquency. There shall also be included within the cost of any
such alteration work (whether for initial tenant improvements or
for any subsequent alteration) a fee to Landlord for Tenant’s
use of Landlord’s personnel involved in the supervision,
coordination, inspection and the like pertaining to such work. Said
fee shall be ten percent (10%) of the total cost of the alteration
work (including costs of plans and permits), plus Landlord’s
out-of-pocket costs (if any), which shall be paid by Tenant within
ten (10) days after presentment by Landlord of an invoice therefor.
Landlord may impose additional reasonable conditions and rules
respecting the manner and times in which such alteration work may
be performed.
C.
Liens.
Tenant shall pay all costs for alterations when due. Tenant shall
keep the Property, Building, Premises and this Lease free from any
mechanic’s, materialman’s, architect’s,
engineer’s or similar liens or encumbrances, and any claims
therefor, or stop or violation notices, in connection with any
alteration. Tenant shall remove any such claim, lien or
encumbrance, or stop or violation notices of record, by bond or
otherwise within ten (10) days after notice by Landlord. If Tenant
fails to do so, such failure shall constitute a default by Tenant,
and Landlord may, in addition to any other remedy, pay the amount
(or any portion thereof) or take such other action as Landlord
deems necessary to remove such claim, lien or encumbrance, or stop
or violation notices, without being responsible for investigating
the validity thereof. The amount so paid and costs incurred by
Landlord shall be deemed additional Rent under this Lease payable
upon demand, without limitation as to other remedies available to
Landlord. Landlord may, in its discretion, require Tenant to obtain
a lien and completion bond or some alternate form of security
satisfactory to Landlord in an amount sufficient to ensure the
lien-free completion of such alterations and naming Landlord as a
co-obligee. Nothing contained in this Lease shall authorize Tenant
to do any act which shall subject Landlord’s title to, or any
Lender’s interest in, the Building, Property or Premises to
any such claims, liens or encumbrances, or stop or violation
notices, whether claimed pursuant to statute or other Law or
express or implied contract.
D.
Construction
Insurance.
In addition to the requirements of Section 11
below, in the event that Tenant makes any alterations, prior to the
commencement of such alterations, Tenant shall provide Landlord
with evidence that Tenant or its general contractor, as
appropriate, carries “Builder’s All Risk”
insurance or its equivalent in an amount approved by Landlord
covering the construction of such alterations, and such other
insurance as Landlord may reasonably require, it being understood
and agreed that all of such alterations shall be insured by Tenant
pursuant to Section 10 of this Lease immediately upon completion
thereof.
SECTION
11: INSURANCE AND WAIVER OF SUBROGATION
A.
Insurance.
During the term of this Lease, Tenant, at its sole cost and
expense, shall continuously maintain the following types of
insurance coverages: (i)
All Risk or Causes of Loss - Special Form property
insurance, including fire and extended coverage, sprinkler leakage,
vandalism, malicious mischief, wind and flood coverage, covering
full replacement value of all of Tenant’s personal property,
trade fixtures and improvements and alterations in and to the
Premises
, with coverages that also include “Business
Personal Property” and “Business Income Coverage”
covering at least one year of anticipated income; (ii)
both
worker’s compensation
insurance to the applicable statutory limit, if any, and
employer’s liability insurance to the limit of $1,000,000 per
occurrence
; (iii)
commercial general liability insurance (occurrence
based) insuring Tenant against any liability arising out of its
use, occupancy or maintenance of the Premises or Building, or the
business operated by Tenant pursuant to the Lease, and providing
coverage for death, bodily injury and disease, property damage or
destruction (including loss of use), products and completed
operations liability, contractual liability which includes all of
Tenant’s indemnity obligations under this Lease (
and
the certificate evidencing Tenant’s insurance coverage shall
state that the insurance includes the liability assumed by Tenant
under this Lease
), fire legal
liability and advertising injury liability damage with a combined
single limit of no less than $5,000,000
(or in the alternative a primary policy combined
single limit of $2,000,000 with an Excess Limits (Umbrella) Policy
in the amount of no less than $3,000,000)
; and
(iv) Business Automobile Liability Insurance for Tenant owned
vehicles (only) in the amount of $1,000,000 combined single limit
(property damage and liability). The amount of any deductible or
self-insured retention for the coverages described in (i) and (iii)
shall not exceed Five Thousand Dollars ($5,000.00), and any
deductible or self-insurance provisions under any other insurance
policies required to be maintained by Tenant shall be subject to
Landlord’s prior written approval, such approval not to be
unreasonably withheld.
B.
Additional
Requirements.
(i) All
insurance required to be carried by Tenant hereunder shall include
the following provisions: (a) shall name Landlord, Landlord's
property manager, and Landlord’s lender (if any) as
additional insureds; (b) shall release Landlord (and its
property manager and lender, if any) from any claims for damage to
business or to any person or the Premises, the Building and the
Property and to Tenant’s fixtures, personal property,
improvements and alterations in or on the Premises, caused by or
resulting from risks insured against under any insurance policy
carried by Tenant in force at the time of such damage;
(c) shall be issued by Insurance companies authorized to do
business in the State of Washington, with
policyholder ratings not lower than
“A-” and financial ratings not lower than
“VII” in Best’s Insurance Guide (latest edition
in effect as of the date of this Lease and subsequently in effect
as of the date of renewal of the required policies)
;
(d) Shall be issued as (and separately endorsed as) a primary
and noncontributory policy as such policies apply to Landlord
(except for workers compensation); and (e) Shall contain an
endorsement requiring at least thirty (30) days prior written
notice of cancellation to Landlord and Landlord’s lender (if
any), before cancellation or change in coverage, scope or amount of
any policy. Tenant shall deliver certificates of such policies
together with evidence of payment of all current premiums to
Landlord within thirty (30) days of execution of this Lease;
provided, if such certificates do not on their face evidence such
terms, Tenant shall also provide full copies of such endorsements
or policies as necessary to evidence that all of the coverage
requirements of this Section 11 have been satisfied by Tenant. Any
certificate of insurance shall designate Tenant as the insured,
specify the Premises location, list Landlord (and its property
manager and lender, if any) as additional insureds (with the
additional insured endorsement attached thereto), and list Landlord
with Landlord’s current address as “Certificate
Holder.”
If certificates are
supplied (rather than the policies), Tenant shall allow Landlord,
at all reasonable times, to inspect the policies of insurance
required herein.
Tenant shall take all necessary steps to
renew all insurance at least thirty (30) days prior to such
insurance expiration dates and shall provide Landlord a copy of the
renewed certificate, prior to said policy’s expiration date.
If Tenant fails at any time to maintain the insurance required by
this Lease, and fails to cure such default within five (5) business
days of written notice from Landlord then, in addition to all other
remedies available under this Lease and applicable Law, Landlord
may purchase such insurance on Tenant’s behalf and the cost
of such insurance shall be Additional Rent due within ten (10) days
of written invoice from Landlord to Tenant.
(ii) It
is expressly understood and agreed that the coverages required by
this Section 11 represent Landlord’s minimum requirements and
such are not to be construed to void or limit Tenant’s
obligations contained in this Lease, including without limitation
Tenant’s indemnity obligations hereunder. Neither shall (a)
the insolvency, bankruptcy or failure of any insurance company
carrying Tenant, (b) the failure of any insurance company to pay
claims occurring nor (c) any exclusion from or insufficiency of
coverage be held to affect, negate or waive any of Tenant’s
indemnity obligations under this Lease or any other provision of
this Lease. Landlord reserves the right to require Tenant provide
evidence of any additional insurance as it reasonably deems
appropriate, as well as the right to require an increase in the
amounts of insurance or the insurance coverages as Landlord may
reasonably request from time to time, but not in excess of the
requirements of prudent landlords or lenders for similar tenants
occupying similar premises in the Puget Sound metropolitan area.
Tenant’s occupancy of the Premises without delivering the
certificates of insurance shall not constitute a waiver of
Tenant’s obligations to provide the required coverages. If
Tenant provides to Landlord a certificate that does not evidence
the coverages required herein, or that is faulty in any respect,
such shall not constitute a waiver of Tenant’s obligations to
provide the proper insurance
C.
Waiver
of Subrogation.
Landlord and Tenant release and relieve the
other, and waive the entire right of recovery for loss or damage to
property located within or constituting a part or all of the
Premises, the Building or the Property to the extent that the loss
or damage is actually covered (and claim amount recovered) by
commercial insurance carried by either party and in force at the
time of such loss or damage. This waiver applies whether or not the
loss is due to the negligent acts or omissions of Landlord or
Tenant, or their respective officers, directors, employees, agents,
contractors, or invitees. Each of Landlord and Tenant shall have
their respective property insurers endorse the applicable insurance
policies to reflect the foregoing waiver of claims, provided,
however, that the endorsement shall not be required if the
applicable policy of insurance permits the named insured to waive
rights of subrogation on a blanket basis, in which case the blanket
waiver shall be acceptable.
SECTION
12: CASUALTY DAMAGE
In the
event the Building or Premises shall be destroyed or rendered
untenantable, either wholly or in part, by fire or other casualty,
Landlord may, at its option, restore the Building or Premises to as
near their previous condition as is reasonably possible and in the
meantime the Rent shall be abated in the same proportion as the
untenantable portion of the Premises bears to the whole thereof,
provided
, such
abatement (i) shall apply only to the extent the Premises are
untenantable for the purposes permitted under this Lease and not
used by Tenant as a result thereof, and (ii) shall not apply if
Tenant or any other occupant of the Premises or any of their
agents, employees, invitees, transferees or contractors caused the
damage. Unless Landlord, within sixty (60) days after the happening
of any such casualty, shall notify Tenant of its election to so
restore, this Lease shall thereupon terminate and end,
provided
, if in
Landlord’s estimation the Premises cannot be restored within
one hundred twenty (120) days following such destruction, Landlord
shall notify Tenant and Tenant may terminate this Lease (regardless
of Landlord’s intent to restore) by delivery of notice to
Landlord within thirty (30) days of Landlord’s notice. Such
restoration by Landlord shall not include replacement of furniture,
equipment or other items that do not become part of the Building or
any improvements to the Premises in excess of those provided for in
the allowance for building standard items. Tenant agrees that the
abatement of Rent as provided above shall be Tenant’s sole
and exclusive recourse in the event of such damage, and Tenant
waives any other rights Tenant may have under applicable Law to
perform repairs or terminate the Lease by reason of damage to the
Building or Premises.
SECTION
13: CONDEMNATION
If at
least fifty percent (50%) of the rentable area of the Premises
shall be taken by power of eminent domain or condemned by a
competent authority or by conveyance in lieu thereof for public or
quasi-public use (“Condemnation”), including any
temporary taking for a period of one year or longer, this Lease
shall terminate on the date possession for such use is so taken.
If: (i) less than fifty percent (50%) of the Premises is taken, but
the taking includes or affects a material portion of the Building
or Property, or the economical operation thereof, (ii) less than
fifty percent (50%) of the Premises are taken and in the reasonable
judgment of Landlord the remaining Premises are not usable for the
business of Tenant, or (iii) the taking is temporary but will be in
effect for more than thirty (30) days, then in either such event,
Landlord may elect to terminate this Lease upon at least thirty
(30) days’ prior notice to Tenant. The parties further agree
that: (a) if this Lease is terminated, all Rent shall be
apportioned as of the date of such termination or the date of such
taking, whichever shall first occur, (b) if the taking is
temporary, Rent shall not be abated for the period of the taking,
but Tenant may seek a condemnation award therefor (and the Term
shall not be extended thereby), and (c) if this Lease is not
terminated but any part of the Premises is permanently taken, the
Rent shall be proportionately abated based on the square footage of
the Premises so taken. Landlord shall be entitled to receive the
entire award or payment in connection with such Condemnation and
Tenant hereby assigns to Landlord any interest therein for the
value of Tenant’s unexpired leasehold estate or any other
claim and waives any right to participate therein, and Tenant shall
make no claim against Landlord for termination of the leasehold
interest or interference with Tenant’s business. Tenant,
however, shall have the right to claim damages from the condemning
authority for a temporary taking of the leasehold as described
above, for moving expenses and any taking of Tenant’s
personal property and for the interruption to Tenant’s
business, but only if such damages are awarded separately in the
eminent domain proceeding and not as part or in diminution of the
damages recovered by Landlord.
SECTION
14: ASSIGNMENT AND SUBLETTING
A.
Consent
Required.
Tenant shall not, without the prior written
consent of Landlord, assign this Lease or any interest therein, or
sublet the Premises or any part thereof, or permit the use of the
Premises by any party other than Tenant or otherwise transfer this
Lease (collectively “Transfer”). Such consent shall be
entirely discretionary with Landlord, except as otherwise provided
in this Section 14. Consent to one such Transfer shall not destroy
or waive this provision, and all subsequent Transfers shall
likewise be made only upon obtaining prior written consent of
Landlord. Subtenants or assignees shall become directly liable to
Landlord for all obligations of Tenant hereunder, without relieving
Tenant of any liability.
B.
Transfers.
If Tenant is a corporation, then any Transfer of this Lease by
merger, consolidation or liquidation, or any change in the
ownership of, or power to vote, the majority of its outstanding
voting stock, shall constitute an assignment for the purpose of
this Section 14. If Tenant is a partnership or limited liability
company, any Transfer of this Lease by merger, consolidation,
liquidation or dissolution, or any change in the ownership of a
majority of the partnership or membership interests, shall
constitute an assignment for the purposes of this Section 14. An
assignment forbidden within the meaning of this Section includes
without limitation one or more sales or Transfers, by operation of
law or otherwise, or creation of new stock, by which an aggregate
of more than fifty percent (50%) of Tenant’s stock shall be
vested in a party or parties who are nonstockholders as of the date
hereof. This Section 14(B) shall not apply if Tenant’s stock
is listed on a recognized security exchange or if at least eighty
percent (80%) of its stock is owned by a corporation whose stock is
listed on a recognized security exchange.
C.
Recapture.
If Tenant at any time desires to Transfer this Lease or any part
thereof, it shall first notify Landlord in writing of its desire to
do so, and offer Landlord the right to recapture, at the per square
foot rental for the space then applicable pursuant to this Lease or
the rental which Tenant proposed to obtain whichever is lower, for
all or any part of the Premises which Tenant desires to assign or
sublet. Tenant’s notice to Landlord shall specify (i) the
name and business of the proposed assignee or sublessee, (ii) the
amount and location of this space affected, (iii) the proposed
effective date and duration of the subletting or assignment, and
(iv) the proposed rental to be paid to Tenant by such sublessee or
assignee. Landlord, upon receipt of such notice, shall have the
option, to be exercised within sixty (60) days from the date of the
receipt of such notice, to require Tenant to execute an assignment
to Landlord of this Lease (if Tenant desires to assign this Lease)
or a sublease to Landlord of the Premises or such portion thereof
as Tenant desires to sublet with the right of Landlord to sublease
to others, or anyone designated by Landlord. If Landlord exercises
such option and such assignment or sublease is at the rental
specified in this Lease, Tenant shall be released of all further
liability hereunder, from and after the effective date of such
assignment or sublease, with respect to that portion of the
Premises included therein. If Landlord does not exercise such
option within such time, Tenant may thereafter assign this Lease or
sublet the premises involved, provided Landlord consents thereto,
but at a rental not less than offered to Landlord in the notice and
not later than ninety (90) days after delivery of the aforesaid
notice unless a further notice is given. In the event Landlord does
not exercise its right to terminate this Lease or to sublet a
portion of the Premises from Tenant and Landlord has granted its
written consent, Tenant may assign this Lease or sublet all or a
portion of the Premises in accordance with Landlord’s
consent. Any Rent accruing to Tenant as a result of such assignment
or sublease which is in excess or the Rent then being paid by
Tenant, or in excess of the pro rata share of Rent then being paid
by Tenant for the portion of the Premises being sublet, shall be
paid by Tenant to Landlord monthly as additional rent.
D.
Costs.
Whether or not Landlord consents to a proposed Transfer (or
exercises its right to recapture), Tenant shall reimburse Landlord
on demand for any and all costs that may be incurred by Landlord in
connection with any proposed Transfer including, without
limitation, the cost of investigating the acceptability of the
proposed transferee and Landlord’s reasonable
attorneys’ fees incurred in connection with each proposed
Transfer.
E.
Notice.
Any notice or request to Landlord with respect to a proposed
assignment or sublease shall contain the name of the proposed
assignee or subtenant (collectively “Transferee”), the
nature of the proposed Transferee’s business to be conducted
at the Premises, and the terms and provisions of the proposed
Transfer. Tenant shall also provide Landlord with a copy of the
proposed Transfer documents when available, and such financial and
other information with respect to the proposed Transferee and
Transfer that Landlord may reasonably require.
F.
Consent.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event of a proposed Transfer,
if Landlord does not exercise its option under Section 14(C), then
Landlord will not unreasonably withhold its consent thereto if (a)
Tenant is not then, nor has been, in default of this Lease (beyond
any applicable cure period), (b) the proposed Transferee will
continuously occupy and use the Premises for the term of the
Transfer, (c) the use by the proposed Transferee will be the same
as Tenant’s use of the Premises, (d) the proposed Transferee
is reputable and of sound financial condition, (e) the Transfer
will not directly or indirectly cause Landlord to be in breach of
any contractual obligation, and (f) the proposed Transferee is not
an existing tenant or subtenant of any other premises located on
the Property. In all other cases, Landlord may withhold consent in
its sole discretion.
G.
Terms;
Transfer Premium.
Any option(s) granted to Tenant in this
Lease or any option(s) granted to Tenant in any amendments to this
Lease, to the extent that said option(s) have not been exercised,
shall terminate and be voided in the event this Lease is assigned,
or any part of the Premises are sublet, or Tenant’s interest
in the Premises are otherwise Transferred, unless otherwise agreed
to by Lanadlord. If Landlord consents to a Transfer, as a condition
thereto which the parties hereby agree is reasonable, Tenant shall
pay to Landlord fifty percent (50%) of any “Transfer
Premium,” as that term is defined in this Section 14(G),
received by Tenant from such Transferee. “Transfer
Premium”
shall
mean all rent, additional rent or other consideration payable by
such Transferee in connection with the Transfer in excess of the
Rent and Additional Rent payable by Tenant under this Lease during
the term of the Transfer on a per rentable square foot basis if
less than all of the Premises is transferred, after deducting the
reasonable expenses incurred by Tenant for (i) any changes,
alterations and improvements to the Premises in connection with the
Transfer, (ii) any free base rent or other economic concessions
reasonably provided to the Transferee, (iii) any brokerage
commissions in connection with the Transfer, and (iv) actual,
reasonable attorneys’ fees incurred by Tenant in connection
with the Transfer. “Transfer Premium”
shall also include, but
not
be limited to, key
money, bonus money or other cash consideration paid by Transferee
to Tenant in connection with such Transfer, and any payment in
excess of fair market value for services rendered by Tenant to
Transferee or for assets, fixtures, inventory, equipment, or
furniture transferred by Tenant to Transferee in connection with
such Transfer. The determination of the amount of Landlord’s
applicable share of the Transfer Premium shall be made on a monthly
basis as rent or other consideration is received by Tenant under
the Transfer.
SECTION
15: PERSONAL PROPERTY, RENT AND OTHER TAXES
Tenant
shall pay prior to delinquency all taxes, charges or other
governmental impositions assessed against, levied upon or otherwise
imposed upon or with respect to all fixtures, furnishings, personal
property, systems and equipment located in or exclusively serving
the Premises, and any improvements made to the Premises under or
pursuant to the provisions of this Lease. Whenever possible, Tenant
shall cause all such items to be assessed and billed separately
from the other property of Landlord. In the event any such items
shall be assessed and billed with the other property of Landlord,
Tenant shall pay Landlord its share of such taxes, charges or other
governmental impositions within ten (10) days after Landlord
delivers a statement and a copy of the assessment or other
documentation showing the amount of impositions applicable to
Tenant’s property. Tenant shall pay any rent tax, sales tax,
service tax, transfer tax, value added tax, or any other applicable
tax on the Rent, utilities or services herein, the privilege of
renting, using or occupying the Premises, or collecting Rent
therefrom, or otherwise respecting this Lease or any other document
entered in connection herewith.
SECTION
16: TENANT’S DEFAULT; LANDLORD’S
REMEDIES
A.
Default.
The occurrence of any one or more of the following events shall
constitute a “Default” by Tenant and shall give rise to
Landlord’s remedies set forth in Section 16(B) below: (i)
failure to make when due any payment of Rent,
provided, however
, that Tenant shall
not be in default solely due to such failure so long as (a) no more
than one (1) such failure occurs during any calendar year, and (b)
any such failure is cured within three (3) business days after
notice from Landlord; (ii) failure to observe or perform any term
or condition of this Lease other than the payment of Rent (or the
other matters expressly described herein), unless such failure is
cured within any period of time following notice expressly provided
with respect thereto in other Sections hereof, or otherwise within
a reasonable time, but in no event more than thirty (30) days
following notice from Landlord (provided, if the nature of
Tenant’s failure is such that more time is reasonably
required in order to cure, Tenant shall not be in Default if Tenant
commences to cure promptly within such period and thereafter
diligently pursues its completion); (iii) failure to cure
immediately upon notice thereof any condition which is hazardous,
interferes with another tenant or the operation or leasing of the
Property, or may cause the imposition of a fine, penalty or other
remedy on Landlord or its agents or affiliates; (iv) abandonment
and vacation of the Premises (failure to occupy and operate the
Premises for ten (10) consecutive days while in monetary default
under this Lease shall conclusively be deemed an abandonment and
vacation); or (v) Tenant, or any guarantor of this Lease
(“Guarantor”), filing by or for reorganization or
arrangement under any Law relating to bankruptcy or insolvency
(unless, in the case of a petition filed against Tenant or such
Guarantor, the same is dismissed within thirty (30) days); (b)
Tenant’s or any Guarantor’s insolvency or failure, or
admission of an inability, to pay debts as they mature, or (c) a
violation by Tenant or any affiliate of Tenant under any other
lease or agreement with Landlord or any affiliate thereof which is
not cured within the time permitted for cure thereunder.
Additionally, if Tenant violates the same term or condition of this
Lease on two (2) occasions during any twelve (12) month period,
Landlord shall have the right to exercise all remedies for any
violations of the same term or condition during the next twelve
(12) months without providing further notice or an opportunity to
cure. The notice and cure periods provided herein are intended to
satisfy any and all notice requirements imposed by Law on Landlord
and are in lieu of, and not in addition to, any notice and cure
periods provided by Law;
provided
, Landlord may elect to
comply with such notice and cure periods provided by Law. In the
event of Tenant’s default, and in addition to any other
amounts or remedies that Landlord may be entitled to, Landlord
shall be entitled to recover from Tenant, Landlord’s costs
and reasonable attorneys’ fees incurred in enforcing this
Lease or otherwise arising from Tenant’s
default.
B.
Remedies.
If a Default occurs, Landlord shall have the rights and remedies
hereinafter set forth to the extent permitted by Law, which shall
be distinct, separate and cumulative with and in addition to any
other right or remedy allowed under any Law or other provision of
this Lease:
1.
Landlord may
terminate Tenant’s right to possession without termination of
this Lease, or Landlord may terminate this Lease and Tenant’s
right to possession, at any time following a Default;
provided
, no act of Landlord
other than giving notice to Tenant with express statement of
termination shall terminate this Lease or Tenant’s right to
possession. Acts of maintenance, efforts to relet the premises or
the appointment of a receiver on Landlord’s initiative to
protect Landlord’s interest under this Lease shall not
constitute a termination of tenant’s right to possession.
Upon termination of Tenant’s right to possession, Landlord
shall have the right to reenter the Premises and recover from
Tenant in addition to any other monies provided herein or at Law:
(a) the Worth of the unpaid Rent that had been earned by Landlord
at the time of termination of Tenant’s right to possession;
(b) the Worth of the amount of the unpaid Rent that would have been
earned after the date of termination of Tenant’s right to
possession through the expiration of the Lease Term; and (c) all
other expenses incurred by Landlord on account of Tenant’s
Default, including without limitation any Costs of Reletting
(defined below) and Landlord’s attorneys’ fees and
collection costs. The “Worth” as used for item (a)
above is to be computed by allowing interest at the rate of
eighteen percent (18%) to accrue on all such unpaid Rent (or such
lesser rate required by Law, if any). The Worth as used for item
(b) above is to be computed by discounting the amount of Rent at
the discount rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco at
the time of termination of Tenant’s right of
possession.
2.
In the event
Landlord has made improvements to the Premises for the use and
occupancy of Tenant, in addition to all other damages and rents to
which Landlord shall be entitled on account of Tenant’s
Default, Landlord shall also be entitled to recover from Tenant a
sum equal to: (a) the unamortized cost to Landlord of the basic
building standard Tenant improvement costs, said sum being computed
by applying the percentage which the unexpired portion of the Lease
Term bears to the total scheduled Lease Term with interest at ten
percent (10%) per annum, plus (b) all costs to Landlord of
non-building standard, custom or special Tenant improvements (above
basic building standard improvements) with no adjustment for the
unexpired portion of the scheduled Lease Term.
3.
In the event of any
such reentry by Landlord, Landlord may, at Landlord’s option,
require Tenant to remove from the Premises any of Tenant’s
property located thereon. If Tenant fails to do so, Landlord shall
not be responsible for the care or safekeeping thereof and may
remove any of the same from the Premises and place the same
elsewhere in the Building or in storage in a public warehouse at
the cost, expense and risk of Tenant with authority to the
warehouseman to sell the same in the event that Tenant shall fail
to pay the cost of transportation and storage, all in accordance
with the rules and regulations applicable to the operation of a
public warehouseman’s business. In any and all such cases of
reentry Landlord may make any repairs in, to or upon the Premises
which may be necessary, desirable or convenient, and Tenant hereby
waives any and all claims for damages which may be caused or
occasioned by such reentry or to any property in or about the
Premises or any part thereof.
4.
Landlord may bring
suits for amounts owed by Tenant hereunder or any portions thereof,
as the same accrue or after the same have accrued, and no suit or
recovery of any portion due hereunder shall be deemed a waiver of
Landlord’s right to collect all amounts to which Landlord is
entitled hereunder, nor shall the same serve as any defense to any
subsequent suit brought for any amount not therefor reduced to
judgment. Landlord may pursue one or more remedies against Tenant
and need not make an election of remedies. All rent and other
consideration paid by any replacement tenants shall be applied at
Landlord’s option: (i) first, to the Costs of Reletting
(defined below), (ii) second, to the payment of all costs and
attorneys’ fees of enforcing this Lease against Tenant or any
Guarantor, (iii) third, to the payment of all interest and service
charges accruing hereunder, (iv) fourth, to the payment of Rent
theretofore accrued, and (v) with the residue, if any, to be held
by Landlord and applied to the payment of Rent and other
obligations of Tenant as the same become due (and with any
remaining residue to be retained by Landlord). “Costs of
Reletting” shall include without limitation, all costs and
expenses incurred by Landlord for any repairs, improvements or
other matters necessary to prepare the Premises for another tenant,
brokerage commissions, advertising costs, attorneys’ fees,
any economic incentives given to enter leases with replacement
tenants. With respect to reletting the Premises, Landlord shall
only be required to use reasonable efforts that do not exceed such
efforts Landlord generally uses to lease other space in the
Building, Landlord may continue to lease other portions of the
Building or other projects owned or managed by Landlord in the same
vicinity before reletting all or a portion of the Premises, and
Landlord shall not be required to relet at rental rates less than
Landlord’s then-existing rates for new leases or terms less
favorable to Landlord than those contained herein. The times set
forth herein for the curing of Defaults by Tenant are of the
essence in this Lease.
5.
All covenants and
agreements to be kept or performed by Tenant under this Lease shall
be performed by Tenant at Tenant’s sole cost and expense and
without any reduction of Rent, except to the extent, if any,
otherwise expressly provided herein. If Tenant shall fail to
perform any obligation under this Lease, and such failure shall
continue in excess of the time allowed under Section 16(A) above,
unless a specific time period is otherwise stated in this Lease,
Landlord may, but shall not be obligated to, make any such payment
or perform any such act on Tenant’s part without waiving its
rights based upon any default of Tenant and without releasing
Tenant from any obligations hereunder. Except as may be
specifically provided to the contrary in this Lease, and in
addition to any other damages recoverable by Landlord hereunder,
Tenant shall pay to Landlord, upon delivery by Landlord to Tenant
of statements therefor, all sums necessary to reimburse Landlord or
pay to Landlord its expenditures actually made and obligations
actually incurred in connection with remedying Tenant defaults
pursuant to this Section 16(B)(5).
SECTION
17: SUBORDINATION, ATTORNMENT AND LENDER
PROTECTION
This
Lease is subject and subordinate to all Mortgages now or hereafter
placed upon the Property, Building, Premises or any interest of
Landlord therein, and all other encumbrances, and matters of public
record applicable to the Property, Building or Premises. Whether
before or after any foreclosure or power of sale proceedings are
initiated or completed by any Lender or a deed in lieu is granted
(or any ground lease is terminated), Tenant agrees upon written
request of any such Lender or any purchaser at such sale, to attorn
and pay Rent to such party, and recognize such party as Landlord
(provided such Lender or purchaser shall agree not to disturb
Tenant’s occupancy so long as Tenant does not Default
hereunder, on a form customarily used by, or otherwise reasonably
acceptable to, such party). However, in the event of attornment, no
Lender shall be: (i) liable for any act or omission of Landlord, or
subject to any offsets or defenses which Tenant might have against
Landlord (arising prior to such Lender becoming Landlord under such
attornment), (ii) liable for any security deposit or bound by any
prepaid Rent not actually received by such Lender, or (iii) bound
by any modification of this Lease not consented to by such Lender.
Any Lender may elect to make this Lease prior to the lien of its
Mortgage by written notice to Tenant, and if the Lender of any
prior Mortgage shall require, this Lease shall be prior to any
subordinate Mortgage; such elections shall be effective upon
written notice to Tenant, or shall be effective as of such earlier
or later date set forth in such notice. Tenant agrees to give any
Lender by certified mail, return receipt requested, a copy of any
notice of default served by Tenant upon Landlord, provided that
prior to such notice Tenant has been notified in writing (by way of
service on Tenant of a copy of an assignment of leases, or
otherwise) of the address of such Lender. Tenant further agrees
that if Landlord shall have failed to cure such default within the
time permitted Landlord for cure under this Lease, any such Lender
whose address has been provided to Tenant shall have an additional
period of thirty (30) days in which to cure (or such additional
time as may be required due to causes beyond such Lender’s
control, including time to obtain possession of the Property by
appointment of receiver, power of sale or judicial action). Should
any current or prospective Lender require a modification or
modifications to this Lease which will not cause an increased cost
or otherwise materially and adversely change the rights and
obligations of Tenant hereunder, Tenant agrees that this Lease
shall be so modified. Except as expressly provided to the contrary
herein, the provisions of this Section shall be self-operative;
however Tenant shall execute and deliver, within ten (10) days
after requested, such documentation as Landlord or any Lender may
request from time to time, whether prior to or after a foreclosure
or power of sale proceeding is initiated or completed, a deed in
lieu is delivered, or a ground lease is terminated, in order to
further confirm or effectuate the matters set forth in this Section
in recordable form (and Tenant hereby authorizes Landlord acting in
good faith to execute any such documentation as Tenant’s
agent and attorney-in-fact). Tenant hereby waives the provisions of
any Law (now or hereafter adopted) which may give or purport to
give Tenant any right or election to terminate or otherwise
adversely affect this Lease or Tenant’s obligations hereunder
if foreclosure or power of sale proceedings are initiated,
prosecuted or completed.
SECTION
18: ESTOPPEL CERTIFICATES
Tenant
shall from time to time, within five (5) days after written request
from Landlord, execute, acknowledge and deliver a statement
certifying: (i) that this Lease is unmodified and in full force and
effect or, if modified, stating the nature of such modification and
certifying that this Lease as so modified, is in full force and
effect (or specifying the ground for claiming that this Lease is
not in force and effect), (ii) the dates to which the Rent has been
paid, and the amount of any Security Deposit, (iii) that Tenant is
in possession of the Premises, and paying Rent on a current basis
with no offsets, defenses or claims, or specifying the same if any
are claimed, (iv) that there are not, to Tenant’s knowledge,
any uncured defaults on the part of Landlord or Tenant which are
pertinent to the request, or specifying the same if any are
claimed, and (v) certifying such other matters, and including such
current financial statements, as Landlord may reasonably request,
or as may be requested by Landlord’s current or prospective
Lenders, insurance carriers, auditors, and prospective purchasers
(and including a comparable certification statement from any
subtenant respecting its sublease). Any such statement may be
relied upon by any such parties. If Tenant shall fail to execute
and return such statement within the time required herein, Tenant
shall be deemed to have agreed with the matters set forth therein,
and Landlord acting in good faith shall be authorized as
Tenant’s agent and attorney-in-fact to execute such statement
on behalf of Tenant (which shall not be in limitation of
Landlord’s other remedies).
SECTION
19: RIGHTS RESERVED BY LANDLORD
Except
to the extent expressly limited herein, Landlord reserves full
rights to control the Property (which rights may be exercised
without subjecting Landlord to claims for constructive eviction,
abatement of Rent, damages or other claims of any kind), including
more particularly, but without limitation, the following
rights:
A.
General
Matters.
To: (i) change the name or street address of the
Building or Property or designation of the Premises, (ii) install
and maintain signs on the exterior and interior of the Building or
Property, and grant any other person the right to do so, (iii)
retain at all times, and use in appropriate instances, keys to all
doors within and into the Premises, (iv) grant to any person the
right to conduct any business or render any service at the
Property, whether or not the same are similar to the use permitted
Tenant by this Lease, (v) grant any person the right to use
separate security personnel and systems respecting access to their
premises, (vi) have access for Landlord and other tenants of the
Building to any mail chutes located on the Premises according to
the rules of the United States Postal Service (and to install or
remove such chutes), and (vii) in case of fire, invasion,
insurrection, riot, civil disorder, emergency or other dangerous
condition, or threat thereof: (a) limit or prevent access to the
Building or Property or Premises, (b) shut down elevator service,
(c) activate elevator emergency controls, and (d) otherwise
take such action or preventative measures deemed necessary by
Landlord for the safety of tenants of the Building or Property or
the protection of the Building or Property and other property
located thereon or therein (but this provision shall impose no duty
on Landlord to take such actions, and no liability for actions
taken in good faith).
B.
Access
to Premises.
To enter the Premises in order to: (i) inspect,
(ii) supply cleaning service or other services to be provided
Tenant hereunder, (iii) show the Premises to current and
prospective Lenders, insurers, purchasers, tenants, brokers and
governmental authorities, (iv) decorate, remodel or alter the
Premises if Tenant shall abandon the Premises at any time, or shall
vacate the same during the last one hundred twenty (120) days of
the Term (without thereby terminating this Lease), and (v) perform
any work or take any other actions under Section 19(C) below, or
exercise other rights of Landlord under this Lease or applicable
Laws. However, Landlord shall: (a) provide reasonable advance
written or oral notice to Tenant’s on site manager or other
appropriate person for matters which will involve a significant
disruption to Tenant’s business (except in emergencies), (b)
take reasonable steps to minimize any significant disruption to
Tenant’s business, and following completion of any work,
return Tenant’s leasehold improvements, fixtures, property
and equipment to the original locations and condition to the
fullest extent reasonably possible, and (c) take reasonable steps
to avoid materially changing the configuration or reducing the
square footage of the Premises, unless required by Laws or other
causes beyond Landlord’s reasonable control (and in the event
of any permanent material reduction, the Rent and other rights and
obligations of the parties based on the square footage of the
Premises shall be proportionately reduced). Tenant shall not place
partitions, furniture or other obstructions in the Premises which
may prevent or impair Landlord’s access to the Systems and
Equipment for the Property or the systems and equipment for the
Premises. If Tenant requests that any such access occur before or
after Landlord’s regular business hours and Landlord
approves, Tenant shall pay all overtime and other additional costs
in connection therewith.
C.
Changes
To The Property.
To: (i) paint and decorate, (ii) perform
repairs or maintenance, and (iii) make replacements, restorations,
renovations, alterations, additions and improvements, structural or
otherwise (including freon retrofit work), in and to the Building
or Property or any part thereof, including any adjacent building,
structure, facility, land, street or alley, or change the uses
thereof (including changes, reductions or additions of corridors,
entrances, doors, lobbies, parking facilities and other areas,
structural support columns and shear walls, elevators, stairs,
escalators, mezzanines, solar tint windows or film, kiosks,
planters, sculptures, displays, and other amenities and features
therein, and changes relating to the connection with or entrance
into or use of the Building or Property or any other adjoining or
adjacent building or buildings, now existing or hereafter
constructed). In connection with such matters, Landlord may among
other things erect scaffolding, barricades and other structures,
open ceilings, close entry ways, restrooms, elevators, stairways,
corridors, parking and other areas and facilities, and take such
other actions as Landlord deems appropriate. However, Landlord
shall: (a) take reasonable steps to minimize or avoid any denial of
access to the Premises except when necessary on a temporary basis,
and (b) in connection with entering the Premises shall comply with
Section 19(B) above.
D.
New
Premises.
To substitute for the Premises other premises
(herein referred to as the “new premises”) in the
Building, provided: (i) the new premises shall be similar to the
Premises in size (up to 10% larger or smaller with the Rent and any
other rights and obligations of the parties based on the square
footage of the Premises adjusted proportionately to reflect any
decrease), (ii) Landlord shall provide the new premises in a
condition substantially comparable to the Premises at the time of
the substitution (and Tenant shall diligently cooperate in the
preparation or approval of any plans or specifications for the new
premises as requested by Landlord or Landlord’s
representatives), (iii) the parties shall execute an appropriate
amendment to the Lease confirming the change within thirty (30)
days after Landlord requests, and (iv) if Tenant shall already have
taken possession of the Premises: (a) Landlord shall pay the
direct, out of pocket, reasonable expenses of Tenant in moving from
the Premises to the new premises, and (b) Landlord shall give
Tenant at least thirty (30) days’ notice before making such
change, and such move shall be made during evenings, weekends, or
otherwise so as to incur the least inconvenience to Tenant. Tenant
shall surrender and vacate the Premises on the date required in
Landlord’s notice of substitution, in the condition and as
required under Section 22, and any failure to do so shall be
subject to Section 23.
E.
Redevelopment
Rights and Construction Activities; Landlord Termination
Right.
Landlord reserves all rights to alter and/or
redevelop the Building and the Property, including the Premises,
and to perform construction activities in connection therewith
(collectively, “Construction Activities”). Construction
Activities may include (i) painting and decoration, (ii) repairs
and maintenance, (iii) replacements, restorations, renovations,
alterations, additions (including adding additional floors to the
Building) and improvements, structural and otherwise, in and to the
Building or Property or any part thereof, including any adjacent
building, structure, facility, land, street or alley, and (iv) any
changes in the uses thereof (including changes, reductions or
additions of corridors, entrances, doors, lobbies, parking
facilities and other areas, structural support columns and shear
walls, elevators, stairs, escalators, mezzanines, solar tint
windows or film, kiosks, planters, sculptures, displays, and other
amenities and features therein, and changes relating to the
connection with or entrance into or use of the Building or Property
or any other adjoining or adjacent building or buildings, now
existing or hereafter constructed). In connection with any such
Construction Activities, Landlord may among other things erect
scaffolding, barricades and other structures, open ceilings, close
entry ways, restrooms, elevators, stairways, corridors, parking and
other areas and facilities, and take such other actions as Landlord
deems appropriate. Landlord shall take reasonable steps to minimize
or avoid any denial of access to the Premises or interference with
Tenant’s use of the Premises except when necessary on a
temporary basis; provided, however, that if Landlord determines in
its reasonable judgment that it is necessary or expedient to do so,
Landlord shall have the right, at its option, to terminate this
Lease in connection with any Construction Activities, by giving
Tenant written notice to such effect (the "Termination Notice") not
less than twelve (12) months prior to the termination date set
forth in the Termination Notice (the “Termination
Date”). On the Termination Date (i) this Lease shall be fully
and finally terminated; (ii) Tenant shall vacate the Premises and
surrender possession of the Premises to Landlord in accordance with
the provisions of the Lease, and (iii) Landlord and Tenant shall be
fully and unconditionally relieved and released of and from their
respective obligations and liabilities under or connected with the
provisions of this Lease accruing or arising after the Termination
Date; provided, however, that any indemnity or similar provisions
of this Lease and any obligations on the part of Landlord or Tenant
to reimburse the other party for overpayments or underpayments
shall survive the termination of the Lease and remain fully
effective as to any and all demands, claims, causes of action, or
reimbursement obligations that accrued or arose on or before the
Termination Date. If Landlord elects to terminate this Lease in
accordance with this Section, Landlord shall work in good faith
with Tenant to identify potential alternative spaces for Tenant to
lease within the portfolio of Seattle office buildings owned by
Landlord or its affiliates.
SECTION
20: LANDLORD’S DEFAULT; REMEDIES
If
Landlord shall fail to perform any obligation under this Lease
required to be performed by Landlord, Landlord shall not be deemed
to be in default hereunder nor subject to any claims for damages of
any kind, unless such failure shall have continued for a period of
thirty (30) days after notice thereof by Tenant (provided, if the
nature of Landlord’s failure is such that more time is
reasonably required in order to cure, Landlord shall not be in
default if Landlord commences to cure within such period and
thereafter diligently seeks to cure such failure to completion). If
Landlord shall default and failure to cure as provided herein,
Tenant shall have such rights and remedies as may be available to
Tenant under applicable Laws, subject to the other provisions of
this Lease; provided, Tenant shall have no right of self-help to
perform repairs or any other obligation of Landlord, and shall have
no right to withhold, set-off, or abate Rent, or terminate this
Lease, and Tenant hereby expressly waives the benefit of any Law to
the contrary.
SECTION
21: RELEASE AND INDEMNITY
A.
Tenant’s
Indemnification of Landlord.
Tenant shall indemnify, defend
(using legal counsel reasonably acceptable to Landlord) and save
Landlord harmless from all claims, suits, losses, damages, fines,
penalties, liabilities and expenses (including Landlord’s
personnel and overhead costs and reasonable attorneys’ fees
and other costs incurred in connection with claims (collectively,
“Claims”), regardless of whether such Claims involve
litigation) resulting from any actual or alleged injury (including
death) of any person or from any actual or alleged loss of or
damage to any property arising out of or in connection with (i)
Tenant’s occupation, use or improvement of the Premises, or
that of its employees, agents or contractors, (ii) Tenant’s
breach of its obligations hereunder or (iii) any act or omission of
Tenant or any subtenant, licensee, assignee or concessionaire of
Tenant, or of any officer, agent, employee, guest or invitee of
Tenant, or of any such entity in or about the Premises.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event any Claims are caused
by the joint or concurrent negligence of Landlord or Tenant,
Tenant's indemnification obligation with respect to Landlord shall
be limited to the extent of the negligence of Tenant, and in no
event shall Tenant have any obligation to indemnify Landlord
against Claims arising out of the sole negligence of Landlord.
FOR THE SOLE PURPOSE OF GIVING FULL
FORCE AND EFFECT TO THE INDEMNIFICATION OBLIGATIONS UNDER THIS
LEASE AND NOT FOR THE BENEFIT OF ANY EMPLOYEES OF TENANT OR ANY
THIRD PARTIES UNRELATED TO THE PARTIES INDEMNIFIED UNDER THIS
LEASE, TENANT SPECIFICALLY AND EXPRESSLY WAIVES ANY IMMUNITY THAT
MAY BE GRANTED IT UNDER THE WASHINGTON STATE INDUSTRIAL INSURANCE
ACT, TITLE 51 RCW.
This indemnity with respect to acts or
omissions during the term of this Lease shall survive termination
or expiration of this Lease. Tenant shall promptly notify Landlord
of casualties or accidents occurring in or about the Premises.
LANDLORD AND TENANT ACKNOWLEDGE
THAT THE INDEMNIFICATION PROVISIONS OF SECTION 29 AND THIS SECTION
21 WERE SPECIFICALLY NEGOTIATED AND AGREED UPON BY
THEM.
B.
Release.
Tenant hereby fully and completely waives and releases all claims
against Landlord for any losses or other damages sustained by
Tenant or any person claiming through Tenant resulting from any
accident or occurrence in or upon the Premises, including but not
limited to: any defect in or failure of Building equipment; any
failure to make repairs; any defect, failure, surge in, or
interruption of project facilities or services; any defect in or
failure of Common Areas; broken glass; water leakage; the collapse
of any Building component; any claim or damage resulting from
Landlord’s repair, maintenance or improvements to any portion
of the Building or Property; or any act, omission or negligence of
co-tenants, licensees or any other persons or occupants of the
Building;
provided
only
, that the release contained in this Section 21(B) shall
not apply to claims for actual damage to persons or property
(excluding consequential damages such as lost profits) resulting
directly and solely from Landlord’s gross negligence or
willful misconduct or from Landlord’s breach of its express
obligations under this Lease which Landlord has not cured within a
reasonable time after receipt of written notice of such breach from
Tenant.
C.
Definitions.
As used in any Section of this Lease establishing indemnity or
release of Landlord, “Landlord” shall include Landlord,
its property manager if any, and their respective managers,
members, partners, officers, agents, employees and contractors, and
“Tenant” shall include Tenant and any person or entity
claiming through Tenant.
SECTION
22: RETURN OF POSSESSION
At the
expiration or earlier termination of this Lease or Tenant’s
right of possession, Tenant shall vacate and surrender possession
of the entire Premises in good, neat and clean order and
well-maintained condition, ordinary wear and tear excepted, shall
surrender all keys and key cards, and any parking transmitters,
stickers or cards, to Landlord, and shall remove all personal
property and office trade fixtures that may be readily removed
without damage to the Premises or Property. All improvements,
fixtures and other items installed by Tenant or Landlord under or
with respect to this Lease, shall be the property of Tenant during
the Term of this Lease, but at the expiration or earlier
termination of this Lease all such improvements, fixtures and other
items shall become Landlord’s property, and shall remain upon
the Premises (unless Landlord elects otherwise), all without
compensation, allowance or credit to Tenant. If prior to such
termination or within three (3) months thereafter Landlord so
directs by notice, and subject to the terms of Section 10(A) of
this Lease, Tenant shall promptly remove such of the foregoing
items as are designated in such notice and restore the Premises to
the condition prior to the installation of such items in a good and
workmanlike manner. If Tenant shall fail to perform any repairs or
restoration, or fail to remove any items from the Premises required
hereunder, Landlord may do so and Tenant shall pay Landlord’s
charges therefor upon demand. All property removed from the
Premises by Landlord pursuant to any provisions of this Lease or
any Law may be handled or stored by Landlord at Tenant’s
expense, and Landlord shall in no event be responsible for the
value, preservation or safekeeping thereof. All property not
removed from the Premises or retaken from storage by Tenant within
thirty (30) days after expiration or earlier termination of this
Lease or Tenant’s right to possession, shall at
Landlord’s option be conclusively deemed to have been
conveyed by Tenant to Landlord as if by bill of sale without
payment by Landlord. Unless prohibited by applicable Law, Landlord
shall have a lien against such property for the costs incurred in
removing and storing the same. Tenant hereby waives any statutory
notices to vacate or quit the Premises upon expiration of this
Lease.
SECTION
23: HOLDING OVER
Unless
Landlord expressly agrees otherwise in writing, Tenant shall pay
Landlord two hundred percent (200%) of the amount of Rent then
applicable prorated on a per diem basis for each day Tenant shall
fail to vacate or surrender possession of the Premises or any part
thereof after expiration or earlier termination of this Lease,
together with all damages sustained by Landlord on account thereof.
Tenant shall pay such amounts on demand, and, in the absence of
demand, monthly in advance. The foregoing provisions, and
Landlord’s acceptance of any such amounts, shall not serve as
permission for Tenant to hold over, nor serve to extend the Term
(although Tenant shall remain a tenant-at-sufferance bound to
comply with all provisions of this Lease). Landlord shall have the
right at any time after expiration or earlier termination of this
Lease, or Tenant’s right to possession, to reenter and
possess the Premises and remove all property and persons therefrom,
and Landlord shall have such other remedies for holdover as may be
available to Landlord under other provisions of this Lease or
applicable Laws.
SECTION
24: NOTICES
Except
as expressly provided to the contrary in this Lease, every notice
or other communication to be given by either party to the other
with respect hereto or to the Premises, Building or Property, shall
be in writing and shall not be effective for any purpose unless the
same shall be served personally, or by national air courier
service, or United States certified mail, return receipt requested,
postage prepaid, to the parties at the addresses set forth in
Section 1, or such other address or addresses as Tenant or Landlord
may from time to time designate by notice given as above provided.
Every notice or other communication hereunder shall be deemed to
have been given as of the third business day following the date of
such mailing (or as of any earlier date evidenced by a receipt from
such national air courier service or the United States Postal
Service) or immediately if personally delivered. Notices not sent
in accordance with the foregoing shall be of no force or effect
until received by the foregoing parties at such addresses required
herein.
SECTION
25: REAL ESTATE BROKERS
Tenant
represents that Tenant has dealt only with the broker, if any,
designated in Section 1 (whose commission, if any, shall be paid by
Landlord pursuant to separate agreement) as broker, agent or finder
in connection with this Lease, and agrees to indemnify and hold
Landlord harmless from all damages, judgments, liabilities and
expenses (including reasonable attorneys’ fees) arising from
any claims or demands of any other broker, agent or finder with
whom Tenant has dealt for any commission or fee alleged to be due
in connection with its participation in the procurement of Tenant
or the negotiation with Tenant of this Lease. Landlord and Tenant
recognize that it is possible that they may hereafter make
additional agreements regarding further extension or renewal of
this Lease or a new lease or leases for all or one or more parts of
the Premises or other space in the Building (or other portions of
the Property or other buildings managed by Landlord) for a term or
terms commencing after the Commencement Date of this Lease. It is
also possible that Landlord and Tenant may hereafter modify this
Lease to add additional space or to substitute other space for all
or a portion of the Premises. In the event any such additional
agreements, modifications to this Lease, or new leases are made,
Landlord shall have no obligation to pay any commission or other
compensation to any broker or other party engaged by Tenant
(including the brokers designated in Section 1) with respect to
negotiating or representing Tenant in such matters, regardless of
whether under the circumstances such person is or is not regarded
by law as an agent of Landlord, and Tenant shall indemnify and hold
Landlord harmless from any claim for such compensation. Nothing in
this Section 25 shall be construed to require or otherwise obligate
Landlord to consider or make any of the above-described additional
agreements, modifications to this Lease, or new lease.
SECTION
26: NO WAIVER
No
provision of this Lease will be deemed waived by either party
unless expressly waived in writing and signed by the waiving party.
No waiver shall be implied by delay or any other act or omission of
either party. No waiver by either party of any provision of this
Lease shall be deemed a waiver of such provision with respect to
any subsequent matter relating to such provision, and
Landlord’s consent or approval respecting any action by
Tenant shall not constitute a waiver of the requirement for
obtaining Landlord’s consent or approval respecting any
subsequent action. Acceptance of Rent by Landlord directly or
through any agent or lock-box arrangement shall not constitute a
waiver of any breach by Tenant of any term or provision of this
Lease (and Landlord reserves the right to return or refund any
untimely payments if necessary to preserve Landlord’s
remedies). No acceptance of a lesser amount of Rent shall be deemed
a waiver of Landlord’s right to receive the full amount due,
nor shall any endorsement or statement on any check or payment or
any letter accompanying such check or payment be deemed an accord
and satisfaction, and Landlord may accept such check or payment
without prejudice to Landlord’s right to recover the full
amount due. The acceptance of Rent or of the performance of any
other term or provision from, or providing directory listings or
services for, any person or entity other than Tenant shall not
constitute a waiver of Landlord’s right to approve any
Transfer. No delivery to, or acceptance by, Landlord or its agents
or employees of keys, nor any other act or omission of Tenant or
Landlord or their agents or employees, shall be deemed a surrender,
or acceptance of a surrender, of the Premises or a termination of
this Lease, unless stated expressly in writing by
Landlord.
SECTION
27: SAFETY AND SECURITY DEVICES, SERVICES AND
PROGRAMS
The
parties acknowledge that safety and security devices, services and
programs provided by Landlord, if any, while intended to deter
crime and ensure safety, may not in given instances prevent theft
or other criminal acts, or ensure safety of persons or property.
The risk that any safety or security device, service or program may
not be effective, or may malfunction, or be circumvented by a
criminal, is assumed by Tenant with respect to Tenant’s
property and interests, and Tenant shall obtain insurance coverage
to the extent Tenant desires protection against such criminal acts
and other losses. Tenant agrees to cooperate in any reasonable
safety or security program developed by Landlord or required by
Law.
SECTION
28: TELECOMMUNICATION LINES AND EQUIPMENT
A.
Telecommunication
Lines.
No telecommunication or computer lines (collectively,
“Lines”) shall be installed within or without the
Premises without Landlord’s prior consent in accordance with
Section 10. Landlord disclaims any representations, warranties or
understandings concerning Landlord’s Building computer
systems, or the capacity, design or suitability of Landlord’s
riser Lines, Landlord’s main distribution frame
(“MDF”) or related equipment. If there is, or will be,
more than one tenant on any floor, at any time, Landlord may
allocate, and periodically reallocate, connections to the terminal
block based on the proportion of square feet each tenant occupies
on such floor, or the type of business operations or requirements
of such tenants, in Landlord’s reasonable discretion.
Landlord may arrange for an independent contractor to review
Tenant’s requests for approval to install any
telecommunication or computer lines, monitor or supervise
Tenant’s installation, connection and disconnection of any
such lines, and provide other such services, or Landlord may
provide the same. In each case, all such work shall be performed in
accordance with Section 10 and the additional requirements set
forth below: (i) an acceptable number of spare Lines and space for
additional Lines shall be maintained for existing and future
occupants of the Project, as determined in Landlord’s
reasonable opinion; (ii) the Lines (including riser cables) shall
be appropriately insulated to prevent excessive electromagnetic
fields or radiation, shall be surrounded by a protective conduit
reasonably acceptable to Landlord, and shall be identified in
accordance with the “Identification Requirements,” as
that term is set forth below; (iii) any new or existing Lines
servicing the Premises shall comply with all applicable
governmental laws and regulations; (iv) as a condition to
permitting the installation of new Lines, Landlord may require that
Tenant remove existing Lines located in or serving the Premises and
repair any damage in connection with such removal; (v) Tenant shall
pay all costs in connection therewith; and (vi) all Lines shall be
clearly marked with adhesive plastic labels (or plastic tags
attached to such Lines with wire) to show Tenant’s name,
suite number, telephone number and the name of the person to
contact in the case of an emergency (A) every four feet (4’)
outside the Premises (specifically including, but not limited to,
the electrical room risers and other Common Areas), and (B) at the
Lines’ termination point(s) (collectively,
“Identification Requirements”). At the expiration or
earlier termination of this Lease, and at Landlord’s request,
Tenant at its cost shall remove all Lines or other computer or
telecommunication systems installed by or for Tenant and Tenant
shall restore the Premises and Building to the condition existing
prior to Tenant’s installation.
B.
Wi-Fi
Network
. In the event Tenant desires to install wireless
intranet, Internet and communications network (“Wi-Fi
Network”) in the Premises for the use by Tenant and its
employees, then the same shall be subject to the provisions of
Section 8 and Section 15. Tenant shall use the Wi-Fi Network so as
not to cause any interference to other tenants in the Building or
with any other tenant’s communication equipment, and not to
interfere with the normal operation of the Building. Should any
interference occur, Tenant shall take all necessary steps as soon
as reasonably possible and no later than three (3) calendar days
following such occurrence to correct such interference. If such
interference continues after such three (3) day period, Tenant
shall immediately cease operating such Wi-Fi Network until such
interference is corrected or remedied to Landlord’s
satisfaction. Tenant acknowledges that Landlord has granted and/or
may grant telecommunication rights to other tenants and occupants
of the Building and Property and to telecommunication service
providers and in no event shall Landlord be liable to Tenant for
any interference of the same with such Wi-Fi Network. Landlord
makes no representation that the Wi-Fi Network will be able to
receive or transmit communication signals without interference or
disturbance. Tenant shall (i) be solely responsible for any
damage caused as a result of the Wi-Fi Network, (ii) promptly
pay any tax, license or permit fees charged pursuant to any Laws in
connection with the installation, maintenance or use of the Wi-Fi
Network and comply with all precautions and safeguards recommended
by all governmental authorities, and (iii) pay for all
necessary repairs, replacements to or maintenance of the Wi-Fi
Network.
C.
Limitation
of Liability.
Unless due solely to Landlord’s
intentional misconduct or grossly negligent acts, Landlord shall
have no liability for damages arising, and Landlord does not
warrant that the Tenant’s use of any telecommunication or
computer lines or systems will be free, from the following
(collectively called “Line Problems”): (i) any
eavesdropping, wiretapping or theft of long distance access codes
by unauthorized parties, (ii) any failure of the Lines to satisfy
Tenant’s requirements, or (iii) any capacitance, attenuation,
cross talk or other problems with the Lines, any misdesignation of
the Lines in the MDF room or wire closets, or any shortages,
failures, variations, interruptions, disconnections, loss or damage
caused by or in connection with the installation, maintenance,
replacement, use or removal of any other Lines or equipment at the
Building or Property by or for other tenants at the Property or
Building, by any failure of the environmental conditions at or the
power supply for the Building to conform to any requirements of the
Lines or any other problems associated with any Lines or by any
other cause. Under no circumstances shall any Line Problems be
deemed an actual or constructive eviction of Tenant, render
Landlord liable to Tenant for abatement of any Rent or other
charges under the Lease, or relieve Tenant from performance of
Tenant’s obligations under the Lease as amended herein.
Landlord in no event shall be liable for any loss of profits,
business interruption or other consequential damage arising from
any Line Problems.
SECTION
29: HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES; DISRUPTIVE
ACTIVITIES
A.
Hazardous
Substances.
1.
Tenant shall not,
without Landlord’s prior written consent, which may be given
or withheld in Landlord’s sole discretion, keep on or around
the Premises, Building or Property, for use, disposal, treatment,
generation, storage or sale, any substances designed as, or
containing components designated as, a “hazardous
substance,” “hazardous material,” hazardous
waste,” “regulated substance” or “toxic
substance” by applicable Law (collectively referred to as
“Hazardous Substances”). With respect to any such
Hazardous Substances, Tenant shall: (i) comply promptly, timely and
completely with all Laws for reporting, keeping and submitting
manifests, and obtaining and keeping current identification
numbers; (ii) submit to Landlord true and correct copies of all
reports, manifests and identification numbers at the same time as
they are required to be and/or are submitted to the appropriate
governmental authorities; (iii) within five (5) days of
Landlord’s request, submit written reports to Landlord
regarding Tenant’s use, storage, treatment, transportation,
generation, disposal or sale of Hazardous Substances and provide
evidence satisfactory to Landlord of Tenant’s compliance with
all applicable Laws; (iv) allow Landlord or Landlord’s agent
or representative to come on the Premises at all times to check
Tenant’s compliance with all applicable Laws; (v) comply with
minimum levels, standards or other performance standards or
requirements which may be set forth or established for certain
Hazardous Substances (if minimum standards or levels are applicable
to Hazardous Substances present on the Premises, such levels or
standards shall be established by an on-site inspection by the
appropriate governmental authorities and shall be set forth in an
addendum to this Lease); and (vi) comply with all applicable Laws
regarding the proper and lawful use, sale, transportation,
generation, treatment and disposal of Hazardous
Substances.
2.
Any and all costs
incurred by Landlord and associated with Landlord’s
monitoring of Tenant’s compliance with this Section 29,
including Landlord’s attorneys’ fees and costs, shall
be additional Rent and shall be due and payable to Landlord
immediately upon demand by Landlord.
B.
Cleanup
Costs, Default and Indemnification.
1.
Tenant shall be
fully and completely liable to Landlord for any and all cleanup
costs, and any and all other charges, fees, penalties (civil and
criminal) imposed by any governmental authority with respect to
Tenant’s use, disposal, transportation, generation and/or
sale of Hazardous Substances, in or about the Premises, Building or
Property.
2.
Tenant shall fully
indemnify, defend and save Landlord and Landlord’s Lender, if
any, harmless from any and all of the costs, fees, penalties and
charges assessed against or imposed upon Landlord (as well as
Landlord’s and Landlord’s Lender’s
attorneys’ fees and costs) as a result of Tenant’s use,
disposal, transportation, generation and/or sale of Hazardous
Substances.
3.
Upon Tenant’s
default under this Section 29, in addition to the rights and
remedies set forth elsewhere in this Lease, Landlord shall be
entitled to the following rights and remedies: (i) at
Landlord’s option, to terminate this lease immediately;
and/or (ii) to recover any and all damages associated with the
default, including, but not limited to cleanup costs and charges,
civil and criminal penalties and fees, loss of business and sales
by Landlord and other tenants of the Building or Property, any and
all damages and claims asserted by third parties and
Landlord’s attorney’s fees and costs.
C.
Disruptive
Activities.
Tenant shall not: (1) produce, or permit to be
produced, any intense glare, light or heat except within an
enclosed or screened area and then only in such manner that the
glare, light or heat shall not, outside the Premises, be materially
different than the light or heat from other sources outside the
Premises; (2) create, or permit to be created, any sound pressure
level which will interfere with the quiet enjoyment of any real
property outside the Premises, or which will create a nuisance or
violate any Law; (3) create, or permit to be created, any floor or
ground vibration that is materially discernible outside the
Premises; (4) transmit, receive, or permit to be transmitted or
received, any electromagnetic, microwave or other radiation which
is harmful or hazardous to any person or property in or about the
Premises, Building or Property; or (5) create, or permit to be
created, any noxious odor that is disruptive to the business
operations of any other tenant in the Building or
Property.
SECTION
30: DISABILITIES ACTS
The
parties acknowledge that the Americans With Disabilities Act of
1990 (42 U.S.C. § 12101 et seq.) and regulations and
guidelines promulgated thereunder (“ADA”), and any
similarly motivated state and local Laws, as the same may be
amended and supplemented from time to time (collectively referred
to herein as the “Disabilities Acts”) establish
requirements for business operations, accessibility and barrier
removal, and that such requirements may or may not apply to the
Premises, Building and Property depending on, among other things:
(i) whether Tenant’s business is deemed a “public
accommodation” or “commercial facility”, (ii)
whether such requirements are “readily achievable”, and
(iii) whether a given alteration affects a “primary function
area” or triggers “path of travel” requirements.
The parties hereby agree that: (a) Landlord shall perform any
required Disabilities Acts compliance in the Common Areas, except
as provided below, (b) Tenant shall perform any required
Disabilities Acts compliance in the Premises, and (c) Landlord may
perform, or require that Tenant perform, and Tenant shall be
responsible for the cost of, Disabilities Acts “path of
travel” and other requirements triggered by any public
accommodation or other use of, or alterations in, the Premises by
Tenant. Tenant shall be responsible for Disabilities Acts
requirements relating to Tenant’s employees, and Landlord
shall be responsible for Disabilities Acts requirements relating to
Landlord’s employees.
SECTION
31: DEFINITIONS
(A)
“Building”
shall mean the structure (or the portion thereof operated by
Landlord) identified in Section 1 within which the Premises are
located.
(B)
“Common
Areas” shall mean the lobbies, walkways, elevators and other
portions of the Property which are provided by Landlord, from time
to time, for use in common by Landlord, Tenant and any other
tenants of the Building.
(C)
“Default
Rate” shall mean eighteen percent (18%) per annum, or the
highest rate permitted by applicable Law, whichever shall be
less.
(D)
“Holidays”
shall mean all federal holidays, and holidays observed by the State
of Washington, including New Year’s Day, President’s
Day, Memorial Day, Independence Day, Labor Day, Veterans’
Day, Thanksgiving Day, Christmas Day, and to the extent of
utilities or services provided by union members engaged at the
Property, such other holidays observed by such unions.
(E)
“Landlord”
shall mean only the landlord from time to time, except for purposes
of any provisions defending, indemnifying and holding Landlord
harmless hereunder, “Landlord” shall include past,
present and future landlords and their respective partners,
beneficiaries, trustees, officers, directors, employees,
shareholders, principals, agents, affiliates, successors and
assigns.
(F)
“Law”
or “Laws” shall mean all federal, state, county and
local governmental and municipal laws (including without limitation
Disabilities Acts), statutes, ordinances, rules, regulations,
codes, decrees, orders and other such requirements, applicable
equitable remedies and decisions by courts in cases where such
decisions are considered binding precedents in the State of
Washington, and decisions of federal courts applying the Laws of
such State, at the time in question. This Lease shall be
interpreted and governed by the Laws of the State of
Washington.
(G)
“Lender”
shall mean the holder of any Mortgage at the time in question, and
where such Mortgage is a ground lease, such term shall refer to the
ground Landlord (and the term “ground lease” although
not separately capitalized is intended throughout this Lease to
include any superior or master lease).
(H)
“Mortgage”
shall mean all mortgages, deeds of trust, ground leases and other
such encumbrances now or hereafter placed upon the Property,
Building or Premises, or any part thereof or interest therein, and
all renewals, modifications, consolidations, replacements or
extensions thereof, and all indebtedness now or hereafter secured
thereby and all interest thereon.
(I)
“Normal
Business Hours” shall mean 8:00 a.m. to 6:00 p.m. Monday
through Friday
.
(J) “Premises”
shall mean the area within the Building identified in Section 1 and
Exhibit B. Possession of areas necessary for utilities, services,
safety and operation of the Building, including the Systems and
Equipment, fire stairways, perimeter walls, space between the
finished ceiling of the Premises and the slab of the floor or roof
of the Building thereabove, and the use thereof together with the
right to install, maintain, operate, repair and replace the Systems
and Equipment, including any of the same in, through, under or
above the Premises in locations that will not materially interfere
with Tenant’s use of the Premises, are hereby excepted and
reserved by Landlord, and not demised to Tenant.
(K)
“Property”
shall mean the real property legally described in Exhibit A of this
Lease together with all landscaping, improvements and personal
property located thereon and related to the Building or its
operation or maintenance.
(L)
“Rent”
shall have the meaning specified therefor in Section
4.
(M)
“Systems and
Equipment” shall mean any plant, machinery, transformers,
duct work, cable, wires, and other equipment, facilities, and
systems designed to supply light, heat, ventilation, air
conditioning and humidity, or any other services or utilities, or
comprising or serving as any component or portion of the
electrical, gas, steam, plumbing, sprinkler, communications, alarm,
security, or fire/life/safety systems or equipment, or any
elevators, escalators or other mechanical, electrical, electronic,
computer or other systems or equipment for the Building, except to
the extent that any of the same serves particular tenants
exclusively (and “systems and equipment” without
capitalization shall refer to such of the foregoing items serving
particular tenants exclusively).
(N)
“Tenant”
shall be applicable to one or more persons or entities as the case
may be, the singular shall include the plural, and if there be more
than one Tenant, the obligations thereof shall be joint and
several. When used in the lower case, “tenant” shall
mean any other tenant, subtenant or occupant of the Building or
Property.
(O)
“Tenant’s
Share” of Expenses and Taxes pursuant to Section 4 shall be
the percentage set forth in Section 1, but if the rentable area of
the Premises or Building shall change, Tenant’s Share shall
thereupon become the rentable area of the Premises divided by the
rentable area of the Building, excluding any parking facilities,
subject at all times to adjustment under Section 4. Tenant
acknowledges that the “rentable area of the Premises”
under this Lease includes the usable area, without deduction for
columns or projections, multiplied by a load or conversion factor,
to reflect a share of certain areas, which may include lobbies,
corridors, mechanical, utility, janitorial, boiler and service
rooms and closets, restrooms, and other public, common and service
areas, all as reasonably determined by Landlord. Except as provided
expressly to the contrary herein, the “rentable area of the
Building” shall include all rentable area of all space leased
or available for lease at the Building, which Landlord may
reasonably re determine from time to time, to reflect re
configurations, additions or modifications to the
Building.
SECTION
32: OFFER
The
submission and negotiation of this Lease shall not be deemed an
offer to enter the same by Landlord (nor an option or reservation
for the Premises), but the solicitation of such an offer by Tenant.
Tenant agrees that its execution of this Lease constitutes a firm
offer to enter the same which may not be withdrawn for a period of
thirty (30) days after delivery to Landlord. During such period and
in reliance on the foregoing, Landlord may, at Landlord’s
option, deposit any Security Deposit and Rent, proceed with any
plans, specifications, alterations or improvements, and permit
Tenant to enter the Premises, but such acts shall not be deemed an
acceptance of Tenant’s offer to enter this Lease, and such
acceptance shall be evidenced only by Landlord signing and
delivering this Lease to Tenant.
SECTION
33: MISCELLANEOUS
A.
Captions
and Interpretation.
The captions of the Sections of this
Lease are for convenience of reference only and shall not be
considered or referred to in resolving questions of interpretation.
Tenant acknowledges that it has read this Lease and that it has had
the opportunity to confer with counsel in negotiating this Lease;
accordingly, this Lease shall be construed neither for nor against
Landlord or Tenant, but shall be given a fair and reasonable
interpretation in accordance with the meaning of its terms. The
neuter shall include the masculine and feminine, and the singular
shall include the plural. The term “including” shall be
interpreted to mean “including, but not limited
to.”
B.
Survival
of Provisions.
All obligations (including indemnity, Rent
and other payment obligations) or rights of either party arising
during or attributable to the period prior to expiration or earlier
termination of this Lease shall survive such expiration or earlier
termination.
C.
Severability.
If any term or provision of this Lease or portion thereof shall be
found invalid, void, illegal, or unenforceable generally or with
respect to any particular party, by a court of competent
jurisdiction, it shall not affect, impair or invalidate any other
terms or provisions or the remaining portion thereof, or its
enforceability with respect to any other party.
D.
Short
Form Lease.
Neither this Lease nor any memorandum of lease
or short form lease shall be recorded by Tenant, but Landlord or
any Lender may elect to record a short form of this Lease, in which
case Tenant shall promptly execute, acknowledge and deliver the
same on a form prepared by Landlord or such Lender.
E.
Light,
Air and Other Interests.
This Lease does not grant any legal
rights to “light and air” outside the Premises nor any
particular view visible from the Premises, nor any easements,
licenses or other interests unless expressly contained in this
Lease.
F.
Authority.
If Tenant is any form of corporation, partnership, limited
liability company or partnership, association or other
organization, Tenant and all persons signing for Tenant below
hereby represent that this Lease has been fully authorized and no
further approvals are required, and Tenant is duly organized, in
good standing and legally qualified to do business in the Premises
(and has any required certificates, licenses, permits and other
such items).
G.
Joint
and Several.
If there is more than one Tenant, the
obligations imposed upon Tenant under this Lease shall be joint and
several. In the event that the Tenant is a married individual, the
terms, covenants and conditions of this Lease shall be binding upon
the marital community of which the Tenant is a member.
H.
Financial
Statements.
Tenant shall, within ten (10) days after
requested from time to time, deliver to Landlord financial
statements (including balance sheets and income/expense statements)
for Tenant’s then most recent full and partial fiscal year
preceding such request, certified by an independent certified
public accountant or Tenant’s chief financial officer, in
form reasonably satisfactory to Landlord.
I.
Successors
and Assigns; Transfer of Property and Security Deposit.
Each
of the terms and provisions of this Lease shall be binding upon and
inure to the benefit of the parties’ respective heirs,
executors, administrators, guardians, custodians, successors and
assigns, subject to Section 14 respecting Transfers and Section 17
respecting rights of Lenders. Subject to Section 17, if Landlord
shall convey or transfer the Property or any portion thereof in
which the Premises are contained to another party, such party shall
thereupon be and become landlord hereunder and shall be deemed to
have fully assumed all of Landlord’s obligations under this
Lease accruing during such party’s ownership, including the
return of any Security Deposit (provided Landlord shall have turned
over such Security Deposit to such party), and Landlord shall be
free of all such obligations accruing from and after the date of
conveyance or transfer.
J.
Rent
and Taxes.
In addition to the provisions of Section 15, all
Rent due Landlord herein is exclusive of any sales, business and
occupational gross receipts or tax based on rents or tax upon this
Lease or tax measured by the number of employees of Tenant or the
area of the Premises or any similar tax or charge. If any such tax
or charge be hereafter enacted, Tenant shall reimburse to Landlord
the amount thereof with each monthly Base Rent payment. If it shall
not be lawful for Tenant to so reimburse Landlord, the monthly Base
Rent payable to Landlord under this Lease shall be revised to net
Landlord the same net rental after imposition of any such tax or
charge upon Landlord as would have been payable to Landlord prior
to the imposition of such tax or charge. Tenant shall not be liable
to reimburse Landlord any federal income tax or other income tax of
a general nature applicable to Landlord’s
income.
K.
Limitation
of Landlord’s Liability.
Tenant agrees to look solely
to Landlord’s interest in the Building for the enforcement of
any judgment, award, order or other remedy under or in connection
with this Lease or any related agreement, instrument or document or
for any other matter whatsoever relating thereto or to the Building
or Premises. Under no circumstances shall any present or future,
direct or indirect, principals or investors, general or limited
partners, officers, directors, shareholders, trustees,
beneficiaries, participants, advisors, managers, employees, agents
or affiliates of Landlord, or of any of the other foregoing
parties, or any of their heirs, successors or assigns have any
liability for any of the foregoing matters.
L.
Signage.
Landlord agrees to provide Tenant, at Landlord’s sole cost,
Building standard signage on the lobby directory board and the
principal floor where the Premises are located in a manner
consistent with other tenants in the Building.
M.
Building
Renovations.
It
is specifically understood and
agreed that Landlord has no obligation and has made no promises to
alter, remodel, improve, renovate, repair or decorate the Premises,
Building, or any part thereof and that no representations
respecting the condition of the Premises or the Building have been
made by Landlord to Tenant except as specifically set forth herein
or in the Work Letter. However, Tenant hereby acknowledges that
Landlord is currently renovating or may during the Lease Term
renovate, improve, alter, or modify the Project, the Building
and/or the Premises (collectively, “Renovations”).
Except as specifically provided in this Lease, Tenant hereby agrees
that such Renovations shall in no way constitute a constructive
eviction of Tenant nor entitle Tenant to any abatement of Rent.
Landlord shall have no responsibility and shall not be liable to
Tenant for any injury to or interference with Tenant’s
business arising from the Renovations, nor shall Tenant be entitled
to any compensation or damages from Landlord for loss of the use of
the whole or any part of the Premises or of Tenant’s personal
property or improvements resulting from the Renovations, or for any
inconvenience or annoyance occasioned by such Renovations.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, Landlord shall use commercially
reasonable efforts to perform all Renovations in a manner, whenever
reasonably possible, to minimize any material, adverse or
unreasonable interference with Tenant’s use of or access to
the Premises.
N.
Force
Majeure.
Any prevention, delay or stoppage due to strikes,
lockouts, labor disputes, acts of God, acts of war, terrorist acts,
inability to obtain services, labor, or materials or reasonable
substitutes therefor, governmental actions, civil commotions, fire
or other casualty, and other causes beyond the reasonable control
of the party obligated to perform, except with respect to the
obligations imposed with regard to Rent and other charges to be
paid by Tenant pursuant to this Lease (collectively, a “Force
Majeure”),
notwithstanding anything to the
contrary contained in this Lease, shall excuse the performance of
such party for a period equal to any such prevention, delay or
stoppage and, therefore, if this Lease specifies a time period for
performance of an obligation of either party, that time period
shall be extended by the period of any delay in such party’s
performance caused by a Force Majeure.
O.
Patriot
Act.
Tenant represents, warrants and covenants that Tenant
(i) is not listed on the Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked
Persons List maintained by the Office of Foreign Asset Control,
Department of the Treasury (“OFAC”) pursuant to
Executive Order No. 13224, 66 Fed. Reg. 49079 (Sept. 25,
2001)(“Order”) and all applicable provisions of Title
III of the USA Patriot Act (Public Law No. 107-56 (October 26,
2001)); (ii) is not listed on the Denied Persons List and Entity
List maintained by the United States Department of Commerce; (iii)
is not listed on the List of Terrorists and List of Disbarred
Parties maintained by the United States Department of State; (iv)
is not listed on any list or qualification of “Designated
Nationals” as defined in the Cuban Assets Control Regulations
31 C.F.R. Part 515; (v) is not listed on any other publicly
available list of terrorists, terrorist organizations or narcotics
traffickers maintained by the United States Department of State,
the United States Department of Commerce or any other governmental
authority or pursuant to the Order, the rules and regulations of
OFAC, or any other applicable requirements contained in any
enabling legislation or other Executive Orders in respect of the
Order (the Order and such other rules, regulations, legislation or
orders are collectively called the “Orders”); (vi) is
not engaged in activities prohibited in the Orders; and (vii) has
not been convicted, pleaded nolo contendere, indicted, arraigned or
custodially detained on charges involving money laundering or
predicate crimes to money laundering, drug trafficking,
terrorist-related activities or other money laundering predicate
crimes or in connection with the Bank Secrecy Act (31 U.S.C.
§§ 5311 et. seq.).
P.
REIT
.
Landlord and Tenant hereby agree that it is their intent that all
Rent due under this Lease shall qualify as “rents from real
property” within the meaning of Sections 512(b)(3) and 856(d)
of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
(“Code”), and the U.S. Department of the Treasury
Regulations promulgated thereunder (“Regulations”). In
the event that (i) the Code or the Regulations, or interpretations
thereof by the Internal Revenue Service contained in revenue
rulings or other similar public pronouncements, shall be changed so
that any Rent no longer so qualifies as “rent from real
property” for purposes of either said Section 512(b)(3) or
Section 856(d) or (ii) Landlord, in its sole discretion, determines
that there is any risk that all or part of any Rent shall not
qualify as “rents from real property” for the purposes
of either said Sections 512(b)(3) or 856(d),
Tenant agrees to cooperate with Landlord
and enter
into such amendment or amendments to this Lease as
Landlord deems necessary to qualify all Rent as
“rents from real property,” provided,
however, that
(A)
any
amendment
required under this Section shall be made so as to
produce, to the extent possible, the equivalent (in economic terms)
Rent as payable before the
amendment, and (B) in the event that Landlord
determines that an amendment cannot produce economically equivalent
Rent as described in clause (A), the Rent payable under any such
amendment shall not be any less favorable to Tenant than the Rent
payable under this Lease immediately prior to such
amendment.
Additionally, no
Rent payable under this Lease may be attributable to personal
property unless (i) such personal property is leased under, or in
connection with, the lease of real property hereunder, and (ii) the
Rent attributable to the personal property for each taxable year
does not exceed 15% of the total Rent for the taxable year
attributable to both the real and personal property leased under or
in connection with this Lease. The parties agree to execute such
further commercially reasonable instrument as may reasonably be
required by Landlord in order to give effect to the foregoing
provisions of this Section.
Q.
Applicable
Law and Other Matters.
This Lease shall be interpreted and
construed under and pursuant to the laws of the State of
Washington. Any action regarding or arising from this Lease shall
be brought in the Washington State Superior or Federal District
Courts located in the county where the Property is located. Time is
of the essence of this Lease. In the event an attorney is engaged
by either party to enforce the terms of this Lease or in the event
suit is brought relating to or arising from this Lease, the
prevailing party shall be entitled to recover from the other party
its reasonable attorneys’ fees and costs. Landlord and Tenant
hereby waive trial by jury in any action, proceeding or
counterclaim brought by either party against the other on any
matters whatsoever arising out of this Lease, or any other
claims.
R.
Confidentiality.
Tenant shall keep the content and all copies of this Lease, related
documents or amendments now or hereafter entered, and all
proposals, materials, information and matters relating thereto
strictly confidential, and shall not disclose, disseminate or
distribute any of the same, or permit the same to occur, except to
the extent reasonably required for proper business purposes by
Tenant’s employees, attorneys, insurers, auditors, lenders
and Transferees (and Tenant shall obligate any such parties to whom
disclosure is permitted to honor the confidentiality provisions
hereof), and except as may be required by Law or court
proceedings.
S.
Counterparts.
This Lease may be executed in counterparts with the same effect as
if both parties hereto had executed the same document. Both
counterparts shall be construed together and shall constitute a
single lease.
SECTION
34: ENTIRE AGREEMENT
This
Lease, together with the Riders, Exhibits and other documents
listed in Section 1 (which collectively are hereby incorporated
where referred to herein and made a part hereof as though fully set
forth), contains all the terms and provisions between Landlord and
Tenant relating to the matters set forth herein and no prior or
contemporaneous agreement or understanding pertaining to the same
shall be of any force or effect, except any such contemporaneous
agreement specifically referring to and modifying this Lease,
signed by both parties. Neither this Lease, nor any Riders or
Exhibits referred to above may be modified, except in writing
signed by both parties.
[THE
REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]
IN
WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Lease as of the
date first set forth above.
LANDLORD:
|
LOGAN BUILDING LLC,
|
|
a Delaware limited liability company
|
|
|
|
By:
|
Unico Boutique Office Portfolio LP, a Delaware limited partnership,
Manager
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
Unico Boutique Office Portfolio GP LLC, a Delaware limited
liability company, General Partner
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
Unico Investment Group LLC, a Delaware limited liability company,
Member
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/ Andrew Cox
|
|
|
|
|
Name:
|
Andrew Cox
|
|
|
|
|
Title:
|
VP
|
TENANT:
|
VISUALANT INCORPORATED,
|
|
|
a Nevada corporation
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/
Ron
Erickson
|
|
|
Name:
|
Ron Erickson
|
|
|
Title:
|
CEO
|
|
LANDLORD ACKNOWLEDGMENT
STATE OF WASHINGTON
|
)
|
|
|
) ss.
|
COUNTY OF KING
|
)
|
|
I
certify that I know or have satisfactory evidence that
__________________________ is the person who appeared before me,
and said person acknowledged that said person signed this
instrument, on oath stated that said person was authorized to
execute the instrument and acknowledged it as the
_____________________________ of Unico Investment Group LLC, a
Delaware limited liability company, the Member of Unico Boutique
Office Portfolio GP LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, the
General Partner of Unico Boutique Office Portfolio LP, a Delaware
limited partnership, the Manager of LOGAN BUILDING LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company, to be the free and voluntary act of such
party for the uses and purposes mentioned in the
instrument.
DATED
this ______ day of ____________________, 2016.
NOTARY PUBLIC in and for the State of Washington, residing at
__________________
|
|
Name (printed or typed)
|
My appointment expires: ___________________
|
TENANT ACKNOWLEDGMENT
STATE OF ______________
|
)
|
|
|
) ss.
|
COUNTY OF ____________
|
)
|
|
I
certify that I know or have satisfactory evidence that
__________________________ is the person who appeared before me,
and said person acknowledged that he/she signed this instrument, on
oath stated that he/she was authorized to execute the instrument
and acknowledged it as the _____________________________ of
VISUALANT INCORPORATED, a Nevada corporation, to be the free and
voluntary act of such party for the uses and purposes mentioned in
the instrument.
DATED
this ______ day of ____________________, 2016.
NOTARY PUBLIC in and for the State
of
, residing at __________________
|
|
Name (printed or typed)
|
My appointment expires: ___________________
|
EXHIBIT A
(Legal Description of Property)
LOTS 9
AND 12, BLOCK 17, ADDITION TO THE TOWN OF SEATTLE AS LAID OUT BY A.
A. DENNY (COMMONLY KNOWN AS A. A. DENNY'S 3RD ADDITION TO THE CITY
OF SEATTLE), ACCORDING TO THE PLAT THEREOF, RECORDED IN VOLUME 1 OF
PLATS, PAGE(S) 33, IN KING COUNTY, WASHINGTON;
EXCEPT
THE SOUTHERLY 5 FEET IN WIDTH OF SAID LOT 12 CONDEMNED IN KING
COUNTY SUPERIOR COURT CAUSE NUMBER 82589 FOR WIDENING OF UNION
STREET, AS PROVIDED BY ORDINANCE NUMBER 18188 OF THE CITY OF
SEATTLE;
TOGETHER
WITH THOSE EASEMENT RIGHTS APPURTENANT TO SAID PREMISES CONTAINED
IN BUILDING AGREEMENT RECORDED UNDER RECORDING NUMBER
8704210116.
THE
ABOVE ALSO BEING DESCRIBED AS FOLLOWS:
COMMENCING
AT THE MOST SOUTHERLY CORNER OF SAID LOT 12;
THENCE
NORTH 30°38'10" WEST 5.00 FEET TO THE POINT OF
BEGINNING;
THENCE
CONTINUING NORTH 30°38'10" WEST 114.92 FEET TO THE MOST
WESTERLY CORNER OF LOT 9;
THENCE
NORTH 59°22'16" EAST 119.97 FEET TO THE MOST NORTHERLY CORNER
OF LOT 9;
THENCE
SOUTH 30°37'36" EAST 114.90 FEET TO THE MOST NORTHWESTERLY
MARGIN OF UNION STREET;
THENCE
SOUTH 59°21'23" WEST 119.95 FEET TO THE POINT OF
BEGINNING;
SITUATE
IN THE CITY OF SEATTLE, COUNTY OF KING, STATE OF
WASHINGTON.
EXHIBIT B
(Floor Plate Showing Premises)
EXHIBIT C
(Work Letter)
This
Work Letter sets forth the terms and conditions relating to the
construction of improvements for the Premises.
SECTION 1
LANDLORD’S OBLIGATIONS
Except
for disbursement of the Tenant Improvement Allowance set forth
below or as otherwise set forth in the Lease, Landlord shall not be
obligated to make or pay for any alterations or improvements to the
Premises, the Building or the Project, except that Landlord will
demolish one wall, and provide a new ceiling and new PIU’s,
all of which shall be at Landlord’s sole cost and
expense.
SECTION 2
TENANT IMPROVEMENTS
2.1
Tenant
Improvement Allowance; Space Planning Allowance
. Subject to
the terms and conditions contained herein, Tenant shall be entitled
to a one-time tenant improvement allowance (the “
Tenant Improvement Allowance
”) in
the amount of $23,575.00 (i.e., $25.00 per rentable square foot)
for the costs relating to the initial design and construction of
Tenant’s improvements (the “
Tenant
Improvements
”), as further
described in Section 2.2.1 below. In no event shall Landlord be
obligated to make disbursements pursuant to this Work Letter in a
total amount which exceeds the Tenant Improvement Allowance.
Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary contained herein, to
the extent any portion of the Tenant Improvement Allowance is
unused by Tenant as of the date which is the first
anniversary of
the Lease Commencement Date (the “
Outside Date
”), then the remaining
balance thereof shall revert to Landlord, and Tenant shall have no
right to use such amount for any remaining improvements or
alterations, nor as a Rent credit or cash allowance.
2.2
Disbursement
of the Tenant Improvement Allowance
.
2.2.1
Tenant
Improvement Allowance Items
. Except as otherwise set forth
in this Work Letter, the Tenant Improvement Allowance shall be
disbursed by Landlord only for the following items and costs
(collectively the “
Tenant
Improvement Allowance Items
”):
2.2.1.1 Payment
of the fees of the Architect (and any other architects retained by
Tenant, or by Architect) and the Engineers, as those terms are
defined in Section 3.1 of this Work Letter, and payment of the fees
of other professional services provided to Tenant in the design and
construction of the Tenant Improvements, and payment of the actual
and reasonable third party fees incurred by, and the cost of
documents and materials supplied by, Landlord and Landlord’s
consultants in connection with the preparation and review of the
“
Construction
Drawings
,” as that term is defined in Section 3.1 of
this Work Letter;
2.2.1.2 The
payment of plan check, permit and license fees relating to
construction of the Tenant Improvements;
2.2.1.3 The
cost of construction of the Tenant Improvements, including, without
limitation, testing and inspection costs, freight elevator usage,
hoisting and trash removal costs, and contractors’ fees and
general conditions;
2.2.1.4
The cost of any changes in the existing Building structure,
capacities or systems (“
Base
Building
”) when such changes are required by the
Construction Drawings (including, without limitation, if such
changes are due to the fact that such work is prepared on an
unoccupied basis), such cost to include all direct architectural
and/or engineering fees and expenses incurred in connection
therewith;
2.2.1.5 The
cost of any changes to the Construction Drawings or Tenant
Improvements required by all applicable building codes (the
“
Code
”);
2.2.1.6 Sales
and use taxes;
2.2.1.7
A construction supervision fee payable to Unico Properties LLC
(Landlord’s property manager) equal to 4.0% of the Final
Costs (as defined below) of the Tenant Improvements;
and
2.2.1.8 Any
other out-of-pocket costs expended by Landlord in payment of cost
items included in the Final Costs (as defined in Section 4.2.1
below) as agreed by Tenant, or as a result of Tenant’s
failure to perform its obligations in connection with the
construction of the Tenant Improvements.
2.2.2
Disbursement
of Tenant Improvement Allowance.
Upon written request from
Tenant, Landlord shall disburse the Tenant Improvement Allowance
(or the remaining portion thereof after disbursement to third
parties for any Tenant Improvement Allowance Items) to Tenant
within thirty (30) days after Tenant has opened for business,
completed construction of the Tenant Improvements, and delivered to
Landlord the following:
2.2.2.1
A detailed Final Costs statement showing the actual total costs of
construction of the Tenant Improvements;
2.2.2.2
A complete list of the names, addresses, telephone numbers and
contract amounts for all Tenant's contractor, subcontractors,
vendors and/or suppliers of labor and/or materials for Tenant's
Work providing work, services and/or material in excess of
$5,000.00 (“Major Contractors”);
2.2.2.3
All mechanics' lien releases or other lien releases on account of
Tenant's Work from Major Contractors, which are notarized,
unconditional and in recordable form or in such form as Landlord
shall have approved;
2.2.2.4
Copies of all building permits, indicating inspection and approval
of the Premises by the issuer of said permits;
2.2.2.5
An architect's certification that the Premises have been
constructed in accordance with the Approved Working Drawings
(defined below); and
2.2.2.6
(i) Final unconditional waivers of liens, contractors'
affidavits, and architects' certificates in such form as may be
required by Landlord and Landlord's title insurance company from
all parties performing labor or supplying materials or services in
connection with the Tenant Improvements showing that all of said
parties have been compensated in full and waiving all liens, to the
extent not already waived as provided above; (ii) a
certificate of occupancy or equivalent as required to occupy the
Premises; (iii) "as built" drawings and other final
documentation; and (iv) a detailed breakdown of Tenant's total
construction costs. The “as built” drawings and other
final documentation shall include the following:
●
Electrical sub
letter confirming electrical panels updated with all
circuits
●
Electrical phase
balance reports
●
Updated fire alarm
points list
●
As – built
drawings in ACAD and PDF
●
O&M manuals
inclusive of all submittals and finishes
●
Warranties of
Contractor and subcontractors
●
AutoCAD files in an
AIA standard layering system, and pdf disk set via e-mail of
architectural and MEP
●
As built controls
instruction and sequence of operation
●
Fan, pump, and
balancing valve curves
●
Updated valve
schedules
●
Valve schedule
indicating valve tag number, location by room number, valve purpose
and size, indicate damper locations and purpose. This information
to be included for the following systems: 1. Refrigerant system 2.
HVAC system 3. Exhaust system 4. Plumbing and HVAC piping systems
5. Temperature control system 6. Any other system installed but not
listed above.
In no
event shall the portion of the Tenant Improvement Allowance
disbursed directly to Tenant exceed the actual out-of-pocket costs
incurred by Tenant for construction of the Tenant
Improvements.
SECTION 3
CONSTRUCTION DRAWINGS
3.1
Selection
of Architect/Construction Drawings
. Tenant shall retain an
architect/space planner reasonably approved by Landlord (the
“
Architect
”) to
prepare the “
Construction
Drawings
,” as that term is defined in this Section
3.1. Tenant shall retain engineering consultants approved by
Landlord (the “
Engineers
”) to prepare all plans
and engineering working drawings relating to the structural,
mechanical, electrical, plumbing, HVAC, life safety, and sprinkler
work in the Premises, which work is not part of the Base Building.
Landlord’s approval of the Engineers shall not be
unreasonably withheld and Landlord shall be deemed to have approved
the Engineers proposed by Tenant if Landlord does not provide
written notice of disapproval within five (5) business days after
Tenant’s written request for approval. The plans and drawings
to be prepared by Architect and the Engineers hereunder shall be
known collectively as the “
Construction
Drawings
.” All Construction
Drawings shall be subject to Landlord’s approval, which shall
not be unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed. Tenant and
Architect shall verify, in the field, the dimensions and conditions
as shown on the relevant portions of the Base Building plans, and
Tenant and Architect shall be solely responsible for the same, and
Landlord shall have no responsibility in connection therewith.
Landlord’s review of the Construction Drawings as set forth
in this Section 3, shall be for its sole purpose and shall not
imply Landlord’s review of the same, or obligate Landlord to
review the same, for quality, design, Code compliance or other like
matters. Accordingly, notwithstanding that any Construction
Drawings are reviewed by Landlord or its space planner, architect,
engineers and consultants, and notwithstanding any advice or
assistance which may be rendered to Tenant by Landlord or
Landlord’s space planner, architect, engineers, and
consultants, Landlord shall have no liability whatsoever in
connection therewith and shall not be responsible for any omissions
or errors contained in the Construction Drawings, and
Tenant’s waiver and indemnity set forth in this Lease shall
specifically apply to the Construction Drawings.
3.2
Final
Space Plan
. Tenant shall supply Landlord with four (4)
copies signed by Tenant of its final space plan for the Premises
before any architectural working drawings or engineering drawings
have been commenced. The final space plan (the “
Final
Space Plan
”) shall include a
layout and designation of all offices, rooms and other
partitioning, their intended use, and equipment to be contained
therein, as well as the storefront and façade of the Premises.
Landlord may request clarification or more specific drawings for
special use items not included in the Final Space Plan. Landlord
shall advise Tenant within five (5) business days after
Landlord’s receipt of the Final Space Plan for the Premises
if the same is unsatisfactory or incomplete in any respect. If
Tenant is so advised, Tenant shall promptly cause the Final Space
Plan to be revised to correct any deficiencies or other matters
Landlord may reasonably require. Notwithstanding anything to the
contrary in this Section 3.2, Landlord shall not unreasonably
withhold, condition or delay its approval of the Final Space Plan;
provided, however, that to the extent that such Final Space Plan
may (i) affect the exterior of the Building, (ii) adversely affect
the structural portions of the Building, (iii) adversely affect the
Building systems and equipment, (iv) unreasonably interfere with
any other occupant’s normal and customary office operation,
(v) fail to comply with Applicable Laws, or (vi) fail to meet or
exceed the Specifications, then Landlord may grant or withhold its
approval of such Final Space Plan in its sole
discretion.
3.3
Final
Working Drawings
. After the Final Space Plan has been
approved by Landlord, Tenant shall supply the Engineers with a
complete listing of standard and non-standard equipment and
specifications, including, without limitation, B.T.U. calculations,
electrical requirements and special electrical receptacle
requirements for the Premises, to enable the Engineers and the
Architect to complete the “
Final Working Drawings
” (as that
term is defined below) in the manner as set forth below. Upon the
approval of the Final Space Plan by Landlord and Tenant, Tenant
shall promptly cause the Architect and the Engineers to complete
the architectural and engineering drawings for the Premises, and
Architect shall compile a fully coordinated set of architectural,
structural, mechanical, electrical and plumbing working drawings in
a form which is complete to allow subcontractors to bid on the work
and to obtain all applicable permits (collectively, the
“
Final Working
Drawings
”) and shall submit the same to Landlord for
Landlord’s approval. Tenant shall supply Landlord with four
(4) copies signed by Tenant of such Final Working Drawings.
Landlord shall advise Tenant within five (5) business days after
Landlord’s receipt of the Final Working Drawings for the
Premises if the same is unsatisfactory or incomplete in any
respect. If Tenant is so advised, Tenant shall immediately revise
the Final Working Drawings in accordance with such review and any
disapproval of Landlord in connection therewith and resubmit them
to Landlord. Landlord shall advise Tenant within five (5) business
days after Landlord’s receipt of any revised Final Working
Drawings for the Premises if the same is unsatisfactory or
incomplete in any respect. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary
in this Section 3.3, Landlord shall not unreasonably withhold,
condition or delay its approval of the Final Working Drawings;
provided, however, that to the extent that such Final Working
Drawings may (i) affect the exterior appearance of the Building,
(ii) adversely affect the structural portions of the Building,
(iii) adversely affect the Building systems and equipment, (iv)
unreasonably interfere with any other occupant’s normal and
customary office operation, (v) fail to comply with Applicable
Laws, or (vi) fail to meet or exceed the Specifications, then
Landlord may grant or withhold its approval of such Final Working
Drawings in its sole discretion. Once approved by Landlord, the
Final Working Drawings are the “
Approved Working
Drawings
”.
3.4
Approved
Working Drawings
. After approval by Landlord of the Final
Working Drawings, Tenant may submit the same to the appropriate
municipal authorities for all applicable building permits. Tenant
hereby agrees that neither Landlord nor Landlord’s
consultants shall be responsible for obtaining any building permit
or certificate of occupancy for the Premises and that obtaining the
same shall be Tenant’s responsibility; provided, however,
that Landlord shall timely cooperate with Tenant in executing
permit applications and performing other ministerial acts
reasonably necessary to enable Tenant to obtain any such permit or
certificate of occupancy. No changes, modifications or alterations
in the Approved Working Drawings may be made without the prior
written consent of Landlord, which consent may not be unreasonably
withheld, conditioned or delayed.
SECTION 4
CONSTRUCTION OF THE TENANT IMPROVEMENTS
4.1
Tenant’s
Selection of Contractors
.
4.1.1
The
Contractor
. A general contractor shall be retained by Tenant
to construct the Tenant Improvements. Such general contractor
(“
Contractor
”)
shall be selected by Tenant subject to Landlord’s prior
approval, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld,
conditioned or delayed. Tenant shall have the right, but not the
obligation, to submit the Tenant Improvements for competitive
bidding to two (2) or more general contractors.
4.1.2
Tenant’s
Agents
. All subcontractors used by Tenant (such
subcontractors, and the Contractor, to be known collectively as
“
Tenant’s
Agents
”) must be
approved in writing by Landlord, which approval shall not be
unreasonably withheld, conditioned or delayed. If Landlord does not
approve any of Tenant’s proposed subcontractors, Tenant shall
submit other proposed subcontractors for Landlord’s written
approval. Landlord shall either approve or disapprove (with
specific reasons for such disapproval) such Tenant’s Agents
within five (5) days after Landlord’s receipt of
Tenant’s request. The subcontractors set forth on
Annex B
hereto are
hereby approved by Landlord.
4.2
Construction
of Tenant Improvements by Tenant’s
Agents
.
4.2.1
Construction
Contract; Cost Budget
. Prior to the commencement of the
construction of the Tenant Improvements, and after Tenant has
accepted all bids for the Tenant Improvements, Tenant shall provide
Landlord with a detailed breakdown, by trade, of the final costs to
be incurred or which have been incurred, in connection with the
design and construction of the Tenant Improvements to be performed
by or at the direction of Tenant or the Contractor, which costs
form a basis for the amount of the construction contract and
general conditions with Contractor (the “
Final Costs
”).
4.2.2
Tenant’s
Agents
.
4.2.2.1
Landlord’s
General Conditions for Tenant’s Agents and Tenant Improvement
Work
. Tenant’s and Tenant’s Agent’s
construction of the Tenant Improvements shall comply with the
following: (i) the Tenant Improvements shall be constructed in
strict accordance with the Approved Working Drawings; (ii)
Tenant’s Agents shall submit schedules of all work relating
to the Tenant’s Improvements to Contractor and Contractor
shall, within five (5) business days of receipt thereof, inform
Tenant’s Agents of any changes which are necessary thereto,
and Tenant’s Agents shall adhere to such corrected schedule;
and (iii) Tenant shall abide by Landlord’s rules and
regulations with respect to the use of freight, loading dock and
service elevators, storage of materials, coordination of work with
the contractors of other tenants, and any other matter in
connection with this Work Letter, including, without limitation,
the construction of the Tenant Improvements, which rules and
regulations are attached hereto as
Annex C
. Tenant shall not pay a
construction supervision or management fee to Landlord in
connection with the Tenant Improvements (but a construction
supervision fee shall be included as a Tenant Improvement Allowance
Item as provided in Section 2.2 above).
4.2.2.2
Indemnity
.
Tenant’s indemnity of Landlord as set forth in this Lease
shall also apply with respect to any and all third party claims for
costs, losses, damages, injuries and liabilities related in any way
to any act or omission of Tenant or Tenant’s Agents, or
anyone directly or indirectly employed by any of them in connection
with the Tenant Improvements, or in connection with Tenant’s
non-payment of any amount arising out of the Tenant Improvements
and/or Tenant’s disapproval of all or any portion of any
request for payment.
4.2.2.3
Insurance
Requirements
.
4.2.2.3.1
General
Coverages
. All of Tenant’s Agents shall carry (a)
worker’s compensation insurance as required by law covering
all of their respective employees, (b) Employer’s Liability
with minimum coverages of minimum of $500,000 each accident;
$500,000 disease, policy limit; $500,000 disease, per employee; (c)
Broad Form Commercial General Liability (naming Landlord and its
property manager as additional insureds) with policy limits of
$1,000,000 per occurrence Combined Single Limit and $3,000,000
aggregate (i.e., such insurance shall be broad form and shall
include contractual liability, personal injury protection and
completed operations coverage); (d) Auto Liability with coverage of
at least $1,000,000; and (e) Property Insurance coverage for tools
and equipment brought onto and/or used on any Property by the
applicable contractor in an amount equal to the replacement costs
of all such tools and equipment.
4.2.2.3.2
Builder’s
Risk Coverages
. Tenant or Tenant’s Contractor shall
carry “Builder’s All Risk” insurance in an amount
approved by Landlord covering the construction of the Tenant
Improvements, and such other insurance as Landlord may reasonably
require, it being understood and agreed that the Tenant
Improvements shall be insured by Tenant pursuant to this Lease
immediately upon completion thereof. Such insurance shall be in
amounts and shall include such extended coverage endorsements as
may be reasonably required by Landlord including, but not limited
to, the requirement that all of Tenant’s Agents shall carry
excess liability and Products and Completed Operation Coverage
insurance, each in amounts not less than $500,000 per incident,
$1,000,000 in aggregate, and in form and with companies as are
required to be carried by Tenant as set forth in this
Lease.
4.2.2.3.3
General
Terms
. Certificates for all insurance carried pursuant to
this Section 4.2.2.3 shall be delivered to Landlord before the
commencement of construction of the Tenant Improvements and before
the Contractor’s equipment is moved onto the site. All such
policies of insurance must contain a provision that the company
writing said policy will give Landlord thirty (30) days prior
written notice of any cancellation or lapse of the effective date
or any reduction in the amounts of such insurance. In the event
that the Tenant Improvements are damaged by any cause during the
course of the construction thereof, Tenant shall immediately direct
its Contractor or Tenants Agents as appropriate to repair the same
at Tenant’s sole cost and expense. Tenant’s Agents
shall maintain all of the foregoing insurance coverage in force
until the Tenant Improvements are fully completed and accepted by
Landlord pursuant to this Work Letter, except for any Products and
Completed Operation Coverage insurance required by Landlord, which
is to be maintained for one (1) year following completion of the
work and acceptance by Landlord and Tenant. All policies carried
under this Section 4.2.2.3 shall insure Landlord and Tenant, as
their interests may appear, as well as Contractor and
Tenant’s Agents. All insurance, except Workers’
Compensation, maintained by Tenant’s Agents shall preclude
subrogation claims by the insurer against anyone insured
thereunder. Such insurance shall provide that it is primary
insurance as respects the owner and that any other insurance
maintained by owner is excess and noncontributing with the
insurance required hereunder. The requirements for the foregoing
insurance shall not derogate from the provisions for
indemnification of Landlord by Tenant under Section 4.2.2.2 of this
Work Letter. Landlord may, in its reasonable discretion, require
Tenant to obtain a lien and completion bond or some alternate form
of security reasonably satisfactory to Landlord in an amount
sufficient to ensure the lien-free completion of the Tenant
Improvements and naming Landlord as a co-obligee.
4.2.3
Governmental
Compliance
. The Tenant Improvements shall comply in all
respects with the following: (i) the Code and other state, federal,
city or quasi-governmental laws, codes, ordinances and regulations,
as each may apply according to the rulings of the controlling
public official, agent or other person; (ii) applicable standards
of the American Insurance Association (formerly, the National Board
of Fire Underwriters) and the National Electrical Code; and (iii)
building material manufacturer’s specifications.
4.2.4
Inspection
by Landlord
. Upon reasonable prior notice to Tenant,
Landlord shall have the right to inspect the Tenant Improvements at
all times, provided however, that Landlord’s failure to
inspect the Tenant Improvements shall in no event constitute a
waiver of any of Landlord’s rights hereunder nor shall
Landlord’s inspection of the Tenant Improvements constitute
Landlord’s approval of the same. Landlord shall conduct any
such inspections in a manner so as to minimize any disruption of
construction of the Tenant Improvements. Should Landlord reasonably
and in good faith disapprove any portion of the Tenant
Improvements, Landlord shall notify Tenant in writing of such
disapproval and shall specify the items disapproved. Any such
reasonable and good faith disapproval by Landlord of any portion of
the Tenant Improvements shall be rectified by Tenant at no expense
to Landlord, provided however, that in the event Landlord
determines that a defect or deviation exists or disapproves of any
matter in connection with any portion of the Tenant Improvements
and such defect, deviation or matter might adversely affect the
mechanical, electrical, plumbing, heating, ventilating and air
conditioning or life-safety systems of the Building, the structure
or exterior appearance of the Building or any other tenant’s
use of such other tenant’s leased premises, Landlord may,
take such action as Landlord deems necessary, at Tenant’s
expense and without incurring any liability on Landlord’s
part, to correct any such defect, deviation and/or matter,
including, without limitation, causing the cessation of performance
of the construction of the Tenant Improvements until such time as
the defect, deviation and/or matter is corrected to
Landlord’s satisfaction.
4.2.5
Meetings
.
Commencing upon the execution of this Lease, Tenant shall hold
weekly meetings at a reasonable time, with the Architect and the
Contractor regarding the progress of the preparation of
Construction Drawings and the construction of the Tenant
Improvements, which meetings may be held by teleconference or at a
mutually convenient location in the Seattle area agreed upon by
Tenant and Landlord, and Landlord and/or its agents shall receive
prior notice of, and shall have the right to attend, all such
meetings, and, upon Landlord’s request, certain of
Tenant’s Agents shall attend such meetings. In addition,
minutes shall be taken at all such meetings, a copy of which
minutes shall be promptly delivered to Landlord.
4.3
Copy
of Record Set of Plans
. At the conclusion of construction,
(i) Tenant shall cause the Architect and Contractor (A) to update
the Approved Working Drawings as necessary to reflect all changes
made to the Approved Working Drawings during the course of
construction, (B) to certify to the best of their knowledge that
the “record-set” of as-built drawings are true and
correct, which certification shall survive the expiration or
termination of this Lease, and (C) to deliver to Landlord two (2)
sets of copies of such record set of drawings within ninety (90)
days following issuance of a certificate of occupancy for the
Premises, and (ii) Tenant shall deliver to Landlord a copy of all
warranties, guaranties, and operating manuals and information
relating to the improvements, equipment, and systems in the
Premises.
SECTION 5
MISCELLANEOUS
5.1
Representatives
.
Tenant’s Representative means _________________ (phone:
______________; e-mail:
_________________
). Until
further notice to Landlord, such Tenant’s Representative
shall have full authority and responsibility to act on behalf of
the Tenant as required in this Work Letter. Landlord’s
Representative shall mean Vicki Fehl (phone:
206-628-5060;
e-mail:
victoriaf@unicoprop.com
)
and Rob Lavergne (phone: 206-628-5066;
e-mail:
robl@unicoprop.com
).
5.2
Time
of the Essence in This Work Letter
. Unless otherwise
indicated, all references herein to a “number of days”
shall mean and refer to calendar days. If any item requiring
approval is timely disapproved by Landlord, the procedure for
preparation of the document and approval thereof shall be repeated
until the document is approved by Landlord.
5.3
Tenant’s
Lease Default
. Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary
contained in this Lease, if an event of default as described in the
Lease has occurred at any time on or before the completion of the
Premises, and such default is not cured within the applicable cure
period set forth in the Lease, then (i) in addition to all other
rights and remedies granted to Landlord pursuant to the Lease,
Landlord shall have the right to withhold payment of all or any
portion of the Tenant Improvement Allowance until such time as such
default is cured pursuant to the terms of the Lease and/or Landlord
may cause Contractor to cease the construction of the Premises
until such time as such default is cured pursuant to the terms of
the Lease (in which case, Tenant shall be responsible for any delay
in the completion of the Premises caused by such work stoppage),
and (ii) all other obligations of Landlord under the terms of this
Work Letter shall be forgiven until such time as such default is
cured pursuant to the terms of the Lease (in which case, Tenant
shall be responsible for any delay in the completion of the
Premises caused by such inaction by Landlord).
RIDER ONE
RULES
(1)
Access to Property.
On Saturdays,
Sundays and Holidays, and on other days between the hours of 6:00
P.M. and 8:00 A.M. the following day, or such other hours as
Landlord shall determine from time to time, access to and within
the Property and/or to the passageways, lobbies, entrances, exits,
loading areas, corridors, elevators or stairways and other areas in
the Property may be restricted and access gained by use of a key to
the outside doors of the Property, or pursuant to such security
procedures Landlord may from time to time impose. Landlord shall in
all cases retain the right to control and prevent access to such
areas by Persons engaged in activities which are illegal or violate
these Rules, or whose presence in the judgment of Landlord shall be
prejudicial to the safety, character, reputation and interests of
the Property and its tenants (and Landlord shall have no liability
in damages for such actions taken in good faith). No Tenant and no
employee or invitee of Tenant shall enter areas reserved for the
exclusive use of Landlord, its employees or invitees or other
Persons. Tenant shall keep doors to corridors and lobbies closed
except when persons are entering or leaving.
(2)
Signs.
Tenant shall not paint, display,
inscribe, maintain or affix any sign, placard, picture,
advertisement, name, notice, lettering or direction on any part of
the outside or inside of the Property, or on any part of the inside
of the Premises which can be seen from the outside of the Premises
without the prior consent of Landlord, and then only such name or
names or matter and in such color, size, style, character and
material, and with professional designers, fabricators and
installers as may be first approved or designated by Landlord in
writing. Landlord shall prescribe the suite number and
identification sign for the Premises (which shall be prepared and
installed by Landlord at Tenant’s expense). Landlord reserves
the right to remove at Tenant’s expense all matter not so
installed or approved without notice to Tenant.
(3)
Window and Door Treatments.
Tenant shall
not place anything or allow anything to be placed in the Premises
near the glass of any door, partition, wall or window which may be
unsightly from outside the Premises, and Tenant shall not place or
permit to be placed any item of any kind on any window ledge or on
the exterior walls. Blinds, shades, awnings or other forms of
inside or outside window ventilators or similar devices, shall not
be placed in or about the outside windows or doors in the Premises
except to the extent, if any, that the design, character, shape,
color, material and make thereof is first approved or designated by
the Landlord. Tenant shall not install or remove any solar tint
film from the windows.
(4)
Lighting and General Appearance of
Premises.
Landlord reserves the right to designate and/or
approve in writing all internal lighting that may be visible from
the public, common or exterior areas. The design, arrangement,
style, color, character, quality and general appearance of the
portion of the Premises visible from public, common and exterior
areas, and contents of such portion of the Premises, including
furniture, fixtures, signs, art work, wall coverings, carpet and
decorations, and all changes, additions and replacements thereto
shall at all times have a neat, professional, attractive, first
class office appearance.
(5)
Property Trade Name, Likeness,
Trademarks.
Tenant shall not in any manner use the name of
the Property for any purpose, or use any trade names or trademarks
used by Landlord, any other tenant, or its affiliates, or any
picture or likeness of the Property for any purpose other than that
of the business address of Tenant, in any letterheads, envelopes,
circulars, notices, advertisements, containers, wrapping or other
material.
(6)
Deliveries and Removals.
Furniture,
freight and other large or heavy items, and all other deliveries
may be brought into the Property only at times and in the manner
designated by Landlord, and always at the Tenant’s sole
responsibility and risk. Landlord may inspect items brought into
the Property or Premises with respect to weight or dangerous nature
or compliance with this Lease or Laws. Landlord may (but shall have
no obligation to) require that all furniture, equipment, cartons
and other items removed from the Premises or the Property be listed
and a removal permit therefor first be obtained from Landlord.
Tenant shall not take or permit to be taken in or out of other
entrances or elevators of the Property, any item normally taken, or
which Landlord otherwise reasonably requires to be taken, in or out
through service doors or on freight elevators. Landlord may impose
reasonable charges and requirements for the use of freight
elevators and loading areas, and reserves the right to alter
schedules without notice. Any hand carts used at the Property shall
have rubber wheels and sideguards, and no other material handling
equipment may be brought upon the Property without Landlord’s
prior written approval.
(7)
Outside Vendors.
Tenant shall not obtain
for use upon the Premises ice, drinking water, vending machine,
towel, janitor and other services, except from Persons designated
or approved by Landlord. Any Person engaged by Tenant to provide
any other services shall be subject to scheduling and direction by
the manager or security personnel of the Property. Vendors must use
freight elevators and service entrances.
(8)
Overloading Floors; Vaults.
Tenant shall
not overload any floor or part thereof in the Premises, or
Property, including any public corridors or elevators therein
bringing in or removing any large or heavy items, and Landlord may
prohibit, or direct and control the location and size of, safes and
all other heavy items and require at Tenant’s expense
supplementary supports of such material and dimensions as Landlord
may deem necessary to properly distribute the weight.
(9)
Locks and Keys.
Tenant shall use such
standard key system designated by Landlord on all keyed doors to
and within the Premises, excluding any permitted vaults or safes
(but Landlord’s designation shall not be deemed a
representation of adequacy to prevent unlawful entry or criminal
acts, and Tenant shall maintain such additional insurance as Tenant
deems advisable for such events). Tenant shall not attach or permit
to be attached additional locks or similar devices to any door or
window, change existing locks or the mechanism thereof, or make or
permit to be made any keys for any door other than those provided
by Landlord. If more than two keys for one lock are desired,
Landlord will provide them upon payment of Landlord’s
charges. In the event of loss of any keys furnished by Landlord,
Tenant shall pay Landlord’s reasonable charges therefor. The
term “key” shall include mechanical, electronic or
other keys, cards and passes. Landlord shall not be liable for the
consequences of admitting by pass key or refusing to admit to the
Premises the Tenant, Tenant’s agent or employees or other
persons claiming the right of admittance.
(10)
Utility
Closets and Connections.
Landlord reserves the right to
control access to and use of, and monitor and supervise any work in
or affecting, the “wire” or telephone, electrical,
plumbing or other utility closets, the Systems and Equipment, and
any changes, connections, new installations, and wiring work
relating thereto (or Landlord may engage or designate an
independent contractor to provide such services). Tenant shall
obtain Landlord’s prior written consent for any such access,
use and work in each instance, and shall comply with such
requirements as Landlord may impose, and the other provisions of
the Lease respecting electric installations and connections,
telephone Lines and connections, and alterations generally. Tenant
shall have no right to use any broom closets, storage closets,
janitorial closets, or other such closets, rooms and areas
whatsoever. Tenant shall not install in or for the Premises any
equipment which requires more electric current than Landlord is
required to provide under this Lease, without Landlord’s
prior written approval, and Tenant shall ascertain from Landlord
the maximum amount of load or demand for or use of electrical
current which can safely be permitted in and for the Premises,
taking into account the capacity of electric wiring in the Property
and the Premises and the needs of tenants of the Property, and
shall not in any event connect a greater load than such safe
capacity.
(11)
Plumbing
Equipment.
The toilet rooms, urinals, wash bowls, drains,
sewers and other plumbing fixtures, equipment and lines shall not
be misused or used for any purpose other than that for which they
were constructed and no foreign substance of any kind whatsoever
shall be thrown therein.
(12)
Trash.
All garbage, refuse, trash and other waste shall be kept in the
kind of container, placed in the areas, and prepared for collection
in the manner and at the times and places specified by Landlord,
subject to Lease provisions respecting Hazardous Materials.
Landlord reserves the right to require that Tenant participate in
any recycling program designated by Landlord.
(13)
Alcohol,
Drugs, Food and Smoking.
Landlord reserves the right to
exclude or expel from the Property any person who, in the judgment
of Landlord, is intoxicated or under the influence of liquor or
drugs, or who shall in any manner do any act in violation of any of
these Rules. Tenant shall not at any time manufacture or sell any
spirituous, fermented, intoxicating or alcoholic liquors on the
Premises, nor permit the same to occur. Tenant shall not at any
time cook, sell, purchase or give away, food in any form by or to
any of Tenant’s agents or employees or any other parties on
the Premises, nor permit any of the same to occur (other than in
microwave ovens and coffee makers properly maintained in good and
safe working order and repair in lunch rooms or kitchens for
employees as may be permitted or installed by Landlord, which does
not violate any Laws or bother or annoy any other tenant). Tenant
and its employees shall not smoke tobacco on any part of the
Property (including exterior areas) except those areas, if any,
that are designated or approved as smoking areas by
Landlord.
(14)
Use
of Common Areas; No Soliciting.
Tenant shall not use the
Common Areas, including areas adjacent to the Premises, for any
purpose other than ingress and egress, and any such use thereof
shall be subject to the other provisions of this Lease, including
these Rules. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing,
Tenant shall not allow anything to remain in any passageway,
sidewalk, court, corridor, stairway, entrance, exit, elevator,
parking or shipping area, or other area outside the Premises.
Tenant shall not use the Common Areas to canvass, solicit business
or information from, or distribute any item or material to, other
tenants or invitees of the Property. Tenant shall not make any room
to room canvass to solicit business or information or to distribute
any item or material to or from other tenants of the Property and
shall not exhibit, sell or offer to sell, use, rent or exchange any
products or services in or from the Premise unless ordinarily
embraced within the Tenant’s use of the Premises expressly
permitted in the Lease.
(15)
Energy
and Utility Conservation.
Tenant shall not waste
electricity, water, heat or air conditioning or other utilities or
services, and agrees to cooperate fully with Landlord to assure the
most effective and energy efficient operation of the Property and
shall not allow the adjustment (except by Landlord’s
authorized Property personnel) of any controls. Tenant shall not
obstruct, alter or impair the efficient operation of the Systems
and Equipment, and shall not place any item so as to interfere with
air flow. Tenant shall keep corridor doors closed and shall not
open any windows, except that if the air circulation shall not be
in operation, windows which are openable may be opened with
Landlord’s consent. If reasonably requested by Landlord (and
as a condition to claiming any deficiency in the air-conditioning
or ventilation services provided by Landlord), Tenant shall close
any blinds or drapes in the Premises to prevent or minimize direct
sunlight.
(16)
Unattended
Premises.
Before leaving the Premises unattended, Tenant
shall close and securely lock all doors or other means of entry to
the Premises and shut off all lights and water faucets in the
Premises (except heat to the extent necessary to prevent the
freezing or bursting of pipes).
(17)
Going-Out-Of-Business
Sales and Auctions.
Tenant shall not use, or permit any
other party to use, the Premises for any distress, fire,
bankruptcy, close-out, “lost our lease” or
going-out-of-business sale or auction. Tenant shall not display any
signs advertising the foregoing anywhere in or about the Premises.
This prohibition shall also apply to Tenant’s
creditors.
(18)
Labor
Harmony.
Tenant shall not use (and upon notice from Landlord
shall cease using) contractors, services, workmen, labor, materials
or equipment, or labor and employment practices that, in
Landlord’s good faith judgment, may cause strikes, picketing
or boycotts or disturb labor harmony with the workforce or trades
engaged in performing other work, labor or services in or about the
Property.
(19)
Prohibited
Activities.
Tenant shall not: (i) use strobe or flashing
lights in or on the Premises, (ii) install or operate any internal
combustion engine, boiler, machinery, refrigerating, heating or air
conditioning equipment in or about the Premises, (iii) use the
Premises for housing, lodging or sleeping purposes or for the
washing of clothes, (iv) place any radio or television antennae
other than inside of the Premises, (v) operate or permit to be
operated any musical or sound producing instrument or device which
may be heard outside the Premises, (vi) use any source of power
other than electricity, (vii) operate any electrical or other
device from which may emanate electrical, electromagnetic, energy,
microwave, radiation or other waves or fields which may interfere
with or impair radio, television, microwave, or other broadcasting
or reception from or in the Property or elsewhere, or impair or
interfere with computers, faxes or telecommunication lines or
equipment at the Property or elsewhere, or create a health hazard,
(viii) bring or permit any bicycle or other vehicle, or dog (except
in the company of a blind person or except where specifically
permitted) or other animal or bird in the Premises or Building,
(ix) make or permit objectionable noise, vibration or odor to
emanate from the Premises, (x) do anything in or about the Premises
or Property that is illegal, immoral, obscene, pornographic, or
anything that may in Landlord’s good faith opinion create or
maintain a nuisance, cause physical damage to the Premises or
Property, interfere with the normal operation of the Systems and
Equipment, impair the appearance, character or reputation of the
Premises or Property, create waste to the Premises or Property,
cause demonstrations, protests, loitering, bomb threats or other
events that may require evacuation of the Building, (xi) advertise
or engage in any activities which violate any code of ethics or
licensing requirements of any professional or business
organization, (xii) throw or permit to be thrown or dropped any
item from any window or other opening in the Property, (xiii) use
the Premises for any purpose, or permit upon the Premises or
Property anything, that may be dangerous to persons or property
(including firearms or other weapons (whether or not licensed or
used by security guards) or any explosive or combustible items or
materials) (xiv) place vending or game machines in the Premises,
except vending machines for employees which shall be at
Tenant’s sole cost and expense and only upon prior notice to
and consent of Landlord, (xv) adversely affect the indoor air
quality of the Premises or Property, (xvi) use the Premises for
cooking or food preparation other than preparation of coffee, tea
and similar beverages, or customary microwave use, for Tenant and
its employees, or (xvii) do or permit anything to be done upon the
Premises or Property in any way tending to disturb, bother, annoy
or interfere with Landlord or any other tenant at the Property or
the tenants of neighboring property, or otherwise disrupt orderly
and quiet use and occupancy of the Property.
(20)
Transportation
Management.
Tenant shall comply with all present or future
programs intended to manage parking, transportation or traffic in
and around the Property, and in connection therewith, Tenant shall
take responsible action for the transportation planning and
management of all employees located at the Premises by working
directly with Landlord, any governmental transportation management
organization or any other transportation-related committees or
entities.
(21)
Parking.
Subject to any contrary provisions of this Lease, if the Property
now or hereafter contains, or Landlord has obtained the right to
use for the Property, a parking garage, structure, facility or
area, the following Rules shall apply therein:
(i)
Parking shall be
available in areas designated by Landlord from time to time, and
for such daily or monthly charges as Landlord may establish from
time to time. Parking for Tenant and its employees and visitors
shall be on a “first come, first served,” unassigned
basis, in common with Landlord and other tenants at the Property,
and their employees and visitors, and other Persons to whom
Landlord shall grant the right or who shall otherwise have the
right to use the same. However, in no event shall Tenant and
Tenant’s employees and visitors use more spaces than the
number derived by applying Tenant’s Pro Rata Share (as
defined in the Lease) to the total number of unassigned spaces in
the area or areas designated by Landlord from time to time to serve
the Premises. In addition, Landlord reserves the right to: (x)
adopt additional requirements or procedures pertaining to parking,
including systems with charges favoring carpooling, and validation
systems, (y) assign specific spaces, and reserve spaces for small
and other size cars, disabled persons, and other tenants, customers
of tenants or other parties, and (z) restrict or prohibit full size
vans and other large vehicles.
(ii)
Monthly
fees shall be paid in advance prior to the first of each month.
Failure to do so will automatically cancel parking privileges, and
incur a charge at the posted daily parking rate. No deductions from
the monthly rate will be made for days on which the Garage is not
used by Tenant or its designees. In case of any violation of these
rules, Landlord may also refuse to permit the violator to park, and
may remove the vehicle owned or driven by the violator from the
Property without liability whatsoever, at such violator’s
risk and expense. Landlord reserves the right to close all or a
portion of the parking areas or facilities in order to make repairs
or perform maintenance services, or to alter, modify, re-stripe or
renovate the same, or if required by casualty, strike,
condemnation, act of God, Law or governmental requirement or
guideline, termination or modification of any lease or other
agreement by which Landlord obtained parking rights, or any other
reason beyond Landlord’s reasonable control. In the event
access is denied for any reason, any monthly parking charges shall
be abated to the extent access is denied, as Tenant’s sole
recourse.
(iii)
Hours
shall be reasonably established by Landlord or its parking operator
from time to time; cars must be parked entirely within the stall
lines, and only small or other qualifying cars may be parked in
areas reserved for such cars; all directional signs, arrows and
speed limits must be observed; spaces reserved for disabled persons
must be used only by vehicles properly designated; washing, waxing,
cleaning or servicing of any vehicle is prohibited; every parker is
required to park and lock his own car, except to the extent that
Landlord adopts a valet parking system; parking is prohibited in
areas: (a) not striped or designated for parking, (b) aisles, (c)
where “no parking” signs are posted, (d) on ramps, and
(e) loading areas and other specially designated areas. Delivery
trucks and vehicles shall use only those areas designated
therefor.
(iv)
Parking
stickers, key cards or any other devices or forms of identification
or entry shall remain the property of Landlord. Such devices must
be displayed as requested and may not be mutilated in any manner.
The serial number of the parking identification device may not be
obliterated. Devices are not transferable and any device in the
possession of an unauthorized holder will be void. Loss or theft of
parking identification, key cards or other such devices must be
reported to Landlord or any garage manager immediately. Any parking
devices reported lost or stolen which are found on any unauthorized
car will be confiscated and the illegal holder will be subject to
prosecution. Lost or stolen devices found by Tenant or its
employees must be reported to Landlord or the office of the garage
immediately.
(22)
Responsibility
for Compliance
. Tenant shall be responsible for ensuring
compliance with these Rules, as they may be amended, by
Tenant’s employees and as applicable, by Tenant’s
agents, invitees, contractors, subcontractors, and suppliers.
Tenant shall cooperate with any reasonable program or requests by
Landlord to monitor and enforce the Rules, including providing
vehicle numbers and taking appropriate action against such of the
foregoing parties who violate these provisions.
RIDER TWO
GREEN ADDENDUM
(1)
The term "Green
Standard" or words of similar import shall include the U.S.
EPA’s Energy Star® rating, the Green Building
Initiative’s Green Globes TM for Continual Improvement of
Existing Buildings (Green GlobesTM-CIEB), the U.S. Green Building
Council’s Leadership in Energy and Environmental Design
(LEED), and/or a current and similar organization with equally
rigorous environmentally and sustainable practices.
(2)
Building Expenses
shall also include: (i) all costs of maintaining, managing,
reporting, commissioning, and recommissioning the Building or any
part thereof that was designed and/or upgraded to be sustainable
and conform with one or more Green Standard rating systems, and
(ii) all costs of applying, reporting and commissioning the
Building or any part thereof to seek certification under one or
more Green Standard rating systems, provided however, the cost of
such applying, reporting and commissioning of the Building or any
part thereof to seek certification shall be a cost capitalized and
thereafter amortized as an annual Expense under GAAP.
(3)
Tenant shall not
use or occupy the Premises for any unlawful purpose or in any
manner that will constitute waste, nuisance or unreasonable
annoyance to Landlord or other tenants of the Building. Tenant
shall not use or operate the Premises in any manner that will cause
the Building or any part thereof not to conform with
Landlord’s sustainability practices or a Green Standard
certification of the Building.
(4)
This building is or
may become in the future certified under a Green Standard or
operated pursuant to Landlord’s sustainable building
practices. Landlord’s sustainability practices address
whole-building operations and maintenance issues including chemical
use; indoor air quality; energy efficiency; water efficiency;
recycling programs; exterior maintenance programs; and systems
upgrades to meet green building energy, water, Indoor Air Quality,
and lighting performance standards. All construction and
maintenance methods and procedures, material purchases, and
disposal of waste must be in compliance with minimum standards and
specifications, in addition to all applicable laws.
(5)
Tenant shall use
proven energy and carbon reduction measures, including energy
efficient bulbs in task lighting; use of lighting controls; closing
shades as needed to avoid over heating the space; turning off
lights and equipment at the end of the work day; purchasing ENERGY
STAR® qualified equipment, including but not limited to
lighting, office equipment, commercial and residential quality
kitchen equipment, vending and ice machines, and; purchasing
products certified by the U.S. EPA’s Water Sense®
program.
(6)
Tenant covenants
and agrees, at its sole cost and expense: (a) to comply with all
present and future laws, orders and regulations of the Federal,
State, county, municipal or other governing authorities,
departments, commissions, agencies and boards regarding the
collection, sorting, separation, and recycling of garbage, trash,
rubbish and other refuse (collectively, “trash”); (b)
to comply with Landlord’s recycling policy as part of
Landlord’s sustainability practices where it may be more
stringent than applicable law; (c) to sort and separate its trash
and recycling into such categories as are provided by law or
Landlord’s sustainability practices; (d) that each separately
sorted category of trash and recycling shall be placed in separate
receptacles as directed by Landlord, and; (e) that Tenant shall pay
all costs, expenses, fines, penalties or damages that may be
imposed on Landlord or Tenant by reason of Tenant’s failure
to comply with the provisions of this Section. Where possible, the
Landlord shall provide a composting program and encourage the
Tenant to sort and separate its trash and recycling from compost
material.
(7)
Landlord shall
provide and install all original bulbs and tubes for Building
standard lighting fixtures within the Premises and all replacement
tubes for such lighting, the cost of which shall be included in
Building Expenses; all other bulbs, tubes and lighting fixtures for
the Premises shall be provided and installed by Tenant at
Tenant’s cost and expense, and must comply with
Landlord’s sustainability practices, including any Green
Standard rating system, concerning the environmental compliance of
the Building or the Premises, as the same may change from time to
time. All maintenance and repairs made by Tenant must comply with
Landlord’s sustainability practices, including any Green
Standard rating system concerning the environmental compliance of
the Building or the Premises, as the same may change from time to
time.
(8)
Any and all Tenant
Improvement Work and/or Alterations is strongly encouraged to be
performed in accordance with Landlord’s sustainability
practices, including any Green Standard or third-party rating
system concerning the environmental compliance of the Building or
the Premises, as the same may change from time to time. Tenant is
further encouraged to engage a qualified third party LEED or Green
Standard professional or similarly qualified professional during
the design phase through implementation of any Tenant Improvement
Work and/or Alterations to review all plans, material procurement,
demolition, construction and waste management procedures to ensure
they are in full conformance with Landlord’s sustainability
practices, as aforesaid. Any and all waste and debris from Tenant
Improvement Work and/or Alterations must meet the minimum
requirements set forth by the Green Standard.
(9)
Landlord does not
permit space heaters or other energy-intensive equipment
unnecessary to conduct Tenant’s business without written
approval by Landlord. Any space conditioning equipment that is
placed in the Premises for the purpose of increasing comfort to
tenants shall be operated on sensors or timers that limit operation
of equipment to hours of occupancy in the areas immediately
adjacent to the occupying personnel.
(10)
Tenant
acknowledges that it is Landlord’s intention that the
Property be operated in a manner which is consistent with
Landlord’s sustainability practices. Tenant is required to
comply with these practices within its Premises.
(11)
Tenant shall
dispose of, in an environmentally sustainable manner, any
equipment, furnishings, or materials no longer needed by Tenant and
shall recycle or re-use such items in accordance with
Landlord’s sustainability practices. Tenant is responsible
for reporting this activity to Landlord in a format determined by
Landlord.
(12)
Landlord
currently provides janitorial service only after 5:30 p.m. five
days per week (excluding legal holidays). Landlord reserves the
right to conduct routine cleaning during Normal Business Hours in
accordance with Landlord’s sustainability practices and will
be done in such a way as to minimize disruption.